FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Printer KYOCERA - Free user manual and instructions
Find the device manual for free FS-3040MFP+/KL3 KYOCERA in PDF.
User questions about FS-3040MFP+/KL3 KYOCERA
0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.
Ask a new question about this device
Download the instructions for your Printer in PDF format for free! Find your manual FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - KYOCERA and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. FS-3040MFP+/KL3 by KYOCERA.
USER MANUAL FS-3040MFP+/KL3 KYOCERA
natural_image
Exterior view of a white and black printer with open lid and control panel (no visible text or symbols)Introduction
Thank you for your purchase of FS-3040MFP+/FS-3140MFP+.
This Operation Guide is intended to help you operate the machine correctly, perform routine maintenance and take a simple troubleshooting action as necessary, so that you can always use the machine in good condition.
Please read this Operation Guide before you start using the machine, and keep it close to the machine for easy reference.
We recommend the use of our own brand supplies. We will not be liable for any damage caused by the use of third party supplies in this machine.
A label shown in the illustration assures that the supplies are our own brand.

natural_image
Technical line drawing of a mechanical housing component with a close-up inset showing internal components (no text or symbols)Included Guides
The following guides are supplied with the machine. Refer to them as necessary.
Quick Installation Guide
Describes frequently-used operations, convenient operations, routine maintenance, and troubleshooting action.
Safety Guide
Provides safety and cautionary information for the installation and use of the machine. Be sure to read this guide before using the machine.
Safety Guide (FS-3040MFP+/FS-3140MFP+)
Describes the machine installation space, cautionary labels, and other information. Be sure to read this guide before using the machine.
DVD-ROM (Product Library)
Operation Guide (This Guide)
Describes how to load paper, basic copy, print and scan operations, and troubleshooting.
FAX Operation Guide
Describes how to operate FAX, check transmission results, print reports, and use Network FAX.
KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide
Printer Driver User Guide
Network FAX Driver Operation Guide
KMnet Viewer User Guide
KM-NET for Direct Printing Operation Guide
PRESCRIBE Commands Technical Reference
PRESCRIBE Commands Command Reference
Safety Conventions in This Guide
The sections of this guide and parts of the machine marked with symbols are safety warnings meant to protect the user, other individuals and surrounding objects, and ensure correct and safe usage of the machine. The symbols and their meanings are indicated below.

WARNING: Indicates that serious injury or even death may result from insufficient attention to or incorrect compliance with the related points.

CAUTION: Indicates that personal injury or mechanical damage may result from insufficient attention to or incorrect compliance with the related points.
Symbols
The symbol indicates that the related section includes safety warnings. Specific points of attention are indicated inside the symbol.

.... [General warning]

.... [Warning of danger of electrical shock]

..... [Warning of high temperature]
The ⊗ symbol indicates that the related section includes information on prohibited actions. Specifics of the prohibited action are indicated inside the symbol.

.... [Warning of prohibited action]

..... [Disassembly prohibited]
The ● symbol indicates that the related section includes information on actions which must be performed. Specifics of the required action are indicated inside the symbol.

..... [Alert of required action]

.... [Remove the power plug from the outlet]

[Always connect the machine to an outlet with a ground connection]
Please contact your service representative to order a replacement if the safety warnings in this Operation Guide are illegible or if the guide itself is missing (fee required).
NOTE: An original which resembles a bank note closely may not be copied properly in some rare cases because this machine is equipped with a counterfeiting prevention function.
Contents
Quick Guide v
Menu Map......viii
Environment ...... xv
Cautions when handling consumables ...... xv
SAFETY OF LASER BEAM (USA) ...... xvii
Safety Instructions Regarding the Disconnection of Power (USA)....xviii
Laser Safety (Europe)....xx
Legal Restriction on Copying/Scanning ....xx
Legal and Safety Information .... xxi
1 P a r t N a m e s
Operation Panel 1-2
Machine....1-4
2 Preparation before Use
Check bundled items. 2-2
Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables....2-3
Connecting Cables 2-5
Power On/Off....2-6
Auto Low Power Mode 2-8
Sleep and Auto Sleep 2-8
Switching the Language for Display [Language]....2-9
Setting Date and Time....2-11
Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection)....2-14
Installing Software....2-16
COMMAND CENTER (Settings for E-mail). 2-28
Sending E-mail 2-29
Preparation for sending a document to a PC 2-31
Loading Paper....2-41
Loading Originals 2-54
3 Basic Operation
Login/Logout 3-2
One-Touch Keys and Program Keys....3-3
Message Display....3-6
Copying....3-7
Printing - Printing from Applications 3-16
Sending....3-18
Confirm Destination Screen 3-25
Specifying Destination....3-26
Canceling Jobs 3-29
Checking Remaining Toner and Paper 3-30
4 Copying Functions
Original Size 4-2
Paper Selection....4-3
Original Orientation 4-6
EcoPrint....4-8
Combine Mode 4-9
Continuous Scan....4-13
Job Finish Notice....4-14
File Name Entry 4-16
Print Override 4-17
5 Sending Functions
Original Size 5-2
Sending Size 5-3
Zoom....5-5
Duplex Sending 5-7
Original Orientation 5-8
File Format 5-10
Original Image....5-12
Adjusting Density 5-13
Scan Resolution 5-14
Color / Grayscale / Black and White Selection 5-15
Continuous Scan....5-16
File Name Entry 5-17
Subject and Body Entry....5-18
WSD Scan. 5-19
Job Finish Notice....5-21
FTP Encrypted TX....5-23
File Separation 5-24
Scanning Image using Application 5-25
6 Document Box
Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory 6-2
Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB) 6-6
Removing USB Memory 6-8
Printing from a Job Box....6-9
7 Status / Job Cancel
Checking Job Status 7-2
Checking Job History 7-8
Sending the Job Log History....7-13
Pause and Resumption of Jobs 7-18
Canceling of Jobs 7-18
Device/Communication 7-19
8 Default Setting (System Menu)
Common Settings 8-2
Copy Settings 8-68
Printer Settings 8-74
Sending Settings....8-86
Document Box Settings....8-88
Printing Reports/Sending Notice 8-93
Adjustment/Maintenance....8-98
Editing Destination (Address Book/Adding One-Touch Keys). 8-105
Restarting the System....8-119
Network Setup....8-120
Network Security....8-139
Interface Block Setting 8-146
Security Level (Security Level setting) 8-150
Optional Functions 8-150
9 Maintenance
Cleaning 9-2
Toner Container Replacement....9-5
Replacing the Waste Toner Box 9-7
Replacing the maintenance kit (MK-370) 9-8
10 Troubleshooting
Solving Malfunctions 10-2
Responding to Error Messages....10-6
Clearing Paper Jams....10-13
11 Management
User Login Administration....11-2
Job Accounting 11-15
Checking the Counter 11-37
Appendix
Optional Equipment. Appendix-2
Character Entry Method ...... Appendix-5
Paper.... Appendix-9
Specifications ...... Appendix-18
EN ISO 7779....Appendix-21
EK1-ITB 2000 ...... Appendix-21
Glossary ...... Appendix-22
Index....Index-1
Quick Guide
Be sure to read Legal and Safety Information before using this machine.
Administrator tasks
To make copies To print

Simply press the Start key to make copies. You can also fine tune the copy settings by changing the paper size, adjusting the density, etc.

You can print via a network or print a PDF file directly from USB memory.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Copying with specific settings"] --> B["Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Memory"]
C["Connecting Cables"] --> D["Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection)"]
E["Print via a network"] --> F["Install the printer driver on your computer...2-16"]
G["Loading Paper...2-41"] --> H["Placing Originals on the Platen...2-54"]
I["Copying Functions ...4-1"] --> J["Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory ... 6-2"]
K["Printing - Printing from Applications ...3-16"] --> L["Operation"]
M["What you want to do"] --> N["Setup"]
Administrator tasks
To send documents

You can send scanned images via a network. Or, you can also store scanned images in USB memory.

flowchart
graph TD
A["What you want to do"] --> B["Send as E-mail"]
A --> C["Connecting Cables"]
A --> D["Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection)"]
A --> E["Plug the USB memory"]
B --> F["Operation"]
C --> F
D --> F
E --> F
F --> G["Sending ...3-18 *1\nSending Functions ...5-1"]
F --> H["Saving Documents to USB Memory\n(Scan to USB) ...6-6"]
G --> I["Editing Destination (Address Book/Adding One-Touch Keys)...8-105"]
H --> I
I --> J["Place the originals on the platen"]
J --> K["Create a shared folder on the destination computer...2-31"]
*1: If the destination is not stored in the address book, you can send by entering the address directly.
To send a FAX(FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+.)

As well as sending a FAX via the telephone lines, you can also send a FAX via a network.
NOTE: For more information on setting up and sending a FAX, refer to the FAX Operation Guide.

flowchart
graph TD
A["What you want to do"] --> B["Send a FAX"]
C["Setup"] --> D["Connect the modular cord for the telephone line to this machine."]
D --> E["Selection of Telephone Line (Inch version only)"]
E --> F["Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection)"]
F --> G["Install the Network FAX Driver on your computer *1"]
G --> H["Selection of Transmit Terminal Identification (TTI)...2-3 on the FAX Operation Guide *2"]
H --> I["Place the originals on the platen"]
I --> J["FAX Operation (Basic) ...3-1 on the FAX Operation Guide"]
K["Operation"] --> J
L["FAX directly from a computer"] --> M["End"]
N["About Network FAX ...7-1 on the FAX Operation Guide"] --> J
*1: For more information, refer to the Network FAX Driver Operation Guide.
*2: If the destination is not stored in the address book, you can send the FAX by entering the address directly.
Menu Map
| Copy key | Function Menu key | Paper Selection | ...page 4-3 |
| Collate | ...page 3-15 | ||
| Duplex | ...page 3-12 | ||
| Zoom | ...page 3-10 | ||
| Combine | ...page 4-9 | ||
| Original Size | ...page 4-2 | ||
| Orig.Orientation | ...page 4-6 | ||
| Original Image | ...page 3-9 | ||
| Density | ...page 3-8 | ||
| EcoPrint | ...page 4-8 | ||
| Continuous Scan | ...page 4-13 | ||
| File Name Entry | ...page 4-16 | ||
| JobFinish Notice | ...page 4-14 | ||
| Print Override | ...page 4-17 |
| Send key | Function Menu key | Color Selection | ...page 5-15 |
| Original Size | ...page 5-2 | ||
| Original Image | ...page 5-12 | ||
| Scan Resolution | ...page 5-14 | ||
| Sending Size | ...page 5-3 | ||
| Zoom | ...page 5-5 | ||
| Orig.Orientation | ...page 5-8 | ||
| Continuous Scan | ...page 5-16 | ||
| File Format | ...page 5-10 | ||
| File Name Entry | ...page 5-17 | ||
| Subject/Body | ...page 5-18 | ||
| JobFinish Notice | ...page 5-21 | ||
| FAX Resolution | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | ||
| FAX Delayed TX | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | ||
| FAX Direct TX | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | ||
| FAX RX Polling | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | ||
| (Continued on next page) | (Continued on next page) | Density | ...page 5-13 |
| Send key(Continued from previous page) | Function Menu key(Continued from previous page) | Duplex | ...page 5-7 |
| FTP Encrypted TX | ...page 5-23 | ||
| File Separation | ...page 5-24 |
| Document Box key | Sub Address Box | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide |
| Polling Box | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | |
| Job Box | ...page 6-9 | |
| USB Memory | ...page 6-2 |
| Document Box key(When printing fromUSB memory) | Function Menu key | Collate | ...page 3-15 |
| Paper Selection | ...page 4-3 | ||
| Duplex | ...page 3-12 | ||
| File Name Entry | ...page 5-17 | ||
| JobFinish Notice | ...page 4-14 | ||
| Print Override | ...page 4-17 | ||
| Encrypted PDF | — | ||
| TIFF Print | ...page 6-3 | ||
| XPS FitTo Page | ...page 6-4 | ||
| Document Box key(When saving to USBmemory) | Function Menu key | Color Selection | ...page 5-15 |
| Original Size | ...page 5-2 | ||
| Original Image | ...page 5-12 | ||
| Scan Resolution | ...page 5-14 | ||
| Storing Size | — | ||
| Zoom | ...page 5-5 | ||
| Orig.Orientation | ...page 5-8 | ||
| Continuous Scan | ...page 5-16 | ||
| File Format | ...page 5-10 | ||
| File Name Entry | ...page 5-17 | ||
| JobFinish Notice | ...page 5-21 | ||
| Density | ...page 5-13 | ||
| Duplex | ...page 5-7 |
| Status/Job Cancel key | Print Job Status | ...page 7-2 |
| Send Job Status | ...page 7-2 | |
| Store Job Status | ...page 7-2 | |
| Scheduled Job | ...page 7-8 | |
| Print Job Log | ...page 7-8 | |
| Send Job Log | ...page 7-8 | |
| Store Job Log | ...page 7-8 | |
| Scanner | ...page 7-19 | |
| Printer | ...page 7-19 | |
| FAX | ...page 7-19 | |
| Toner Status | ...page 3-30 | |
| Paper Status | ...page 3-30 | |
| USB Memory | ...page 7-20 |
| System Menu/ Counter key | Report Report | Print Menu Map | ...page 8-93 | ||
| Status Page | ...page 8-93 | ||||
| Font List | ...page 8-93 | ||||
| Admin Rpt Set. | Outgoing FAX Rpt | ...Refer to theFAX Operation Guide | |||
| Incoming FAX Rpt | ...Refer to theFAX Operation Guide | ||||
| Result Rpt Set. | Send Result E-mail/Folder | ...page 8-96 | |||
| ...page 8-96 | |||||
| ...page 8-96 | |||||
| FAX RX Result | ...Refer to theFAX Operation Guide | ||||
| JobFinish Notice | ...Refer to theFAX Operation Guide | ||||
| Job Log History | Auto Sending | ...page 7-13 | |||
| Send History | ...page 7-13 | ||||
| Destination Confirmation | firmation | ...page 7-13 | |||
| Register | ...page 7-13 | ||||
| Subject | ...page 7-13 | ||||
| SSFC Log Subject | ...page 7-13 | ||||
| System Menu/ Counter key (Continued from previous page) | Counter | ...page 11-37 | |||
| System Network | Setting | TCP/IP Settings | TCP/IP | ...page 8-121 | |
| IPv4 Setting | ...page 8-121 | ||||
| IPv6 Setting | ...page 8-130 | ||||
| Protocol Detail | ...page 8-136 | ||||
| NetWare | ...page 8-131 | ||||
| AppleTalk | ...page 8-132 | ||||
| WSD-SCAN | ...page 8-133 | ||||
| WSD-PRINT | ...page 8-134 | ||||
| IPSec | ...page 8-139 | ||||
| Secure Protocol | ...page 8-139 | ||||
| Host Name | — | ||||
| LAN Interface | ...page 8-120 | ||||
| I/F Block Set. | ...page 8-146 | ||||
| Security Level | ...page 8-150 | ||||
| Restart | ...page 8-119 | ||||
| Op Functions | ...page 8-150 | ||||
| User/Job Account | User Login Set. | User Login | ...page 11-2 | ||
| Local User List | ...page 11-6 | ||||
| IC Card Setting | — | ||||
| Group Auth. | ...page 11-11 | ||||
| NW User Property | ...page 11-12 | ||||
| Job Account.Set. | Job Accounting | ...page 11-15 | |||
| Account. Report | ...page 11-35 | ||||
| Total Accounting | ...page 11-31 | ||||
| Each Job Account | ...page 11-31 | ||||
| Account. List Detail/Edit | ...page 11-19 | ||||
| ...page 11-19 | |||||
| ...page 11-18 | |||||
| Default Setting | Apply Limit | ...page 11-26 | |||
| Copy/Print Count | ...page 11-22 | ||||
| Counter Limit | ...page 11-28 | ||||
| Unknown ID Job | ...page 11-13 | ||||
| System Menu/ Counter key (Continued from previous page) | User Property | — | ||||
| Common Settings | Language | ...page 8-3 | ||||
| Default Screen | ...page 8-5 | |||||
| Sound Buzzer | ...page 8-6 | |||||
| FAX Speaker | ...page 8-6 | |||||
| FAX Monitor | ...page 8-6 | |||||
| Display Bright. | ...page 8-7 | |||||
| Orig./Paper Set. | Custom Orig.Size | ...page 8-7 | ||||
| Def. Orig. Size | ...page 8-9 | |||||
| Custom PaperSize | ...page 8-10 | |||||
| Cassette 1 Set. | ...page 8-12 | |||||
| Cassette 2 Set. | ...page 8-12 | |||||
| Cassette 3 Set. | ...page 8-12 | |||||
| Cassette 4 Set. | ...page 8-12 | |||||
| MP Tray Set. | ...page 8-14 | |||||
| Media Type Set. | ...page 8-16 | |||||
| Media for Auto | ...page 8-19 | |||||
| Def. PaperSource | ...page 8-20 | |||||
| SpecialPaper Act. | ...page 8-21 | |||||
| Preset Limit | ...page 8-23 | |||||
| Measurement | ...page 8-24 | |||||
| Error Handling | ...page 8-25 | |||||
| Date Setting | ...page 8-27 | |||||
| Timer Setting F | Err. Clear Timer | ...page 8-32 | ||||
| Sleep Timer | ...page 8-34 | |||||
| PanelReset Timer | ...page 8-37 | |||||
| Low Power Timer | ...page 8-39 | |||||
| Auto Err. Clear | ...page 8-32 | |||||
| Auto Sleep | ...page 8-34 | |||||
| Auto Panel Reset | ...page 8-37 | |||||
| Unusable Time | ...page 8-40 | |||||
| (Continued on next page) | (Continued on next page) | |||||
| System Menu/ Counter key (Continued from previous page) | Common Settings(Continued from previous page) | Function Default | Color Selection | ...page 8-42 | ||
| Scan Resolution | ...page 8-43 | |||||
| FAX Resolution | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | |||||
| Original Image | ...page 8-44 | |||||
| Density | ...page 8-45 | |||||
| Zoom | ...page 8-46 | |||||
| Collate | ...page 8-47 | |||||
| Orig.Orientation | ...page 8-48 | |||||
| EcoPrint | ...page 8-49 | |||||
| File Name Entry | ...page 8-50 | |||||
| Subject/Body | ...page 8-51 | |||||
| Continuous Scan | ...page 8-52 | |||||
| File Format | ...page 8-53 | |||||
| File Separation | ...page 8-54 | |||||
| TIFF Print | ...page 8-55 | |||||
| XPS FitTo Page | ...page 8-56 | |||||
| Detail Setting | 2 in 1 Layout | ...page 8-57 | ||||
| 4 in 1 Layout | ...page 8-58 | |||||
| Border Line | ...page 8-60 | |||||
| Orig. Binding | ...page 8-61 | |||||
| Finish. Binding | ...page 8-62 | |||||
| Image Quality | ...page 8-63 | |||||
| Color TIFF Comp. | ...page 8-64 | |||||
| Login Operation | ...page 8-66 | |||||
| RAM Disk Mode | ...page 8-67 | |||||
| (Continued on next page) | Copy Photo Processing | ...page 8-68 | ||||
| ...page 8-69 | ||||||
| ...page 8-70 | ||||||
| ...page 8-71 | ||||||
| ...page 8-72 | ||||||
| System Menu/Counter key(Continued from previous page) | Printer Emulation Set. | ...page 8-74 | ||||
| ...page 8-77 | ||||||
| ...page 8-78 | ||||||
| ...page 8-79 | ||||||
| ...page 8-80 | ||||||
| ...page 8-81 | ||||||
| ...page 8-82 | ||||||
| ...page 8-82 | ||||||
| ...page 8-83 | ||||||
| ...page 8-84 | ||||||
| Send Select Key Set. | ...page 8-86 | |||||
| Document Box Sub Address Box | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | |||||
| ...page 8-88 | ||||||
| ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | ||||||
| ...page 8-90 | ||||||
| ...page 8-105 | ||||||
| ...page 8-105 | ||||||
| Edit Destination | Address Book | |||||
| Print List | ||||||
| Adjust/Maint. Copy Denst. Adj. | ...page 8-98 | |||||
| Send/Box Density | ||||||
| Correct. Bk Line | ||||||
| Service Setting | Service Status | ...page 8-95 | ||||
| Network Status | ...page 8-95 | |||||
| New Developer | ...page 8-101 | |||||
| Auto DrumRefresh | ...page 8-102 | |||||
| Drum Refresh | ...page 8-103 | |||||
| FAX Country Code | — | |||||
| FAX Call Set. | — | |||||
| Remote Diag.Set. | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | |||||
| Remote Diag. ID | ...Refer to the FAX Operation Guide | |||||
Environment
The service environmental conditions are as follows:
• Temperature: 50 to 90.5 °F (10 to 32.5 °C)
• Humidity: 15 to 80 %
However, adverse environmental conditions may affect the image quality. Avoid the following locations when selecting a site for the machine.
- Avoid locations near a window or with exposure to direct sunlight.
- Avoid locations with vibrations.
- Avoid locations with drastic temperature fluctuations.
- Avoid locations with direct exposure to hot or cold air.
- Avoid poorly ventilated locations.
If the floor is delicate against casters, when this machine is moved after installation, the floor material may be damaged.
During copying, some ozone is released, but the amount does not cause any ill effect to one's health. If, however, the machine is used over a long period of time in a poorly ventilated room or when making an extremely large number of copies, the smell may become unpleasant. To maintain the appropriate environment for copy work, it is suggested that the room be properly ventilated.
Cautions when handling consumables

CAUTION
Do not attempt to incinerate the toner container or the waste toner box. Dangerous sparks may cause burns.
Keep the toner container and the waste toner box out of the reach of children.
If toner happens to spill from the toner container or the waste toner box, avoid inhalation and ingestion, as well as contact with your eyes and skin.



- If you do happen to inhale toner, move to a place with fresh air and gargle thoroughly with a large amount of water. If coughing develops, contact a physician.
- If you do happen to ingest toner, rinse your mouth with water and drink 1 or 2 cups of water to dilute the contents of your stomach. If necessary, contact a physician.
- If you do happen to get toner in your eyes, flush them thoroughly with water. If there is any remaining tenderness, contact a physician.
- If toner does happen to get on your skin, wash with soap and water.
Do not attempt to force open or destroy the toner container or the waste toner box.

Other precautions
Return the exhausted toner container and waste toner box to your dealer or service representative. The collected toner container and waste toner box will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
Store the machine while avoiding exposure to direct sunlight.
Store the machine in a place where the temperature stays below 40^ C while avoiding sharp changes of temperature and humidity.
If the machine will not be used for an extended period of time, remove the paper from the cassette and the Multi Purpose (MP) Tray, return it to its original package and reseal it.
If using the FS-3140MFP+ the main power switch is off, transmitting/receiving Fax is disabled. Do not turn off the main power switch, but press the Power key on the operation panel to enter Sleep mode.
SAFETY OF LASER BEAM (USA)
1. Safety of laser beam
This machine has been certified by the manufacturer to Class 1 level under the radiation performance standards established by the U.S.DHHS (Department of Health and Human Services) in 1968. This indicates that the product is safe to use during normal operation and maintenance. The laser optical system, enclosed in a protective housing and sealed within the external covers, never permits the laser beam to escape.
2. The CDRH Act
A laser-product-related act was implemented on Aug. 2, 1976, by the Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) of the U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA). This act prohibits the sale of laser products in the U.S. without certification, and applies to laser products manufactured after Aug. 1, 1976. The label shown below indicates compliance with the CDRH regulations and must be attached to laser products marketed in the United States. On this machine, the label is on the rear.

text_image
FS-3140MFP+FS-3040MFP+3. Optical unit
When checking the optical unit, avoid direct exposure to the laser beam, which is invisible. Shown at below is the label located on the cover of the optical unit.

text_image
DANGER ATTENTION VORSICHT ATTENZIONE PRECAUCION VAUO [IMAGE] CLASS 68 LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN, AUDID DURING EXPOSURE CLASS 68 RADIATION DESIGNER ASSEMBLER OFFRINT, NECHI DEM STRAIN, AUDITRIEN, EXTANS 150000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER EN CAS D'OUVERTURE, EXPOSITION DANCE/RESE AU PABOVAL CLASS 68 LASER/STRALUMS, WMEN AUSIKURUM SODRINT, NIGHT DEM STRAIN, AUDITRIEN, EXTANS 150000000000000000 CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSUSE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSUSE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSUSE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXTANS EXPOSUSE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBO CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 68 RADIATION LASER QUANDO DE ABRE, EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 324 GAVA BEATEMENTOS WTR EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 324 GAVA BEATEMENTOS WTR EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 324 GAVA BEATEMENTOS WTR EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 324 GAVA BEATEMENTOS WTR EXPOSURE AU RUBU CLASS 324 GAVA BEATEMENTOS WTR EXPOSURE AU RUBU4. Maintenance
For safety of the service personnel, follow the maintenance instructions in the other section of this manual.
Safety Instructions Regarding the Disconnection of Power (USA)
Caution: The power plug is the main isolation device! Other switches on the equipment are only functional switches and are not suitable for isolating the equipment from the power source.
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
- Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
- Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
- Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
- The use of a non-shielded interface cable with the referenced device is prohibited.
CAUTION — The changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with Part 15 of FCC Rules and RSS-Gen of IC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions; (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
* The above warning is valid only in the United States of America.
Radio Tag Technology
In some countries the radio tag technology used in this equipment to identify the toner container may be subject to authorization and the use of this equipment may consequently be restricted.
Other precautions (for users in California, the United States)
This product contains a CR Coin Lithium Battery which contains Perchlorate Material - special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
FS-3040MFP+/FS-3140MFP+ MULTIFUNCTIONAL PRODUCT LIMITED WARRANTY
Kyocera Mita America, Inc. and Kyocera Mita Canada, Ltd. (both referred to as "Kyocera") warrant the Customer's new Multifunctional Product (referred to as "MFP"), and the new accessories installed with the initial installation of the MFP, against any defects in material and workmanship for a period of one (1) year, or 300,000 copies/prints from date of installation, whichever first occurs. In the event the MFP or an accessory is found to be defective within the warranty period, Kyocera's only obligation and the Customer's exclusive remedy shall be replacement of any defective parts. Kyocera shall have no obligation to furnish labor.
This warranty is valid only for the original retail purchaser (referred to as the “Customer”) of a new Kyocera MFP in the United States of America or Canada, based upon the country of purchase.
In order to obtain performance of this warranty, the Customer must immediately notify the Authorized Kyocera Dealer from whom the product was purchased. If the Kyocera Dealer is not able to provide service, write to Kyocera at the address below for the name and address of the Authorized Kyocera Dealer in your area or check Kyocera's website at www.kyoceramita.com/us.
This warranty does not cover MFP's or accessories, which: (a) have become damaged due to operator negligence, misuse, accidents, improper storage or unusual physical or electrical stress, (b) have used parts or supplies which are not genuine Kyocera brand parts or supplies, (c) have been installed or serviced by a technician not employed by Kyocera or an Authorized Kyocera Dealer, or (d) have had the serial number modified, altered, or removed.
This warranty does not cover Maintenance Kits or the components of Maintenance Kits, which consist of the developing unit, the drum unit, the transfer roller, the fixing unit and the feed roller unit, which have a separate warranty.
This warranty gives the Customer specific legal rights. The Customer may also have other rights, which vary from state to state, or province to province. Neither the seller, nor any other person, is authorized to extend the time period or expand this warranty on behalf of Kyocera.
THIS WARRANTY IS MADE IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, AND KYOCERA SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THIS WARRANTY SHALL NOT EXTEND TO, AND KYOCERA SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR, ANY INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WHICH MAY ARISE OUT OF THE USE OF, OR INABILITY TO USE, THE MFP.
KYOCERA MITA AMERICA, INC.
225 Sand Road
Fairfield, New Jersey
07004-0008, USA
Laser Safety (Europe)
Laser radiation could be hazardous to the human body. For this reason, laser radiation emitted inside this machine is hermetically sealed within the protective housing and external cover. In the normal operation of the product by user, no radiation can leak from the machine.
This machine is classified as Class 1 laser product under IEC 60825-1:2007.
Caution: Performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
These labels are attached to the laser scanner unit inside the machine and are not in a user access area.

text_image
DANGER ATTENTION VORIGHT ATTENZIONE PRECAUTION VARO • CLASS 62 LASER PADIATION WHEN OPEN AVOID INVERT EXPENDENCE TO BHAIL • CLASS 62 LASER PADIATION LAIUS EN CHAS DIOUVERTURE EXPOSITION DANSIPERSUE AU PASSOURAL • LANSE AS LASERETHA UNIEN, WENN AMBEZKUNI SEFFINEC NECH DEM ETHN L. ARNESTED. • CLASS 62 LASERETHA LASER IN CASO IN APERTURA. • LANSE AS LASERETHA LASER IN PASORA • CLASS 62 RADIACONE LASER CANADO SE ABRE EVIDEN ESPOMESAR AL RAVID. • ASTAGEMA OLUT AUTIMA LUCKAN AS LASERATETEYLLLE ALTA KATO IS TENDER • 脂肪:使产品为30天光能产品,打开量子筛余有激光探测,将光能光光隔离。 • 脂肪:液晶面板30mm激光摄影,打开量子筛余有激光探测,将原光光束测量。 • 脂肪:CLASS 3B 24芯 塑面型防光镜 抗物,显示可读即可。 • 脂肪:它必须与各种多孔器一样一起进行安装。 - 一个具有超薄的光缆,能够可以从光缆中识别。The label shown below is attached on the right side of the machine.

text_image
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT KLASSE 1 LASER PRODUKTLegal Restriction on Copying/Scanning
- It may be prohibited to copy/scan copyrighted material without permission of the copyright owner.
- Copying/Scanning the following items is prohibited and may be penalized by low.
It may not be limited to these items. Do not knowingly copy/scan the items that are not to be copied/scanned.
Paper money
Bank note
Securities
Stamp
Passport
Certificate
- Local laws and regulations may prohibit or restrict copying/scanning of other items not mentioned above.
Legal and Safety Information
Please read this information before using your machine. This chapter provides information on the following topics.
- Legal Information.... xxii
- Regarding Trade Names .... xxii
• Energy Saving Control Function.... xxvi
• Automatic 2-Sided Copy Function.... xxvi - Paper Recycling .... xxvi
- Energy Star (ENERGY STAR ^ ) Program.... xxvi
- About this Operation Guide.... xxvii
- Conventions in This Guide ....xxviii
Legal Information
Copying or other reproduction of all or part of this guide without the prior written consent of Kyocera Mita Corporation is prohibited.
Regarding Trade Names
- PRESCRIBE and ECOSYS are trademarks of Kyocera Corporation.
- KPDL is a trademark of Kyocera Corporation.
- Microsoft, MS-DOS, Windows, Windows NT and Internet Explorer are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S.A. and/or other countries.
- Windows Me, Windows XP and Windows Vista are trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
- PCL is a trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
- Adobe Acrobat, Adobe Reader and PostScript are trademarks of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
- Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
• Novell and NetWare are registered trademarks of Novell, Inc.
• IBM and IBM PC/AT are trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation. - Power PC is a trademark of IBM in the U.S.A. and/or other countries.
- AppleTalk, Bonjour, Macintosh, and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
- TypeBankG-B, TypeBankM-M and Typebank-OCR are trademarks of TypeBank ^® .
- All European language fonts installed in this machine are used under licensing agreement with Monotype Imaging Inc.
- Helvetica, Palatino and Times are registered trademarks of Linotype-Hell AG.
- ITC Avant Garde Gothic, ITC Bookman, ITC ZapfChancery and ITC ZapfDingbats are registered trademarks of International Type-face Corporation.
- UFST™ MicroType ^ fonts by Monotype Imaging Inc. are installed in this machine.
- This machine contains the software having modules developed by Independent JPEG Group.
All other brands and product names are registered trademarks or trademarks of their respective companies. The designations ^™ and ^® will not be used in this Operation Guide.
GPL/LGPL
This product contains GPL (http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html) and/or LGPL (http://www.gnu.org/licenses/lgpl.html) software as part of its firmware. You can get the source code, and you are permitted to copy, redistribute and modify it under the terms of GPL/LGPL. For further information including availability of the source code, visit http://www.kyoceramita.com/gpl/.
Open SSLeay License
Copyright (c) 1998-2006 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3 All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment:
"This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)
4 The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior written permission.
For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org.
5 Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project.
6 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Original SSLeay License
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, Ihash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed.
If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used.
This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1 Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3 All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement:
"This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)"
The word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
4 If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
"This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publicly available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]
Monotype Imaging License Agreement
1 Software shall mean the digitally encoded, machine readable, scalable outline data as encoded in a special format as well as the UFST Software.
2 You agree to accept a non-exclusive license to use the Software to reproduce and display weights, styles and versions of letters, numerals, characters and symbols (Typefaces) solely for your own customary business or personal purposes at the address stated on the registration card you return to Monotype Imaging. Under the terms of this License Agreement, you have the right to use the Fonts on up to three printers. If you need to have access to the fonts on more than three printers, you need to acquire a multi-user license agreement which can be obtained from Monotype Imaging. Monotype Imaging retains all rights, title and interest to the Software and Typefaces and no rights are granted to you other than a License to use the Software on the terms expressly set forth in this Agreement.
3 To protect proprietary rights of Monotype Imaging, you agree to maintain the Software and other proprietary information concerning the Typefaces in strict confidence and to establish reasonable procedures regulating access to and use of the Software and Typefaces.
4 You agree not to duplicate or copy the Software or Typefaces, except that you may make one backup copy. You agree that any such copy shall contain the same proprietary notices as those appearing on the original.
5 This License shall continue until the last use of the Software and Typefaces, unless sooner terminated. This License may be terminated by Monotype Imaging if you fail to comply with the terms of this License and such failure is not remedied within thirty (30) days after notice from Monotype Imaging. When this License expires or is terminated, you shall either return to Monotype Imaging or destroy all copies of the Software and Typefaces and documentation as requested.
6 You agree that you will not modify, alter, disassemble, decrypt, reverse engineer or decompile the Software.
7 Monotype Imaging warrants that for ninety (90) days after delivery, the Software will perform in accordance with Monotype Imaging-published specifications, and the diskette will be free from defects in material and workmanship. Monotype Imaging does not warrant that the Software is free from all bugs, errors and omissions.
The parties agree that all other warranties, expressed or implied, including warranties of fitness for a particular purpose and merchantability, are excluded.
8 Your exclusive remedy and the sole liability of Monotype Imaging in connection with the Software and Typefaces is repair or replacement of defective parts, upon their return to Monotype Imaging.
In no event will Monotype Imaging be liable for lost profits, lost data, or any other incidental or consequential damages, or any damages caused by abuse or misapplication of the Software and Typefaces.
9 Massachusetts U.S.A. law governs this Agreement.
10 You shall not sublicense, sell, lease, or otherwise transfer the Software and/or Typefaces without the prior written consent of Monotype Imaging.
11 Use, duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at FAR 252-227-7013, subdivision (b)(3)(ii) or subparagraph (c)(1)(ii), as appropriate. Further use, duplication or disclosure is subject to restrictions applicable to restricted rights software as set forth in FAR 52.227-19 (c)(2).
12 You acknowledge that you have read this Agreement, understand it, and agree to be bound by its terms and conditions. Neither party shall be bound by any statement or representation not contained in this Agreement. No change in this Agreement is effective unless written and signed by properly authorized representatives of each party. By opening this diskette package, you agree to accept the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
Energy Saving Control Function
The device comes equipped with a Low Power Mode where energy consumption is reduced after a certain amount of time elapses since the device was last used, as well as a Sleep Mode where printer and fax functions remain in a waiting state but power consumption is still reduced to a minimum when there is no activity with the device within a set amount of time.
Low Power Mode
The device automatically enters Low Power Mode when 2 minutes have passed since the device was last used. The amount of time of no activity that must pass before Low Power Mode is activated may be lengthened. For more information refer to Auto Low Power Mode on page 2-8.
Sleep
The device automatically enters Sleep when 15 minutes have passed since the device was last used. The amount of time of no activity that must pass before Sleep is activated may be lengthened. For more information see Sleep and Auto Sleep on page 2-8.
Automatic 2-Sided Copy Function
This device includes 2-sided copying as a standard function. For example, by copying two 1-sided originals onto a single sheet of paper as a 2-sided copy, it is possible to lower the amount of paper used. For more information see Duplex Copying on page 3-12.
Paper Recycling
This device supports the recycled paper which reduces the load on the environment. Your sales or service representative can provide information about recommended paper types.
Energy Star (ENERGY STAR®) Program

We have determined as a participating company in the International Energy Star Program that this product is compliant with the standards laid out in the International Energy Star Program.
About this Operation Guide
This Operation Guide contains the following chapters.
Chapter 1 - Part Names
Identifies machine parts and operation panel keys.
Chapter 2 - Preparation before Use
Explains adding paper, placing originals, connecting the machine, and necessary configurations before first use.
Chapter 3 - Basic Operation
Describes the procedures for basic copying, printing and scanning.
Chapter 4 - Copying Functions
Describes the functions you can use when copying.
Chapter 5 - Sending Functions
Describes the functions you can use when sending originals.
Chapter 6 - Document Box
Provides a basic guide to using document boxes.
Chapter 7 - Status / Job Cancel
Explains how to check the job status and job history and how to pause or resume jobs being printed or waiting to print. Also explains how to check the device status.
Chapter 8 - Default Setting (System Menu)
Describes the System Menu options for general machine operation.
Chapter 9 - Maintenance
Describes cleaning and toner replacement.
Chapter 10 - Troubleshooting
Explains how to handle error messages, paper jams and other problems.
Chapter 11 - Management
Explains user login administration and job accounting.
Appendix
Explains how to enter characters, and lists the machine specifications.
Introduces the convenient optional equipment available for this machine.
Provides information on media types and paper sizes. Also includes a glossary of terms.
Conventions in This Guide
The following conventions are used depending on the nature of the description.
| Convention Description Example | ||
| Bold Indicates the operation panel keys or a computer screen. | Press the Start key. | |
| [Regular] Indicates a selection item on the Message Display. | Select [System]. | |
| Italic Indicates a message displayed on the Message Display. | Ready to copy is displayed. | |
| Used to emphasize a key word, phrase or references to additional information. | ||
| Note Indicates supplemental information or operations for reference. | NOTE: | |
| Important Indicates items that are required or prohibited so as to avoid problems. | IMPORTANT: | |
| Caution Indicates what must be observed to prevent injury or machine breakdown and how to deal with it. | CAUTION: | |
1 Part Names
This chapter identifies the machine parts and operation panel keys.
• Operation Panel 1-2
- Machine....1-4
Operation Panel

text_image
Displays the System Menu/Counter menu screen, where you can check the system settings and counters. Displays the Status screen, where you can check the status, print a status report, and pause or cancel the job in process. Displays the Copy screen, where you can make settings required for copying. System Menu Counter Status/Job Cancel Copy Send (E-mail Folder FAX) Document Box FAX Displays the FAX screen, where you can send a FAX.* Displays the Send screen, where you can send an e-mail, folder (SMB/FTP) or FAX.* Displays the Document Box screen, where you can operate the document box and USB memory. Displays the Address Book screen, where you can add, edit and delete destinations. Calls the previous destination. Also used to enter a pause when entering a FAX number.* Displays the Confirm Destination screen, where you can edit and delete destinations. Displays the Add Destination screen, where you can add destinations. Switches between on-hook and off-hook when manually sending a FAX.* Message Display. Check what is shown here while operating the machine. Selects the menu displayed at the lower right in the Message Display. Shift Lock 1. 2. 3. 4. 12. 13. 14. 15. 5. 6. 7. 8. 16. 17. 18. 19. 9. 10. 11. 20. 21. 22. Print Send/Receive Blinks while data is transmitted. Blinks during printing operation. Uses to register, call and delete destinations to the one-touch key numbers (1 to 22). Shifts to switch the one-touch key numbers (1 to 11 and 12 to 22). Lamp is lit while shifted (12 to 22).* FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+.

text_image
Used to select a menu item, move the cursor when entering characters, change a value, etc. Selects the chosen item or finalizes the entered value. Displays the function menu for copy, print, transmission and document box. Clears entered numbers and characters. Resets settings and displays the basic screen. Puts the machine to sleep or wakes it up. Lith when the machine's main power is on. Function Menu OK Back Memory Attention Numeric keys. Enter numbers and symbols. Returns the Message Display to the previous screen. Lights or blinks when an error occurs. Blinks while the machine is accessing the memory. Starts copying and scanning operations and processing for setting operations. Start *,./. 0 # Symbols Clear C Reset Stop Program I, ID Card Copy Power Logout Ends operation (logs out) on the Administration screen. Used to register or recall programs. Cancels the printing job in progress. Blinks while the machine is accessing the memory.Machine

text_image
Technical diagram of a printer with numbered parts for identification and assembly reference.1 Platen
2 Slit Glass
3 Operation Panel
4 Top Cover
5 Front Cover
6 Toner Container Lock Lever
7 Toner Container
8 Developer Unit
9 USB Memory Slot
10 Paper Guage
11 Duplexer Front Cover

text_image
Technical diagram of a printer internal structure with numbered parts and exploded view12 Document Processor
13 Inner Tray
14 Paper Length Guide
15 Paper Width Guide
16 Paper Width Adjusting Tab
17 Paper Size Dial
18 Cassette 1
19 Paper Width Guides
20 Multi Purpose Tray (MP tray)
21 Support Tray Section of the Multi Purpose Tray
22 Handholds

text_image
24 23 25 2523 Rear Unit
24 Fuser Cover
25 Envelope Switch

text_image
26 27 28 29 30 3126 Top Cover
27 Original Width Guides
28 Original Table
29 Original Eject Table
30 Original Stopper
31 Document Processor Open/Close Handle

text_image
32 33 34 35 36 38 39 37 33 40 4132 USB interface Connector
33 Network Interface Connector/indicators
34 LINE Connector*
35 TEL Connector*
36 Rear Cover
37 Power Cord Connector
38 Main Power Switch
39 Handholes
40 Left Cover
41 Waste Toner Box
*Only on products with the fax function installed.
2 Preparation before Use
This chapter explains the preparations before using this equipment for the first time as well as the procedures for loading papers and originals.
- Check bundled items.... 2-2
• Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables . 2-3 - Connecting Cables 2-5
• Power On/Off....2-6
• Auto Low Power Mode 2-8 - Sleep and Auto Sleep.... 2-8
- Switching the Language for Display [Language]...... 2-9
- Setting Date and Time.... 2-11
- Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection).... 2-14
• Installing Software 2-16
• COMMAND CENTER (Settings for E-mail)...... 2-28 - Sending E-mail 2-29
- Preparation for sending a document to a PC ...... 2-31
- Loading Paper 2-41
- Loading Originals 2-54
Check bundled items
Check that the following items have been bundled.
- Quick Installation Guide
- Safety Guide
• Safety Guide (FS-3040MFP+/FS-3140MFP+)
• DVD-ROM (Product Library)
• DVD-ROM (TWAIN compatible application)
Documents Contained in the Included DVD-ROM
The following documents are contained in the included DVD-ROM (Product Library). Refer to them as necessary.
Documents
Operation Guide (This Guide)
FAX Operation Guide
KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide
Printer Driver User Guide
Network FAX Driver Operation Guide
KMnet Viewer User Guide
KM-NET for Direct Printing Operation Guide
PRESCRIBE Commands Technical Reference
PRESCRIBE Commands Command Reference
Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables
Check the method to connect the equipment to a PC or network, and prepare the necessary cables.
Connection Example
Determine the method to connect the equipment to a PC or network by referring to the illustration below.
Connecting a scanner to your PC network with a network cable (100BASE-TX or 10BASE-T)

flowchart
graph TD
A["Administrator's PC"] -->|COMMAND CENTER| B["Printing"]
B -->|MFP| C["Network"]
C --> D["Send E-mail"]
C --> E["Send SMB"]
C --> F["Send FTP"]
B --> G["Network FAX"]
B --> H["FAX"]
G --> I["USB"]
H --> J["USB"]
I --> K["Network"]
J --> L["Network"]
K --> M["Network"]
L --> N["Network"]
M --> O["Network"]
N --> P["Network"]
O --> Q["USB"]
P --> R["USB"]
Q --> S["SWAIN Scanning"]
R --> T["WIA Scanning"]
S --> U["TWAIN and WIA are standardized interface for communication between software"]
T --> V["TWAIN and WIA are standardized interface for communication between software"]
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
style E fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
style F fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
style G fill:#cff,stroke:#333
style H fill:#cff,stroke:#333
style I fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style J fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style K fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style L fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style M fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style N fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style O fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style P fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style Q fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style R fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style S fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
style T fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
Preparing Necessary Cables
The following interfaces are available to connect the equipment to a PC. Prepare the necessary cables according to the interface you use.
Available Standard Interfaces
| Function Interface Necessary Cable | ||
| Printer/Scanner /Network FAX* | Network interface LAN | (10Base-T or 100Base-TX, Shielded) |
| Printer/TWAIN Scanning/WIA Scanning | USB interface USB2.0 | compatible cable(Hi-Speed USB compliant, Max. 5.0 m, Shielded) |
* Network FAX and FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+. For details on Network FAX, refer to the FAX Operation Guide.
Connecting Cables
Follow the steps below to connect cables to the machine.

text_image
Diagram showing a hand pressing a button on a device with an arrow indicating rotation or adjustment.1 Turn the main power switch off (O).
2 Connect the machine to the PC or your network device. When using the network interface, remove the cap.
When connecting the network cable, configure the network. For details, refer to Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection) on page 2-14.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Hand-drawn printer"] --> B["USB port"]
B --> C["Computer"]
C --> D["USB port"]
D --> E["Switch"]
style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
style E fill:#cff,stroke:#333

natural_image
Line drawing of a hand inserting a green tool into a computer oven (no text or symbols)3 Connect one end of the supplied power cable to the machine and the other end to a power outlet.
IMPORTANT: Only use the power cable that comes with the machine.
Power On/Off
Power On
When the main power indicator is lit...

text_image
Power ① ○Press the Power key.
When the main power indicator is off...

text_image
Diagram showing a hand pressing a button labeled 'I' with an arrow indicating rotation, next to a device panel.Turn the main power switch on.
IMPORTANT: When turning off the main power switch, do not turn on the main power switch again immediately. Wait more than 5 seconds, and then turn on the main power switch.
Power Off
Before turning off the main power switch, press the Power key on the operation panel to off. Make sure that the memory indicator is off before turning off the main power switch.

text_image
Print Send/Receive Memory Attention Power Make sure that the indicator is off.In case of not using the machine for a extended period of time

CAUTION: If this machine will be left unused for an extended period (e.g. overnight), turn it off at the main power switch. If the machine will not be used for an even longer period of time (e.g. vacation), remove the power plug from the outlet as a safety precaution. If using the FS-3140MFP+, note that turning the machine off at the main power switch disables fax transmission and reception.
CAUTION: Remove paper from the cassettes and seal it in the paper storage bag to protect it from humidity.
Auto Low Power Mode
Auto Low Power Mode automatically switches the machine into Low Power Mode if left idle for 2 minutes.
Sleep and Auto Sleep
Sleep

text_image
Power ①To enter Sleep, press the Power key. Message Display and all indicators on the operation panel will go out to save a maximum amount of power except the Main Power indicator. This status is referred to as Sleep.
If print data is received during Sleep, the print job is performed while the Message Display remains unlit.
If you are using the FS-3140MFP+, received fax data is printed out while the operation panel also remains unlit.
To resume, press the Power key. The machine will be ready to operate in about 15 seconds.
Note that ambient environmental conditions, such as ventilation, may cause the machine to respond more slowly.
Auto Sleep
Auto Sleep automatically switches the machine into Sleep Mode if left idle for 15 minutes.
Switching the Language for Display [Language]
Select the language displayed on the Message Display.
Use the procedure below to select the language.
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 1](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/f0bbab17150793cc0a5d9e0cadabdd6f65fdc5b309a80acef3df2d12cd7f4b83.jpg)
text_image
Diagram showing a hand pressing a button labeled 'I' with an arrow indicating rotation or change, next to a device panel.![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 2](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/6bf8faf2ad61aadc31facffee62e4e1b3439a9b220a22419757431be0a76f6c4.jpg)
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 3](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/334fcd131ba810e6df134419a3339cf778c938eef6791863f10e9a0053379374.jpg)
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 4](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/88dd2223608f453262be6a20b777f619cc987d00cfcb772d688e69e99711f264.jpg)
text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 5](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/d57d6952c6b4a615abc4c7da76ce92e634f85a1826912faf1a03f2872a8757ed.jpg)
text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [1 Turn on the main power switch.
2 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
When you are performing user management and have not logged in, a login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password to log in.
NOTE: The following administrator is registered in the machine at the factory.
Login User Name:4000
Login Password:4000
Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
4 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Language].
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 6](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/f6d8201f9c7d77fc1881847226bc186065dfdd66e6cfacd466cf146fe626bc47.jpg)
text_image
Language: [0 1] * English [0 2] Deutsch [0 3] Français6 Press the OK key. Language appears.
7 Press the or key to select the desired language and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Setting Date and Time
Follow the steps below to set the local date and time at the place of installation.
When you send an E-mail using the transmission function, the date and time as set here will be printed in the header of the E-mail message. Set the date, time and time difference from GMT of the region where the machine is used.
NOTE: Be sure to set the time difference before setting the date and time.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings
text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Date Setting: 01 Date/Time 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone [1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
3 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Date Setting], and press the OK key.
5 A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
6 The Date Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Time Zone].

text_image
Time Zone: 30 GMT Casablanca *GMT Greenwich 32 +01:00 Amsterdam8 Press the OK key. Time Zone appears.
9 Press the or key to select your region and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Setting menu.
10 Press the or key to select [Summer Time].

text_image
Date Setting: 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone 04 Summer Time [11 Press the OK key. Summer Time appears.

text_image
Summer Time: [01]*Off [02] On12 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Setting menu.
13 Press the or key to select [Date/Time].

text_image
Date Setting: [01] Date/Time [02] Date Format [03] Time Zone [14 Press the OK key. Date/Time appears.

text_image
Date/Time: Year Month Day 2011 01 01 (Time Zone:Greenwich)15 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move the cursor position, press the △ or ▽ key to enter year, month and day, and then press the OK key.

text_image
Date/Time: Hour Min. Second 11: 45: 50 (Time Zone:Greenwich)16 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move the cursor position, press the △ or ▽ key to enter hours, minutes and seconds, and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Setting menu.
2

text_image
Date Setting: 01 Date/Time 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone [17 Press the or key to select [Date Format].

text_image
Date Format: 01 Month/Day/Year 02 *Day/Month/Year 03 Year/Month/Day [18 Press the OK key. Date Format appears.
19 Press the or key to select the desired display format and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Setting menu.
Network Setup (LAN Cable Connection)
The machine is equipped with network interface, which is compatible with network protocols such as TCP/IP (IPv4), TCP/IP (IPv6), IPX/SPX, NetBEUI, IPSec, and AppleTalk. It enables network printing on the Windows, Macintosh, UNIX, NetWare and other platforms.
The table below shows the items required for each of the settings.
Configure the printer's network parameters as appropriate for your PC and your network environment.
For details of the procedure, refer to the Network Setup on page 8-120 or Network Security on page 8-139.
NOTE: When COMMAND CENTER is used, network parameters and security settings can be conveniently changed and checked from your PC. For more information, refer to COMMAND CENTER (Settings for E-mail) on page 2-28.
| Menu Submenu Setting | |||||
| System Network Setting | TCP/IP Settings | TCP/IP On/Off | |||
| IPv4 Setting DHCP | On/Off | ||||
| Bonjour On/Off | |||||
| IP Address IP address | |||||
| Subnet Mask IP address | |||||
| Default Gateway IP address | |||||
| IPv6 Setting On/Off | |||||
| Protocol Detail Net | BEUI On/Off | ||||
| SNMPv3 | On/Off | ||||
| FTP (Server) | On/Off | ||||
| FTP (Client) | On/Off Port number: 21 | ||||
| SMB | On/Off | ||||
| SNMP | On/Off | ||||
| SMTP (E-mail TX) | On/Off | ||||
| POP3 (E-mail RX) | On/Off | ||||
| RAW Port | On/Off | ||||
| LPD | On/Off | ||||
| IPP | On/Off Port number: 631 | ||||
| IPP Over SSL | On/Off | ||||
| HTTP | On/Off | ||||
| HTTPS | On/Off | ||||
| LDAP | On/Off | ||||
| NetWare On/Off | Frame Type | |||
| AppleTalk On/Off | ||||
| WSD-SCAN On/Off | ||||
| WSD-PRINT On/Off | ||||
| IPSec IPSec On/Off | ||||
| Rule Setting On/Off | ||||
| Secure Protocol | SSL On/Off | |||
| IPP Security IPP/IPP over SSL | IPPoverSSL only | |||
| HTTP Security HTTP/HTTPS | HTTPS only | |||
| LDAP Security Off | LDAPv3/TLS LDAP over SSL | |||
| LAN Interface Auto | 10Base-Half 10Base-Full 100Base-Half 100Base-Full | |||
NOTE: After all network related settings have been done, turn the machine OFF and ON again. This is mandatory to make the settings effective!
Installing Software
Ensure the printer is plugged in and connected to the PC before installing the printer driver from the DVD-ROM.
Installing the Software in Windows
If you are connecting this printer to a Windows PC, follow the next steps to install the printer driver. The example shows you how to connect your printer to a Windows Vista PC.
NOTE: In Windows operating systems, you must be logged in with administrator rights to install the printer driver.
You can use either Express Mode or Custom Mode to install the software. Express Mode automatically detects connected printers and installs the required software. Use Custom Mode if you want to specify the printer port and select the software to be installed.
1 Turn on the computer and start up Windows.
If the Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard dialog box displays, select Cancel.
2 Insert the DVD-ROM supplied with the printer into the optical drive of the PC. In Windows 7, Windows Server 2008 and Windows Vista, the user account control window may appear. Click Allow.
The installation program launches.
NOTE: If the software install wizard does not launch automatically, open the DVD-ROM window in Windows Explorer and double-click Setup.exe.
3 Click View License Agreement and read the License Agreement. Click Accept.

text_image
KYOCERA Product Library THE NEW VALUE FRONTIER Product Library FS-C2526MFP FS-C2626MFP FS-C2026MFP+ FS-C2126MFP+ FS-3540MFP FS-3640MFP FS-3140MFP+ Notice By using or installing the device drivers and Software included on this DVD-ROM, you agree to become bound by the terms and conditions of this License Agreement. Please open and read. View License Agreement Accept Exit © 2011 KYOCERA MITA Corporation4 Click Install software.
The software install wizard starts up.

text_image
Kyocera Product Library KYOCERA THE NEW VALUE FRONTIER Product Library FS-C2526MFP FS-C2626MFP FS-C2026MFP+ FS-C2126MFP+ FS-3540MFP FS-3640MFP FS-3040MFP+ FS-3140MFP+ Install Software Remove Software Advanced Tools Hardware Documentation Software Documentation Software Release Notes Select Language Install drivers and utilities. © 2011 KYOCERA MITA Corporation www.kyocoramita.comFrom this point, the procedure differs depending on your version of Windows and your connection method. Proceed to the correct procedure for your connection type.
- Express Mode
- Custom Mode
Express Mode
In Express Mode, the installer automatically detects the printer when it is turned on. Use Express Mode for standard connection methods.
1 In the installation method selection window, select Express Mode. The print system detection window appears and the installer detects the connected printers. If the installer does not detect a print system, check that the print system is connected via USB or a network and that it is turned on. Then click Refresh to search print system again.
NOTE: While the information shown in Windows Vista and Windows 7/Windows XP installation dialog boxes differs slightly, the installation procedure is the same.

text_image
Installer Installation Method Choose how to install the software. Express Mode Install the recommended printing software. The printing system must be connected. Custom Mode Create a custom installation. Utilities Install printing system utilities only. Back Next Cancel KYOCERA2 Select the printer you want to be installed, and click Next.
NOTE: If the Found New Hardware Wizard appears, click Cancel. If a hardware installation warning message appear, click Continue.

text_image
Installer Discover Printing System Choose the printing system you would like to install: Device Type Details PV4 PV6 Finished Information Refresh Use host name for port name KYOCERA < Back Next > Cancel3 You can customize the print system name in the installation settings window. This will be the name displayed in the Printer window and in the printer lists displayed in applications. Specify whether to share the print system name or set the print system as an existing printer and then click Next.
IMPORTANT: Step 3 only appears if the print system is connected via a network. It does not appear if the print system is connected via a USB at the time of the first installation.

text_image
Installer Printer Settings Type a name for your printer. Some programs do not support printer and server name combinations longer than 31 characters. Printing system name: Share your printer with other users. To share the printer, type a share name. Set as default printer KYOCERA < Back Next > Cancel4 A window appears in which you can check the settings. Check the settings carefully and then click Install.
NOTE: If the Windows security window appears, click Install this driver software anyway.
5 A message appears saying that the printer has been installed successfully. Click Finish to exit the printer installation wizard and return the DVD-ROM main menu.
If the device setup dialog box appears after you click Finish, you can specify the settings for items such as optional features installed in the print system. You can also specify the device settings after you exit the installation. For details, refer to Device Settings in the printer driver operation manual on the DVD-ROM.
This completes the printer driver installation procedure. Follow the on-screen instructions to restart the system, if required.
Custom Mode
Use Custom Mode if you want to specify the printer port and select the software to be installed.
For example, if you do not want fonts installed on your computer to be replaced, select Custom Mode and deselect the Fonts checkbox in the utility tab.
1 Select Custom Mode.

text_image
Installer Installation Method Choose how to install the software. Express Mode Install the recommended printing software. The printing system must be connected. Custom Mode Create a custom installation. Utilities Install printing system utilities only. KYOCERA Back User Cancel2 Following the instructions in the install wizard window, select the software packages to be installed and the specify the port, etc.
For details, refer to Custom Installation in the printer driver operation manual on the DVD-ROM.

text_image
Installer Discover Printing System Choose or discover the printing system to install. Custom select Discover Device Type Details To create Add to default version Finished Information Use host name for port name KYOCERA < Back Next > CancelInstallation on a Macintosh
This section explains how to install the printer driver in Mac OS.
1 Turn on the printer and the Macintosh.
2 Insert the included DVD-ROM (Product Library) into the DVD-ROM drive.
3 Double-click the DVD-ROM icon.
4 Double-click either OS X 10.2 and 10.3 Only, OS X 10.4 Only or OS X 10.5 or higher depending on your Mac OS version.

text_image
Kyocera > DEVICES > SHARED > PLACES > SEARCH FOR: Common files Document OS X 10.2 and 10.3 Only OS X 10.4 Only OS X 10.5 or higher Readme.pdf 6 items, Zero KB available5 Double-click Kyocera OS X x.x.

text_image
OS X 10.5 or higher > DEVICES > SHARED > PLACES > SEARCH FOR Kyocera OS X 10.5+ build PDL Setup 2 items, Zero KB available6 The printer driver installation program starts up.

text_image
Install FS-C2026MFP+/C2126MFP+/C2526MFP/C2626MFP/3040MFP+/3140MF Welcome to the FS-C2026MFP+/C2126MFP+/C2526MFP/C2626MFP/ 3040MFP+/3140MFP+/3540MFP/3640MFP Installer You will be guided through the steps necessary to install this software. Macintosh Installer © 2011 KYOCERA Corporation, KYOCERA META Corporation Go Back Continue7 Choose Select Destination, Installation Type and then install the printer driver as directed by the instructions in the installation software.
NOTE: In addition to Easy Install, the Installation Type options include Custom Install, which allows you to specify the components to be installed.
IMPORTANT: In the Authenticate screen, enter the name and password used to log in to the operating system.
This completes the printer driver installation. Next, specify the print settings.
If an IP, AppleTalk or Bonjour connection is used, the settings below are required. If a USB connection is used, the printer is automatically recognized and connected.
8 Open System Preferences and click Print & Fax.

text_image
System Preferences Show All Personal Appearance Desktop & Screen Saver Dock Expose & Spaces Language & Text Security Spotlight Hardware CDs & DVDs Displays Energy Saver Keyboard Mouse Print & Fax Sound Internet & Wireless MobileMe Network Bluetooth Sharing System Accounts Date & Time Parental Controls Software Update Speech Startup Disk Time Machine Universal Access9 Click the plus symbol (+) to add the installed printer driver.

text_image
Print & Fax Show All Printers Idle, Last Used Idle Idle Idle 00.005.004.2022 Open Print Queue... Options & Supplies... Location: Kind: Status: Idle Share this printer on the network Sharing Preferences Default printer: Last Printer Used Default paper size: A4 Click the lock to prevent further changes.10 Click the IP icon for an IP connection and then enter the IP address and printer name.
When you click the AppleTalk icon for an AppleTalk connection, enter the printer name.
NOTE: AppleTalk icon is not displayed on Mac OS X 10.6.

text_image
Add Printer Default Fax IP Windows Search Protocol: Line Printer Daemon - LPD Address: Enter host name or IP address. Queue: Leave blank for default queue. Name: No Selection Location: No Selection Print Using: AddFor a Bonjour connection, click the default icon and select the printer for which Bonjour appears in Connection.

text_image
Add Printer Default Fax IP Windows Search Printer Name: Kind Bonjour Bonjour Bonjour Bonjour Bonjour Bonjour Bonjour Name: No Selection Location: No Selection Print Using: Add11 Select the installed printer driver and click Add.

text_image
Add Printer Default Fax IP Windows Search Protocol: Line Printer Daemon - LPD Address: 10.183.51.199 Valid and complete address. Queue: Leave blank for default queue. Name: 10.183.51.199 Location: Print Using: https://10.183.com/ (4755) Add12 Select the options available for the printer and click Continue.

text_image
Add Printer Default Fax IP Windows Search Installable Options Make sure your printer's options are accurately shown here so you can take full advantage of them. For information on your printer and its optional hardware, check the documentation that came with it. Paper Feeders: Three Optional Disk: RAM Disk Cancel Continue13 The selected printer is added. This completes the printer setup procedure.

text_image
Print & Fax Show All Printers 108.089.10.2007 Idle, Last Used Idle OKORON Idle OKORON Idle Open Print Queue... Options & Supplies... Location: Kind: Status: Idle Share this printer on the network Sharing Preferences... Default printer: Last Printer Used Default paper size: A4 Click the lock to prevent further changes.Uninstalling Software (Windows PC)
The software can be uninstalled (removed) using the DVD-ROM (Product Library) supplied with the printer.
IMPORTANT: On Macintosh computers, because the printer settings are specified using a PPD (PostScript Printer Description) file, the software cannot be uninstalled using the DVD-ROM (Product Library).
1 Exit all active software applications.
2 Insert the enclosed DVD-ROM (Product Library) into the DVD-ROM drive. In Windows 7, Windows Server 2008 and Windows Vista, the user account control window may appear. Click Allow.
3 Following the procedure used to install the printer driver, click Remove Software. The Kyocera Uninstaller wizard appears.
4 Select the software package to remove.
5 Click Uninstall.
NOTE: When KMnet Viewer is installed, separate uninstallers are launched for this application. Proceed with the uninstallation steps for this application as directed by the on-screen instructions.
The uninstaller starts.
6 When Uninstall complete screen appears, click Finish.
7 If Restart Your System screen appears, select whether you restart your computer or not, and click Finish.
NOTE: The software can be uninstalled from the Start menu.
Start the uninstaller by clicking start > All Programs > Kyocera > Uninstall Kyocera Product Library, and uninstall the software.
Setting TWAIN Driver
Register this machine to the TWAIN Driver.
1 Start the TWAIN Driver by clicking start > All Programs > Kyocera > TWAIN Driver Setting.
2 Click Add.

text_image
Kyocera TWAIN Driver Scannel List Name Model Add... OK OK Set as default About... Help Close3 Enter the machine name in the Name field.

text_image
Kypocera TWAIN Driver Name F5.0000007 Source F5.0000007 - 1.0000007 Scanner Address Image Compression (Color) Yes No Compression Level 3 Low High Image Compression (Gray / Monochrome) Compression Level 3 Low High Unit Inch Metric User Authentication Settings Help OK Cancel4 Click ▼ next to the Model field and select this machine from the list.
5 Click User Authentication Settings. If user login administration is invalid, go to Step 7.
6 Select the checkbox beside Authentication, enter Login User Name (up to 64 characters) and Password (up to 64 characters) and then click OK.

text_image
User Authentication Settings ✓ Authentication Login user name: administrator Password ****** ✓ Account ID OK Cancel7 Click OK.
8 The machine is registered to the PC and the machine name and model name are displayed in the Scanner List field.

text_image
Kyocera TWAIN Driver Scanner List Name Model Add... Delete Edit... Set or default About... Help CloseNOTE: Click Delete to delete the added machine. Click Edit to change names and other settings.
Setting the WIA Driver (Windows Vista™, Windows® Server 2008 and Windows 7)
Register this machine to the WIA Driver.
NOTE: The following is not necessary to register when using the machine possesses an IP address or host name that you have specified during installation of WIA Driver.
1 Click Start, Control Panel and then Scanners and Cameras. For Windows 7, in the search box, type scanners and cameras, and then click Scanners and Cameras.
2 Select the same name as this machine from WIA Drivers, and press Properties.

text_image
Scanners and Cameras If you do not see your device in the list, make sure it is connected to the computer and turned on, then choose Refresh. Scanners and Cameras Fyocers My Computer My Driver Refresh Add Device... Scan Profiles Properties Do I need to use this to install my scanner or camera? CloseNOTE: If Windows Security and User Account Control are displayed, no trouble should be found with operation after installing the driver and software we have provided. Continue installation.
3 Click the Settings tab and select Image Compression and the Compression Level. If user login administration is invalid, go to Step 5.

text_image
Kycena WIA Driver Properties General Color Management Settings About Image Compression(Color) Low High Compression Level 3 Low High Image Compression(Gray / Black & White) Compression Level 3 Low High Unit Inch Metric Authentication Light user name Password Account ID OK CancelNOTE: When the machine's IP address is unknown, contact Administrator.
4 Select the checkbox beside Authentication, enter Login User Name (up to 64 characters) and Password (up to 64 characters) and then click OK.
5 Click Close.
The machine is registered to the PC.
COMMAND CENTER (Settings for E-mail)
COMMAND CENTER is a tool used for tasks such as verifying the operating status of the machine and changing the settings for security, network printing, E-mail transmission and advanced networking.
NOTE: Here, information on the FAX settings has been omitted. For more information on using the FAX, refer to the FAX Operation Guide.
FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+.
The procedure for accessing COMMAND CENTER is explained below.
1 Launch your Web browser.
2 In the Address or Location bar, enter the machine's IP address.
E.g.) http://192.168.48.21/
The web page displays basic information about the machine and COMMAND CENTER as well as their current status.

text_image
Address: http://192.168.48.21/ KYOCERA COMMAND CENTE Start Basic Printer Scanner Ad3 Select a category from the navigation bar on the left of the screen. The values for each category must be set separately.
Enter the correct password to access pages other than the startup page. The default setting is admin00. The password can be changed.
For details, refer to the KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide.
Sending E-mail
Specifying the SMTP settings allows you to send images loaded onto this machine as E-mail attachments.
To use this function, this machine must be connected to a mail server using the SMTP protocol.
Before sending images loaded onto this machine as E-mail attachments, check the following:
- The network environment used to connect this machine to the mail server. A full-time connection via a LAN is recommended.
- SMTP Settings
Use COMMAND CENTER to register the IP address or host name of the SMTP server.
• If limits have been set on the size of E-mail messages, it may not be possible to send very large E-mails. - Sender address
The procedure for specifying the SMTP settings is explained below.
1 Click Advanced -> SMTP -> General.

text_image
KYOOCERA COMMAND CENTER Start Basic Printer Scanner FAX / i-FAX Jobs Document Box Advanced Advanced > E-mail: SMTP: General SMTP ► General | E-mail Recipient 1 | E-mail Recipient 2 | E-mail Recipient 3 SMTP Protocol Settings SMTP Protocol: On Off SMTP Port Number: 25 SMTP Server Name: mailserver.kyocera.com SMTP Server Timeout: 30 seconds Authentication Protocol: On POP before S POP3 E-mail Recipient 1 Management E-mail Recipient 2 SNMP E-mail Recipient 3 LDAP2 Enter the correct settings in each field.
The settings to be specified in the SMTP settings screen are shown below.
| Item Description | |
| SMTP Protocol | Enables or disables SMTP protocol. To use E-mail, this protocol must be enabled. |
| SMTP Port Number Set the SMTP Port Number or use the SMTP default port 25. | |
| SMTP Server Name | Enter the SMTP server IP address or its name. The maximum length of the SMTP server name and IP address is 64 characters. If entering the name, a DNS server address must also be configured. The DNS server address may be entered on the TCP/IP General tab. |
| SMTP Server Timeout Enter the default time out for the server in seconds. | |
| Authentication Protocol | Enables or disables the SMTP authentication protocol or sets POP before SMTP as the protocol. The SMTP authentication supports Microsoft Exchange 2000. |
| Authenticate as | Authentication can be set from three POP3 accounts or you can choose a different account. |
| Login User Name | When Other is selected for Authenticate, the login user name set here will be used for SMTP authentication. The maximum length of the login user name is 64 characters. |
| Login Password | When Other is selected for Authenticate, the password set here will be used for authentication. The maximum length of the login password is 64 characters. |
| POP before SMTP Timeout | Enter the timeout (in seconds) if you chose POP before SMTP as the Authentication Protocol. |
| Test | This will test if the SMTP connection can be successfully established. |
| E-mail Size Limit | Enter the maximum size of E-mail that can be sent in kilobytes. When the value is 0, the limitation for E-mail size is disabled. |
| Sender Address | Enter the E-mail address of the person responsible for the machine, such as the machine administrator, so that a reply or non-delivery report will go to a person rather than to the machine. The sender address must be entered correctly for SMTP authentication. The maximum length of the sender address is 128 characters. |
| Signature | Enter the signature. The signature is free form text that will appear at the end of the E-mail body. It is often used for further identification of the machine. The maximum length of the signature is 512 characters. |
| Domain Restriction | Enter the domain names that can be permitted or rejected. The maximum length of the domain name is 32 characters. You can also specify E-mail addresses. |
3 Click Submit.
Preparation for sending a document to a PC
Check the information that needs to be set on the machine and create a folder to receive the document on your computer. Screens of Windows 7 are used in the following explanation. The details of the screens will vary in other versions of Windows.
2
NOTE: Log on to Windows with administrator privileges.
Checking what to enter for [Host Name]
Check the name of the destination computer.
1 From the Start menu, select Computer and then System Properties.
Check the computer name in the window that appears.
In Windows XP, right-click My Computer and select Properties. The System Properties dialog box appears. Click the Computer Name tab in the window that appears and check the computer name.
If there is a workgroup
All characters appearing in "Full computer name" should be entered in Host Name. (Example: PC4050)
Computer name, domain, and workgroup settings
Computer name:
Full computer name:
Computer description:
Workgroup:

abcdnet
Windows activation
Computer name, domain, and workgroup settings
Computer name:
Full computer name:
Computer description:
Domain:

abcdnet
Windows activation
If there is a domain
The characters to the left of the first dot (.) in "Full computer name" should be entered in Host Name. (Example: pc4050)
2 After checking the computer name, click the (Close) button to close the System Properties screen.
In Windows XP, after checking the computer name, click the Cancel button to close the System Properties screen.
Checking what to enter for [Login User Name]
Check the domain name and user name for logging onto Windows.
1 From the Start menu, select All Programs (or Programs), Accessories and then Command Prompt.
The Command Prompt window appears.

text_image
Microsoft Windows [Version 6.1.7689] Copyright (c) 2007 Microsoft Corporation. All rights reserved. C:\Users\James.smith>net config workstation Computer name \PC4850 Bull Computer name DCB064 User name James.smith Workstation active on MetBI_tcpip_(XXXXXXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXXXXXXXXXX)2 At the Command Prompt, enter "net config workstation" and then click Enter.
Screen example: user name "james.smith" and domain name "ABCDNET"
Creating a Shared Folder
Check the domain name and user name for logging onto Windows.
NOTE: If there is a workgroup in System Properties, configure the settings below to limit folder access to a specific user or group.
1 From the Start menu, select Control Panel, Appearance and Personalization, and then Folder Options.

text_image
Ease of Access Center Accommodate low vision | Use screen reader | Turn on easy access keys | Turn High Contrast on or off Folder Options Specify single- or double-click to open | Show hidden files and folders Fonts Preview, delete, or show and hide fonts | Change Font Settings | Adjust ClearType text NVIDIA Control PanelWindows XP, click My Computer and select Folder Options in Tools.
2 Click the View tab and remove the checkmark from Use Sharing Wizard (Recommended) in Advanced settings.

text_image
Folder Options General View Search Folder views You can apply the view (such as Details or Icons) that you are using for this folder to all folders of this type: Apply to Folders Reset Folders Advanced settings: Launch folder windows in a separate process Restore previous folder windows at logon Show drive letters Show encrypted or compressed NTFS files in color Show pop-up description forfolder and desktop items Show preview handlers in preview pane Use email how to select items Use Sharing Wizard (Recommended) When typing into list view Automatically type into the Search Box Select the typed item in the view Restore Defaults OK Cancel ApplyIn Windows XP, click the View tab and remove the checkmark from Use Simple File Sharing (Recommended) in Advanced settings.
3 Click the OK button to close the Folder Options screen.
2
1 Create a folder on the local disk (C).
NOTE: For example, create a folder with the name "scannerdata" on the local disk (C).
2 Right-click the scannerdata folder and click Share and Advanced sharing. Click the Advanced Sharing button.
The scannerdata Properties dialog box appears.
In Windows XP, right-click the scannerdata folder and select Sharing and Security... (or Sharing).
3 Select the Share this folder checkbox and click the Permissions button.
The Permissions for scannerdata dialog box appears.
In Windows XP, select Share this folder and click the Permissions button.

text_image
Advanced Sharing ✓ Share this folder Settings Share name: scannerdata Add Remove Limit the number of simultaneous users to: 20 Comments: Permissions Caching OK Cancel Apply
text_image
Permissions for scannerdata Share Permissions Group or user names: Everyone Add... Remove Permissions for Everyone Allow Deny Full Control Change Read Learn about access control and permissions OK Cancel Apply4 Click the Add button.

text_image
Select Users or Groups Select this object type: Users, Groups, or Built-in security principals Object Types... From this location: PC4050 Locators... Enter the object names to select (examples): James smith Check Names Advanced... OK Cancel5 Enter the user name in the text box and click the OK button.

text_image
Permissions for scannerdata Share Permissions Group or user names: Everyone PC4050 (PC4050\james.smith) Add... Remove Permissions for james.smith Allow Deny Full Control Change Read Learn about access control and permissions OK Cancel Apply6 Select the entered user, select the Change and Read permissions, and click the OK button.
In Windows XP, go to step 8.
NOTE: "Everyone" gives sharing permission to everyone on the network. To strengthen security, it is recommended that you select Everyone and remove the Read permission checkmark.
7 Click the OK button in the Advanced Sharing screen to close the screen.

text_image
scannerdata Properties General Sharing Security Previous Versions Customize Object name: C:\scannerdata Group or user names: SYSTEM PC0391 (PC4050\james.smith) Administrators (PC4050\Administrators) To change permissions, click Edit. Edit... Permissions for SYSTEM Allow Deny Full control ✓ Modify ✓ Read & execute ✓ List folder contents ✓ Read ✓ Write ✓ For special permissions or advanced settings. click Advanced. Advanced Learn about access control and permissions Close Cancel Apply8 Click the Security tab and then click the Edit button.
In Windows XP, click the Security tab and then click the Add button.
2

text_image
Permissions for scannerdata Security Object name: C:\scannerdata Group or user names: SYSTEM james.smith (PC4050\james.smith) Administrators (PC4050\Administrators) Add... Remove Permissions for james.smith Allow Deny Full control Modify Read & execute List folder contents Read Learn about access control and permissions OK Cancel Apply9 Proceed in the same way as in step 5 to add a user to Group or user names.
10 Select the added user, select the Modify and Read & execute permissions, and then click the OK button.
Checking the [Path]
Check the share name of the shared folder that will be the destination for the document.
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Checking the [Path] - 1](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/96a8625fc1507732d6cedbd21ab36e303022d1ec4dc1591ac2f26335c51176ae.jpg)
text_image
\pc4050\scannerdata See more results \pc4050 Shut down1 Enter "\pc4050" in "Program and File Search" in the Start menu.
The Search Results screen opens.
In Windows XP, click Search in the Start menu, select All files and folders, and search for the destination computer to which the file will be sent.
In Search Companion, click Computers or people and then A computer on the network.
In the "Computer name:" text box, enter the name of the computer that you checked (pc4050) and then click Search.
2 Click "\pc4050\scannerdata" that appears in the search results.
In Windows XP, double-click the computer ("pc4050") that appears in the search results.
3 Check the folder that appears.
Check the address bar. The third and following text strings (▶) should be entered for the path.
In Windows XP, double-click the scannerdata folder and check the address bar. The text string to the right of the third backslash () should be entered in Path.
(Example: scannerdata)
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Checking the [Path] - 2](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/fbefc87147d6ea458ab175c8f6899858cae68ff0a7ee3f582a26f894637c7a30.jpg)
text_image
Network PC4050 scannerdata Organize Include in library Share with Burn New folder Favorites Name Date Desktop projectA 3/22, Downloads projectB 3/22, Recent PlacesNOTE: You can also specify a subfolder in the shared folder as the location where data is to be sent. In this case, "share name\name of folder in the shared folder" should be entered for the Path. In the example window above, "scannerdata\projectA" is the Path.
Configuring Windows Firewall (for Windows 7)
Permit sharing of files and printers and set the port used for SMB transmission.
NOTE: Log on to Windows with administrator privileges.
Checking file and printer sharing

text_image
Control Panel Home System and Security Network and Internet Hardware and Sound Programs User Accounts and Family Safety Appearance and Personalization Clock, Language, and Region Ease of Access Action Center Review your computer's status and resolve issues Change User Account Cont Troubleshoot common computer problems Restore your computer to an earlier Windows Firewall Check Firewall status Follow a program through Windows Firewall System View amount of RAM and processor speed Check the Windows Experience Index Allow remote access See the name of this computer Device Manager Windows Update Turn automatic updating on or off Check for updates View installed updates Power Options Require a password when the computer wakes Change what the power buttons Change when the computer sleeps Backup and Restore Back up your computer Restore files from backup Bill color Drive Encirculation1 From the Start menu, select Control Panel, System and Security, and Allow a program through Windows Firewall.
2
NOTE: If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click the Continue button.

text_image
Allow programs to communicate through Windows Firewall To add, change, or remove allowed programs and ports, click Change settings. What are the risks of allowing a program to communicate? Change settings Allowed programs and features: Name Home/Work (Private)/Public BranchCache - Content Retrieval (Uses HTTP) BranchCache - Hosted Cache Client (Uses HTTPS) BranchCache - Hosted Cache Server (Uses HTTPS) BranchCache - Peer Discovery (Uses WSD) Connect to a Network Projector Core Networking Distributed Transaction Coordination File and Printer Sharing HomeGroup ISCSI Service Media Center Extenders Netloon Service Details... Remove Allow another program... OK Cancel2 Click Change settings, select the File and Printer Sharing checkbox, and click OK.
Adding a port

text_image
Control Panel Home System and Security Network and Internet Hardware and Sound Programs User Accounts and Family Safety Appearance and Personalization Clock, Language, and Region Ease of Access Action Center Review your computer's status and resolve issues Change User Account Control settings | Troubleshoot common computer prc Restore your computer to an earlier time Windows Firewall Check firewall status Allow a program through Windows Firewall System View amount of RAM and processor speed Check the Windows Experience Info Allow remote access See the name of this computer Device Manager Windows Update Turn automatic updating on or off Check for updates View installed update Power Options Require a password when the computer wakes Change what the power buttons Change when the computer sleeps1 From the Start menu, select Control Panel, System and Security, and Check firewall status.

text_image
Control Panel Home Allow a program or feature through Windows Firewall Change notification settings Turn Windows Firewall on or off Restore defaults Advanced settings Troubleshoot my network Help protect your computer with Windows Firewall Windows Firewall can help prevent hackers or malicious software from gain through the Internet or a network. How does a firewall help protect my computer? What are network locations? Home or work (private) networks Networks at home or work where you know and trust the people and devi Windows Firewall state On Incoming connections Block all connections to2 Click Advanced settings.

text_image
Windows Firewall with Advanced Security File Edit View Help Windows Firewall with Advanced Security on Local Computer Windows Firewall with Advanced Security provides network security for Windows complex. Overview Domain Profile Windows Frameworks... Inbound connections that do not match scale are blocked Outbound connectors that do not match a role are shown Private Profile is Active3 Click Inbound Rules.

text_image
Windows Firewall with Advanced Security File Edit View Help Advanced Status Name Group Profile Enabled Action BranChCache Content Retouch (HTR) In BranchCache - Content Rate: All No Allow BranChCache Model Cache Server (MRT) BranchCache - Market Cache: All No Allow BranChCache Peer Discovery (WDS) In BranchCache - Peer Discount: All No Allow Connect to a Network Project (TCP) In Connect to a Network Project: Private, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (TCP) In Connect to a Network Project: Domain, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (WDS) In Connect to a Network Project: Private, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (WDS) In Connect to a Network Project: Domain, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (WDS) In Connect to a Network Project: Private, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (WDS) In Connect to a Network Project: Domain, No Allow Connect to a Network Project (WDS) In Connect to a Network Project: All, No Allow Actions New Policy... ✓ Forward by Guide ✓ Filter by Guide ✓ Filter by Group View Network Export Info... Help4 Click New Rule.

text_image
New Inbound Rule Wizard Rule Type Select the type of firewall rules to create. Steps: Rule Type Protocol and Port Action Profile Name What type of rule would you like to create? Program Rule that controls connections for a program. Port Rule that controls connections for a TCP or UDP port. Predefined: BranchCache - Content Retrieval (Users HTTP) Rule that controls connections for a Windows experience. Custom Custom site. Learn more about rule blocks < Back Next > Cancel5 Select Port and click Next.

text_image
New Inbound Rule Wizard Protocol and Ports Specify the protocols and ports to which this rule applies. Steps: Rule Type Protocol and Ports Action Profile Name Does this rule apply to TCP or UDP? TCP UDP Does this rule apply to all local ports or specific local ports ? All local ports Specific local ports 139 Example: 80, 445, 6000/5010 Learn more about protocol and ports < Back Next > Cancel6 Select TCP, select Specific local ports, enter "139", and click Next.

text_image
New Inbound Rule Wizard Action Specify the action to be taken when a connection matches the conditions specified in the rule. Steps: Rule Type Protocol and Policy Action Finish Name What action should be taken when a connection matches the specified conditions? Allow the connection This includes connections that are protected with iPsec as well as those are not. Allow the connection if it is secure This includes only connections that have been authenticated by using iPsec. Connections will be secured using the settings in iPsec properties and rules in the Connection Security Rule node. Controls Block the connection Learn more about actions < Back Next > Cancel7 Select Allow the connection and click Next.
2

text_image
New Inbound Rule Wizard Profile Specify the profiles for which this rule applies Steps: Rule Type Protocol and Parts Action Profile Name When does this rule apply? Domain Applies when a computer is connected to its corporate domain. Private Applies when a computer is connected to a private network location. Public Applies when a computer is connected to a public network location. Learn more about profiles < Back Next > Cancel8 Make sure all checkboxes are selected and click Next.

text_image
New Inbound Rule Wizard Name Specify the name and description of this rule. Steps: Rule Type Protocol and Pois Action Profile Name Name: Scan to $MB Description (optional): < Back Finish Cancel9 Enter "Scan to SMB" in "Name" and click Finish.
NOTE: In Windows XP or Windows Vista, follow the procedure below to set the port.
1 From the Start menu, select Control Panel, System and Security (or Security Center), and then Check Firewall Status) (or Windows Firewall).
If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click the Continue button.
2 Click the Exceptions tab and then the Add port... button.
3 Specify Add a Port settings.
Enter any name in "Name" (example: Scan to SMB). This will be the name of the new port. Enter "139" in "Port Number". Select TCP for "Protocol".
4 Click the OK button to close the Folder Options screen.
Loading Paper
Paper can be loaded standardly in the cassette and the multi purpose tray. A paper feeder is also available as an option (refer to Optional Equipment on Appendix-2).
Before Loading Paper

text_image
Illustration showing four sequential steps of a fabric or mechanical process, labeled 1 to 4 with arrows indicating direction and rotation.When you open a new package of paper, fan the sheets to separate them slightly prior to loading in the following steps.
1 Bend the whole set of sheets to swell them in the middle.
2 Hold the stack at both ends and stretch it while keeping the entire stack swelled.
3 Raise the right and left hands alternately to create a gap and feed air between the papers.
4 Finally, align the papers on a level, flat table.
If the paper is curled or folded, straighten it before loading. Paper that is curled or folded may cause a jam.
CAUTION: If you copy onto used paper (paper already used for copying), do not use paper that is stapled or clipped together. This may damage the machine.
NOTE: If printouts are curled or not neatly stapled, turn the stack in the cassette upside down.
Avoid exposing opened paper to high temperatures and high humidity as dampness can be a cause of problems. Seal any remaining paper after loading in the multi purpose tray or cassettes back in the paper storage bag.
If the machine will not be used for a prolonged period, protect all paper from humidity by removing it from the cassettes and sealing it in the paper storage bag.
NOTE: If you use special paper such as letterhead, paper with holes or paper with pre-prints like logo or company name, refer to Paper on Appendix-9.
Loading Paper in the Cassettes
The standard cassette will each hold plain paper, recycled paper or color paper.
The standard cassette holds up to 500 sheets of A4 or smaller plain paper (80 g/m ^2 ).
The following paper sizes are supported: Legal, Oficio II, Letter, Executive, Statement, A4, B5, A5, A6, Folio, and 16K.
IMPORTANT:
- You should not use inkjet printer paper or any paper with a special surface coating. (Such papers may cause paper jams or other faults.)
- When using media types other than plain paper (such as recycled or colored paper), always specify the media type setting. (Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes on page 2-49) The cassettes can hold paper with weights up to 120g / m^2 .
- Do not load thick paper that is heavier than 120 ~g / m^-2 in the cassettes. Use the multi purpose tray for paper that is heavier than 120 ~g / m^2 .
NOTE: Statement and A6 can only be used in cassette 1.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting into a computer motherboard with a downward arrow indicating compression (no text or symbols present)1 Pull the cassette all the way out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: When pulling the cassette out of the printer, ensure it is supported and does not fall out.

text_image
A5 B5 A4 LTR-LGL A4 LTR B5 A5Standard paper sizes are marked on the inside of the cassette.

text_image
Technical diagram showing mechanical assembly with labeled component A4, including cross-sectional views and hand gesture.2 Turn the paper size dial so that the size of the paper you are going to use appears in the paper size window.
NOTE: When the paper size dial is set to OTHER the paper size must be set into the printer on the operation panel. Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media on page 2-49.

text_image
Diagram showing a hand inserting a device into a device with directional arrows indicating movement or change.3 Pull the release lever on the left side guide and slide to the desired paper size.
2

text_image
Diagram of a computer monitor layout with an inset showing hand placement and directional arrow indicating movement or navigation.4 If you are going to set paper that is longer than A4, pull out the extension cassettes pushing the lock lever one by one and adjust them to the desired paper size.

text_image
Diagram of a device interior with labeled components and an inset showing hand insertion mechanism5 Pull the release lever and slide the paper length guide to the desired paper size.
When using non-standard size paper, move the paper width guide and paper length guide all the way out, insert the paper, then adjust the paper width guides and paper length guide to the size of the paper. Adjust them so that they are in light contact with the paper.

text_image
Diagram illustrating a device's internal structure with a no-smoking symbol, showing part assembly and cleaning steps.6 Place the paper in the paper cassette. Ensure the side to be printed is facing down and the paper is not folded, curled, or damaged.

natural_image
Top-down schematic of a device layout with two green ventilation units and a central screen (no text or symbols)NOTE: Do not load more paper than will fit under the load limits on the paper width guides.
The cassette holds up to 500 sheets of A4 or smaller plain paper (80 g/m ^2 ).

natural_image
Technical line drawing of a mechanical device with two arms and a central screen (no text or symbols)7 Set the stack of paper so that it is under the clips as shown.

natural_image
Illustration of hands inserting a green card into a printer (no text or symbols visible)8 Insert the cassette into the slot in the printer. Push it straight in as far as it will go.

text_image
Diagram showing a printer with a magnified view of its internal components, including a green tool and labeled parts.There is a paper gauge on the right side of the front of the paper cassette to indicate the remaining paper supply. When paper is exhausted, the pointer will go down to the level of L(empty).
Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose Tray
The multi purpose tray will hold up to 100 sheets of A4 or smaller plain paper (80 g/m ^2 ).
The multi purpose tray accepts paper sizes from A4 to A6 and Hagaki and from Legal to Statement-R, and 16K. Be sure to use the multi purpose tray when you print on any special paper.
IMPORTANT: When using media types other than plain paper (such as recycled or colored paper), always specify the media type setting. (Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-51.) If you are using a paper weight of 106g / m^2 or more, set the media type to Thick.
The capacity of the multi purpose tray is as follows.
- A4 or smaller plain paper (80 g/m ^2 ), recycled paper or color paper: 100 sheets
- Hagaki: 1 sheet
- OHP film: 1 sheet
- Envelope: 5 sheets
NOTE: When you load custom size paper, enter the paper size by referring to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-51.
When you use special paper such as transparencies or thick paper, select the media type by referring to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-51.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer's internal structure showing two arrows pointing to internal components (no text or symbols present)1 Pull the MP tray towards you until it stops.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer's internal structure with a hand pressing a green tray, showing no text or symbols.2 Pull out the extension.

text_image
A4 LTR B5 A53 Adjust the position of the paper width guides on the MP tray. Standard paper sizes are marked on the MP tray. For standard paper sizes, slide the paper width guides to the position marked correspondingly.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer's front view showing internal components and a green cover with an upward arrow (no text or symbols)4 Align the paper with the paper width guides and insert as far as it will go.
NOTE: If the paper is considerably curled in one direction, for example, if the paper is already printed on one side, try to roll the paper in the opposite direction to counteract the curl. Printed sheets will then come out flat.
| Correct | ![]() | ![]() |
| Incorrect | [IMAGE][IMAGE] | ![]() |
When loading envelope, place with the envelope flap closed and keep the printing side face-up. Insert envelope against the guide with the flap on the front or left side until they stop.
5 Set the MP tray paper size on the printer's operation panel. Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media on page 2-49.
Loading Envelopes
5 envelope may be loaded in the multi purpose tray.
Acceptable envelope sizes are as follows.
| Acceptable Envelope Size | |
| Hagaki 148×100 (mm) | |
| Oufuku Hagaki 148×200 (mm) | |
| Youkei 2 162×114 (mm) | |
| Youkei 4 235×105 (mm) | |
| Monarch 3 7/8"×7 1/2" | |
| Envelope #10 (Commercial #10) 4 1/8"×9 1/2" | |
| Envelope DL 110×220 (mm) | |
| Envelope C5 162×229 (mm) | |
| Executive 7 1/4"×10 1/2" | |
| Envelope #9 (Commercial #9) 3 7/8"×8 7/8" | |
| Envelope #6 (Commercial #6 3/4) 3 5/8"×6 1/2" |
To print on envelopes, press the envelope switches in the rear cover to change to envelope mode.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green card into a computer monitor (no text or symbols visible)1 Open the rear cover.

natural_image
Technical diagram of a computer tower with hand operating keys and two circular insets showing internal components (no text or symbols present)2 Press the two envelope switches (green) to change the paper feed mode to envelope mode.

CAUTION: The fuser unit inside the printer is hot. Do not touch it with your hands as it may result in burn injury.

natural_image
Illustration of hands inserting a green card into a computer case (no text or symbols visible)3 Close the rear cover.
4 Follow the steps of Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-45.
NOTE: When printing on plain paper, press the two envelope switches (green) again to change the paper feed mode to plain paper mode.
When you load envelopes or cardstock in the multi purpose tray
Load envelope with the print side facing up.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Start"] --> B["Close the flap."]
B --> C["Return postcard (Oufuku Hagaki)"]
B --> D["Cardstock (Hagaki)"]
B --> E["Portrait form envelopes"]
B --> F["Landscape form envelopes"]
NOTE: Use unfolded return postcard (Oufuku Hagaki).
IMPORTANT: How to load envelopes (orientation and facing) will differ depending on the type of envelope. Be sure to load it in correctly, otherwise printing may be done in the wrong direction or on the wrong face.
NOTE: When you load envelopes in the multi purpose tray, select the envelope type by referring to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-51.
Specifying Paper Size and Media
The default paper size setting for cassette, for multi purpose tray and for the optional paper feeder (cassettes 2 to 4) is [Letter], and the default media type setting is [Plain].
To fix the type of paper to be used in cassettes, specify the paper size and media type setting. (Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes on page 2-49.)
To fix the type of paper to be used in multi purpose tray, specify the paper size setting. (Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2-51.)
Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes
To fix the type of paper to be used in cassette or the optional paper feeder (cassettes 2 to 4), specify the paper size. Also, you use a media type other than plain paper, specify the media type setting.
| Selection Item Selectable Size/Type | |
| Paper Size Select from the standard sizes. Selectable paper sizes are as follows.Inch size: Letter, Legal, Statement* and Oficio IIMetric size: A4, A5, A6*, B5, Folio, and 16K | |
| Media Type Plain, Rough, Recycled, Preprinted, Bond, Color,Prepunched, Letterhead, High Quality andCustom 1~8 |
* Statement and A6 can only be used in cassette 1.
** To change to a media type other than Plain, refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16.
NOTE: If using the FS-3140MFP+, the available media types for printing received faxes are as shown below. Plain, Recycled, Bond, Color, High Quality and Rough
When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER, a paper size can be set for the cassette.


text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
When you are performing user management and have not logged in, a login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password to log in.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
2 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: ◆ OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select from [Cassette 1 Set.] to [Cassette 4 Set.].
NOTE: [Cassette 2], [Cassette 3] and [Cassette 4] are shown when the optional cassettes are installed.
Follow the steps below when you select the main unit cassette (Cassette 1). Operate in a similar fashion when you select an optional cassette (Cassette 2 to 4).
7 Press the OK key. The Cassette 1 Set. menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Cassette 1 Size].
9 Press the OK key. Cassette 1 Size appears.
10 Press the or key to select the desired paper size and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Cassette 1 Set. menu.

text_image
Cassette 1 Set.: 01 Cassette 1 Size 02 Cassette 1 Type [ Exit ]
text_image
Cassette 1 Size: 01 *Letter 02 Legal 03 Statement
text_image
Cassette 1 Set.: 01 Cassette 1 Size 02 Cassette 1 Type [ Exit ]
text_image
Cassette 1 Type: OK [0 1]*Plain 0 2 Rough 0 3 Recycled11 Press the or key to select [Cassette 1 Type].
12 Press the OK key. Cassette 1 Type appears.
13 Press the or key to select the desired paper type and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Cassette 1 Set. menu.
Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray
To fix the type of paper to be used in the multi purpose tray, specify the paper size. When using other than a plain paper, specify the media type.
| Item Description | ||
| Paper Size | Standard Sizes | Select from the standard sizes. Selectable paper sizes are as follows.Inch size: Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, and Oficio IIMetric size: A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5,Envelope #10 (Commercial #10), Envelope #9(Commercial #9), Envelope #6 (Commercial #6 3/4),Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki,Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2 and Custom |
| Size Entry | Enter the size not included in the standard size.Selectable paper sizes are as follows.Inch sizeX (Horizontal): 5.83~14.02" (in 0.01" increments),Y (Vertical): 2.16~8.50" (in 0.01" increments)Metric sizeX (Horizontal): 148~356 mm (in 1mm increments),Y (Vertical): 70~216 mm (in 1mm increments) | |
| Media Type Selectable media types are as follows.Plain, Transparency, Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled,Preprinted, Bond, Cardstock, Color, Prepunched,Letterhead, Envelope, Thick, High Quality and Custom1~8 | ||
* To change to a media type other than Plain, refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16.
NOTE: If using the FS-3140MFP+ and the multi purpose tray is used to print a received FAX, the available media types are as shown below.
Plain, Recycled, Bond, Color, High Quality and Rough


text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK 01 Custom Orig.Size 02 Def. Orig. Size 03 Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]
text_image
MP Tray Set.: 01 MP Tray Size 02 MP Tray Type [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
When you are performing user management and have not logged in, a login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password to log in.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
2 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
3 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Set.].
7 Press the OK key. The MP Tray Set. menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Size].

text_image
MP Tray Size: 01 *Letter 02 Legal 03 Statement9 Press the OK key. MP Tray Size appears.
2

text_image
MP Tray Set.: 01 MP Tray Size 02 MP Tray Type [ Exit ]10 Press the or key to select the desired paper size and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the MP Tray Set. menu.
11 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Type].

text_image
MP Tray Type: [0 1] *Plain [0 2] Transparency [0 3] Rough12 Press the OK key. MP Tray Type appears.
13 Press the or key to select the desired paper type and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the MP Tray Set. menu.
Loading Originals
Follow the steps below to load originals for copying, sending or storing.
Placing Originals on the Platen
You may place books or magazines on the platen in addition to ordinary sheet originals.

natural_image
Illustration of a printer with a green cover and a black arrow indicating the open lid (no text or symbols present)1 Open the document processor.
NOTE: Before opening the document processor, be sure that there are no originals left on the original table or on the original eject table. Originals left on the original table or on the original eject table may fall off when the document processor is opened.
Keep the document processor open if the original is 40 mm or thicker.

natural_image
Line drawing of hands operating a mechanical device with open lid (no text or symbols)2 Place the original. Put the scanning side facedown and align it flush against the original size indicator plate with the back left corner as the reference point.
3 Close the document processor.
IMPORTANT: Do not push the original cover forcefully when you close it. Excessive pressure may crack the platen glass. Do not close the document processor when the original is 40 mm or thicker.
NOTE: Shadows may be produced around the edges and in the middle of open-faced originals.
CAUTION: Do not leave the document processor open as there is a danger of personal injury.

Loading Originals in the Document Processor
The document processor automatically scans each sheet of multiple originals. Both sides of two-sided originals are scanned.
Originals Supported by the Document Processor
The document processor supports the following types of originals.
| Weight 50 to 120 g/m ^2 (duplex: 50 to 110 g/m ^2 ) |
| Size Maximum A4 to Minimum A5Maximum Legal to Minimum Statement |
| Capacity Plain paper, Colored paper, Recycled paper,High quality paper: 50 sheetsThick paper (110 g/m ^2 ): 36 sheetsThick paper (120 g/m ^2 ): 33 sheetsArt paper: 1 sheet |
Originals Not Supported by the Document Processor
Do not use the document processor for the following types of originals.
- Soft originals such as vinyl sheets
• Transparencies such as OHP film - Carbon paper
• Originals with very slippery surfaces
• Originals with adhesive tape or glue - Wet originals
• Originals with correction fluid which is not dried - Irregularly shaped (non-rectangular) originals
• Originals with cut-out sections - Crumpled paper
- Originals with folds (Straighten the folds before loading. Failure to do so may cause the originals to jam).
- Originals bound with clips or staples (Remove the clips or staples and straighten curls, wrinkles or creases before loading. Failure to do so may cause the originals to jam).
How to Load Originals
IMPORTANT: Before loading originals, be sure that there are no originals left on the original eject table. Originals left on the original eject table may cause the new originals to jam.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer with arrows indicating process flow (no text or symbols present)1 Adjust the original width guides to fit the originals.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a card into a printer with an arrow indicating the card's direction (no text or symbols present)2 Place the originals. Put the side to be scanned (or the first side of two-sided originals) face-up. Slide the leading edge into the document processor as far as it will go.
IMPORTANT: Confirm that the original width guides exactly fit the originals. If there is a gap, readjust the original width guides. The gap may cause the originals to jam.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer with a green cover and control panel, showing no readable text or symbols.Ensure that loaded originals do not exceed the level indicator. Exceeding the maximum level may cause the originals to jam (see the figure).
Originals with punched holes or perforated lines should be placed in such a way that the holes or perforations will be scanned last (not first).
3 Basic Operation
This chapter explains the following operations.
- Login/Logout.... 3-2
• One-Touch Keys and Program Keys...... 3-3 - Message Display 3-6
- Copying 3-7
- Printing - Printing from Applications 3-16
- Sending 3-18
- Confirm Destination Screen 3-25
- Specifying Destination 3-26
- Canceling Jobs.... 3-29
- Checking Remaining Toner and Paper...... 3-30
Login/Logout
If user login administration is enabled, it is necessary to enter the login user name and password to use the machine.
NOTE: You will be unable to log in if you forget your login user name or login password. In this event, log in with administrator privileges and change your login user name or login password.
Login
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 If the screen shown appears during operations, enter the login user name.
2 Press the ▽ key. The input cursor moves to Login Password.
3 Enter the login password.
Press the key to move the input cursor to Login User Name.
4 Check the login user name and password are correct, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The following administrator is registered in the machine at the factory.
Login User Name: 4000
Login Password: 4000
Logout

To logout from the machine, press the Logout to return to the login user name/password entry screen.
One-Touch Keys and Program Keys
The one-touch keys and program keys on the operation panel are described below.
One-Touch Key
Register destinations to one-touch keys, and you can enter the desired destination by pressing the applicable one-touch key. For registering a destination to a one-touch key, refer to Adding a Destination on One-touch Key on page 8-116.
Entering Destination with One-touch Key

text_image
Address Entry: ABC [ Text ]1 In Address Entry, press the one-touch key where the desired destination is registered.
Recalling from One-touch Keys 1 to 11
Press the one-touch key where the destination is registered.
Recalling from One-touch Keys 12 to 22
Press the Shift Lock key to turn on the lamp next to the keys, and then press the one-touch key where the destination is registered.
2 The destination registered to the one-touch key is recalled and automatically entered on the screen.

text_image
Address Entry OK 5y@##########.co.jp ABC [ Text ]IMPORTANT: Any destination already entered is overwritten.
Program Keys
Settings of various functions frequently used for copying and sending can be collectively registered as a program. Then, you can change the current settings of various functions to the registered settings by just pressing one of the Program 1 to 4 keys.
NOTE: The following functions are already registered in Program 1 key. This function allows you to copy the front and back sides of ID card or other document that is smaller than Statement or A5 size onto a single page. Although the functions are deleted by overwriting Program 1 key, you can register the same settings using the Function Menu key.
Combine: 2 in 1
Continuous Scan: On
Original Size: Statement (Inch models)/A5 (Metric models)
Paper Selection: Cassette 1
Zoom Options: Auto Zoom

text_image
Program I. ID Card Copy Power # # LogoutID Card Copy is printed on the Program 1 key. When the functions are deleted by overwriting Program 1 key, seal the label supplied with the machine and write the function name in it.
Registering Settings

text_image
Registered. →Program 1After making settings, press and hold the one of the Program 1 to 4 keys where you want to register the settings for 3 seconds. The current settings are registered to the selected program key.
Changing and Deleting Settings

text_image
Menu: [0 1] Overwrite [0 2] Delete1 Press and hold the one of the Program 1 to 4 keys where the settings you want to change/delete are registered for 3 seconds. Menu appears.

text_image
Overwrite. Are you sure? →Program 1 [ Yes ] [ No ]2 To replace the registered settings with the current settings, press the or key to select [Overwrite] and then press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key) to change the settings.

text_image
Delete. Are you sure? →Program 1 [ Yes ] [ No ]To delete the registered settings, press the or key to select [Delete] and then press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key) to delete the registered settings.
Recalling Settings
Press the one of the Program 1 to 4 keys where the settings you want to recall are registered. The current settings of various functions are replaced with the registered settings.
ID Card Copy
The procedure for using ID Card copying is explained below.

text_image
Copy1 Press the Copy key when the Copy key/indicator is off.
NOTE: If the Message Display is turned off, press the Power key and wait for the machine to warm up.
3
2 Place the original on the platen.
Put the scanning side facedown in the center of Statement or A5 size scanning area.
NOTE: For loading instructions, refer to Loading Originals on page 2-54.
Recalled. →Program 1
3 Press the Program 1.
The ID Card Copy function is recalled.
4 Press the Start key. Scanning begins.
5 Turn over the original on the platen and press the Start key.
6 After scanning all originals, press [End Scan] (the Right Select key) to start copying.
Message Display
The following examples explain the messages and icons used on the message display.

text_image
Ready to copy. Copies: 1 A4 A4 100% [ Zoom ] [ ]Copier Screen Send Screen

text_image
Ready to send. Dest.: 1 sally@########## 1-sided [ Duplex ] [ ] 8 9 4 5| Reference number | Meaning |
| 1 | Indicates the current status of the machine. Also displays the title of the current menu whenever the operation panel is being used. |
| 2 | Displays an icon that indicates the currently selected source of paper feed. The meaning of each icon is as indicated below. |
| The standard paper cassette is currently selected. When this icon is displayed as there is no paper is the cassette. | |
| The paper cassette for the optional paper feeder is currently selected.When this icon is displayed as there is no paper is the cassette. | |
| The MP Tray is currently selected. When this icon is displayed as there is no paper is the MP Tray. | |
| 3 | Displays the size of the original(s). |
| 4 | Displays the current setting when there is a corresponding menu that can be selected using the left or right Select keys. |
| 5 | Displays the title of the corresponding menu that can be selected using the left or right Select keys. |
| 6 | Displays the number of copies. |
| 7 | Displays the paper size to be copied. |
| 8 | Displays the number of destinations. |
| 9 | Displays the destination. |
Copying
Follow the steps as below for basic copying.

text_image
Copy
natural_image
Line drawing of hands operating a device with open lid (no text or symbols)
text_image
Ready to copy. Copies: 1 Letter □ ▶ Letter ▼ 100% [ Zoom ] [ Paper ] Paper source
text_image
Paper Selection: 01 * Auto 02 1 A4 Plain 03 2 A5 Plain
text_image
.# 1 ABC DEF 2 3 GHI JKL MNO 4 5 6 PQRS TUV WXYZ 7 8 9 +↔A ... Symbols */. 0 #
text_image
Start1 Press the Copy key when the Copy key/indicator is off.
NOTE: If the Message Display is turned off, press the Power key and wait for the machine to warm up.
2 Place the originals on the platen or in the document processor.
NOTE: For loading instructions, refer to Loading Originals on page 2-54.
3 The paper source for copying is the location displayed on the panel.
When you need to change the paper source, use the Paper Selection menu. If [Auto] is selected, the most suitable paper source is automatically selected.
For specifying the paper source, refer to Paper Selection on page 4-3.
4 Use the numeric keys to enter the copy quantity. Specify the desired number up to 999.
5 Press the Start key to start copying.
6 Remove the finished copies from the top tray.
Adjusting Density
Use this procedure to adjust the density when copying.
| Density Adjustment Option | Description |
| Manual Adjust density using 7 | levels. |
| Auto Optimum density is selected according to the density of the original. | |
NOTE: You may choose Auto mode as the default setting (refer to Density on page 8-45).
The procedure for adjusting the density of copies is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Paper Selection [02] Collate [03] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Density: 01 Auto 02 *Manual
text_image
Manual: 03 Lighter -1 04 Normal 0 05 Darker +11 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Density].
3 Press the OK key. Density appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Manual].
5 Press the OK key.
When [Manual] is selected, Manual appears. Press the or key to select your desired density and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
6 Press the Start key. Copying begins.
Selecting Image Quality
Select image quality suited to the type of original.
The table below shows the quality options.
| Image Quality Option Description | |
| Text+Photo For originals | with both text and photographs. |
| Photo For photos taken with a camera. | |
| Text For originals primarily consisting of text. | |
3
The procedure for selecting the quality of copies is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]1 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Original Image].
3 Press the OK key. Original Image appears.

text_image
Original Image: [0 1] *Text+Photo [0 2] Photo [0 3] Text4 Press the or key to select the image quality suited to the type of original.
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
6 Press the Start key. Copying begins.
Zoom Copying
Adjust the magnification to reduce or enlarge the original image. The following zoom options are available.
Auto Zoom

flowchart
graph LR
A["Letter-R"] -->|129%| B["A5"]
A -->|141%| B
A -->|64%| C["A4"]
A -->|70%| D["A5"]
Automatically reduces or enlarges the original image suitably to the selected paper size.
Zoom Entry

bar
| Category | Value (%) | |---|---| | Bar 1 | 25 | | Bar 2 | 400 |Manually reduces or enlarges the original image in 1% increments between 25% and 400%.
Standard Zoom
Reduces or enlarges at preset magnifications.
The following magnifications are available.
| Model Zoom Level (OriginalCopy) | ||
| Inch Models | Standard 1 | 00%, 400% (Max.), 200%, 129% (Statement >> Letter),78% (Legal >> Letter), 64% (Letter >> Statement), 50%,25% (Min.) |
| Other 141% (A5 >> A4), 115% (B5 >> A4), 90% (Folio >> A4),86% (A4 >> B5), 70% (A4 >> A5) | ||
| Metric Models | Standard 1 | 00%, 400% (Max.), 200%, 141% (A5 >> A4),115% (B5 >> A4), 86% (A4 >> B5), 70% (A4 >> A5),50%, 25% (Min.) |
| Other 129% (Statement >> Letter), 90% (Folio >> A4),78% (Legal >> Letter), 64% (Letter >> Statement) | ||
| Metric Models (Asia Pacific) | Standard 1 | 00%, 400% (Max.), 200%, 141% (A5 >> A4),115% (B5 >> A4), 90% (Folio >> A4), 86% (A4 >> B5),70% (A4 >> A5), 50%, 25% (Min.) |
| Other 129% (Statement >> Letter), 78% (Legal >> Letter),64% (Letter >> Statement) | ||
The procedure for using zoom copying is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Paper Selection [02] Collate [03] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Zoom: [0 1] * 100% 0 2 Auto 0 3 Standard Zoom
text_image
Standard Zoom: 0 4 129% STMT >> LTR 0 5 *100% 0 6 78% LGL >> LTR
text_image
Zoom Entry: (25 - 400) 200%1 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Zoom].
3 Press the OK key. Zoom appears.
4 Press the or key to select the desired magnification.
To copy in the same size as the original, select [100%].
To select automatic zoom, select [Auto].
To use fixed magnifications, select [Standard Zoom] and press the OK key. Standard Zoom appears. Press the or key to select the desired magnification. If you select [Other] and press the OK key, you can select from additional magnifications.
To enter a magnification, select [Zoom Entry] and press the OK key. Zoom Entry appears. Use the numeric keys to enter the any magnification.
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
6 Press the Start key. Copying begins.
Duplex Copying
Produce two-sided copies. The following duplex options are available.
You can also create single-sided copies from two-sided originals or originals with facing pages such as books. The following modes are available.
One-sided to Two-sided

text_image
Original Copy
flowchart
graph LR
A["Original Copy"] --> B["A"]
B --> C["B"]
Produces two-sided copies from one-sided originals. In case of an odd number of originals, the back side of the last copy will be blank.
The following binding options are available.
A Binding Left/Right: Images on the second sides are not rotated.
B Binding Top: Images on the second sides are rotated 180^ . Copies can be bound on the top edge, facing the same orientation when turning the pages.
Two-sided to One-sided

flowchart
graph LR
A["Original Copy"] --> B["1"]
A --> C["2"]
Copies each side of a two-sided original onto two individual sheets.
The following binding options are available.
- Binding Left/Right: Images on the second sides are not rotated.
- Binding Top: Images on the second sides are rotated 180^ .
Two-sided to Two-sided

text_image
Original CopyProduces two-sided copies from two-sided originals.
NOTE: The paper sizes supported in Two-sided to Two-sided are Legal, Letter, Oficio II, Executive, A4, B5, A5 and Folio.
The procedure for using two-sided/duplex copying is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Paper Selection [0 2] Collate [0 3] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Duplex: [0 1]*1-sided>>1-sided [0 2] 1-sided>>2-sided [0 3] 2-sided>>1-sied
text_image
Finish. Binding: 01 * Left/Right 02 Top
text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK 01 Top Edge Top 02 * Top Edge left
text_image
Orig. Binding: 01 * Left/Right 02 Top
text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK 01 Top Edge Top 02 * Top Edge left1 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Duplex].
3 Press the OK key. Duplex appears.
4 Press the or key to select the desired duplex copying mode.
If you select [1-sided>>2-sided], press [Detail] (the Right Select key) and you can select the binding edge of the finished copies and the original setting orientation.
After pressing the OK key, select the binding edge of the finished copies and the original setting orientation.
If you select [2-sided>>1-sided], press [Detail] (the Right Select key) and you can select the binding edge of the original and the original setting orientation.
After pressing the OK key, select the binding edge of the original and finished copies, and the original setting orientation.

text_image
Orig. Binding: [0 1] * Left/Right [0 2] TopIf you select [2-sided>>2-sided], press [Detail] (the Right Select key) and you can select the binding edge of the original.

text_image
Finish. Binding: [0 1] * Left/Right [0 2] TopAfter pressing the OK key, select the binding edge of the finished copies.

text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK [0 1] * Top Edge Top [0 2] Top Edge leftAfter pressing the OK key, select the original setting orientation.
| Scanning... | |
| Job No.: | 9999 |
| Page(s): | 1 |
| [ Cancel ] |
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
6 Press the Start key. Copying begins.
If the original is placed on the platen, replace it with the next one before pressing the Start key.
Set original
and press Start key.
Job No.: 9999
Page(s): 3
[ Cancel ] [End Scan]
If there is no next original, press [End Scan] (the Right Select key). Copying begins.
Collate Copying
The machine can collate at the same time as it copies.
You can use the Collate copy function for tasks such as those shown below.

text_image
Original CopyScan multiple originals and deliver complete sets of copies as required according to page number.
3

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]The procedure for using collate copying is explained below.
1 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.

text_image
Collate: 01 Off 02 *On2 Press the or key to select [Collate].
3 Press the OK key. Collate appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
6 Use the numeric keys to enter the number of copies, and press the Start key Copying begins.
Printing - Printing from Applications
Follow the steps below to print documents from applications.
NOTE: To print the document from applications, install the printer driver on your computer from the supplied DVD-ROM (Product Library).

text_image
Print Printer Name: Status: Idle Type: Where: Comment: Properties Find Printer... Print to file Manual duplex Page range All Current page Selection Pages Enter page numbers and/or page ranges separated by commas. For example, 1,3,5-12 Copies Number of copies: Collage Print what: Document Print: All pages in range Zoom Pages per sheet: 1 page Scale to paper size: No Scaling Options... OK Cancel1 Create a document using an application.
2 Click File and select Print in the application. The Print dialog box appears.
3 Click the ▼ button next to the Name field and select this machine from the list.
4 Enter the desired print quantity in the Number of copies box. Enter any number up to 999.
When there is more than one document, select Collate to print out one by one in the sequence of the page numbers.
5 Click Properties button. The Properties dialog box appears.
6 Select the Basic tab and click Page Size button to select the paper size.
To print on the special paper such as thick paper or transparency, click the Media Type menu and select the media type.

text_image
Printing Preferences Quick Print Basic Layout Imaging Publishing Advanced Paper Print size: Letter: [100%] Source: Auto source selection Media type: Unspecified Destination: Printer default Page Sizes... Orientation Portrait Landscape Rotated Copies: 1 Collate Duplex: Print on both sides Flip on long edge Flip on short edge Quality: EcoPrint Print preview KYOCERA Profile... OK Cancel7 Click Source and select the paper source.
NOTE: If you choose Auto source selection, papers are supplied automatically from the paper source loaded with paper of optimum size and type. To print on special paper such as envelope or thick paper, place it on the multi purpose tray and select MP Tray.
8 Select paper orientation, either Portrait or Landscape, to match the orientation of the document.
Selecting Rotated will print the document rotated 180°.
9 Click OK button to return to the Print dialog box.
10 Click OK button to start printing.
Printing Using Half Speed Mode
When printing on a paper with a smooth surface or thick paper, adjust the printing speed using the printer driver. For details, refer to Printer Driver User Guide.
Sending
This machine can send a scanned image as an attachment to an E-mail message or to a PC linked to the network. In order to do this, it is necessary to register the sender and destination (recipient) address on the network.
A network environment which enables the machine to connect to a mail server is required. It is recommended that a Local Area Network (LAN) be used to assist with transmission speed and security issues.
At the same time as you send a scanned image, you can also print the image or send it to the Document Box.
To use the Scanning Function perform the following steps:
- Program the settings, including the E-mail setting on the machine.
- Use COMMAND CENTER (the internal HTML web page) to register the IP address, the host name of the SMTP server, and the recipient.
- Register the destination in the Address Book or One-touch keys.
- When the PC Folder (SMB/FTP) is selected, it is necessary to share the destination folder. For setting-up the PC Folder, contact your administrator.
- Detailed transmission settings (to select a Document Box as the destination or to print and send the image at the same time)
Follow the steps below for basic sending. The following four options are available.
- Send as E-mail: Sends a scanned original image as an E-mail attachment...page 3-19
- Send to Folder (SMB): Stores a scanned original image in a shared folder of any PC...page 3-21
- Send to Folder (FTP): Stores a scanned original image in a folder of an FTP server...page 3-21
- Image Data Scanning with TWAIN / WIA: Scan the document using a TWAIN or WIA compatible application program...page 5-25
NOTE: Different sending options can be specified in combination. Refer to Sending to Different Types of Destinations (Multi Sending) on page 3-28.
Send as E-mail
Sends a scanned original image as an E-mail attachment.
NOTE:
- You must have a network environment in which this machine can connect to a mail server. It is recommended that the machine be used in an environment in which it can connect to the mail server at any time over a LAN.
- Access the COMMAND CENTER beforehand and specify the settings required for sending e-mail. For details, see COMMAND CENTER (Settings for E-mail) on page 2-28.
• Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Send (E-mail Folder FAX)
text_image
Send to: 01 E-mail 02 Folder(SMB) 03 Folder(FTP)1 Press the Send key.
Displays the screen for sending.
2 Press the or key to select [E-mail].
3 Press the OK key. Address Entry appears.

text_image
Address Entry: ABC [ Text ]4 Enter the destination e-mail address.
NOTE: Destination can be specified using the Address Book or the One-touch keys. Refer to Specifying Destination on page 3-26.
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
NOTE: If the screen for confirming the entry of a new destination (page 8-88) is set to [On], a screen to confirm the entered e-mail address appears. Enter the same e-mail address again and press the OK key.
6 If there are additional destinations, press the Add Destination key. Repeat steps 2 to 5 to enter additional destinations. Up to 100 destinations can be specified.
Ready to send.
Dest.: 1
☑:sally@#########
1-sided 300x300dpi
[ Duplex ] [ScanRes.]

text_image
Dest. Confirm.: ✓ Morgan@########## ✓ aaaaaaaaaa@########## ✓ bbbbbbb [ Exit ]7 Press the Confirm Destination key to confirm the registered destinations.
Press the or key to select a destination and press the OK key. Then, you can edit or delete the destination.
Press [Exit] (the Right Select key) to return to the basic screen.
8 Press the Start key. Transmission starts.
NOTE: If the screen for confirming the destination before transmission (page 8-88) is set to [On], the Confirm Destination screen appears when the Start key is pressed. For more information, refer to Confirm Destination Screen on page 3-25.
Send to Folder (SMB)/Send to Folder (FTP)
Stores a scanned original image file in the specified shared folder of any PC.
Stores a scanned original image in a folder of an FTP server.
NOTE:
- Refer to Help of your operating system for details on how to share a folder.
- Be sure that SMB Protocol or FTP in the COMMAND CENTER is On. For details, refer to the KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide.
• Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Send (E-mail Folder FAX)
text_image
Send to: 01 E-mail 02 Folder(SMB) 03 Folder(FTP)
text_image
Host Name(SMB): RD Center ABC [ Text ]
text_image
or Host Name(FTP) : RD Center■ ABC [ Text ]
text_image
Path: RD3\report ABC [ Text ]1 Press the Send key.
Displays the screen for sending.
2 Press the or key to select [Folder(SMB)] or [Folder(FTP)].
3 Press the OK key. Host Name(SMB) or Host Name(FTP) appears.
4 Enter the host name.
NOTE: Destination can be specified using the Address Book or the One-touch keys. Refer to Specifying Destination on page 3-26.
5 Press the OK key. Path appears.
6 Enter the path name. Consider, that the share name but not the folder name on the destination PC has to be typed in.
7 Press the OK key. Login User Name appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Maury ABC [ Text ]8 Enter the login user name. You have to enter the account name of the destination PC.

text_image
Login Password: OK ABC [ Text ]9 Press the OK key. Login Password appears.

text_image
Check the connection. Are you sure? [ Yes ] [ No ]10 Enter the login password. You have to enter the password of the account on the destination PC.
11 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
NOTE: If the screen for confirming the entry of a new destination (page 8-88) is set to [On], screens to confirm the entered host name and path name appear. Enter the same host name and path name again and press the OK key on their respective screens.
Data to be entered are as follows.
NOTE: You will be unable to send the data if you forget your login user name or login password of the destination PC. Contact your administrator and check your login user name or login password.
For send to folder (SMB)
| Item Data | to be entered | Max. characters |
| Host Name (SMB)* | Host name or IP address of the PC to receive the data. | Up to 64 characters |
| Path Path to the | receiving folder such as follows.For example,User\Sharename. | Up to 128 characters |
| Login User Name | User name to access the PCFor example,abcdnet\james.smith | Up to 64 characters |
| Login Password | Password to access the PC Up to 64 | characters |
* To specify a port number different from the default (139), enter using the format "host name: port number" (e.g., SMBhostname: 140).
For send to folder (FTP)
| Item Data to be entered | Max. characters | |
| Host Name (FTP)* | Host name or IP address of FTP server Up | up to 64 characters |
| Path Path to the receiving folder.For example,User\ScanData.Otherwise the data will be saved in the home directory. | Up to 128 characters | |
| Login User Name | FTP server log-in user name Up to 64 | characters |
| Login Password | FTP server log-in password Up to 64 | characters |
* To specify a port number different from the default (21), enter using the format "host name: port number" (e.g., FTPhostname: 140).

text_image
Dest. Confirm.: ✓ Morgan@########### 0667640000 0667741234 [ Exit ]12 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). This makes a connection with the entered destination.

text_image
Dest. Confirm.: FRD Center EI5 PT10 [ Exit ]If the connection is successful, Connected. is displayed on the screen. Press [OK] (the Right Select key). Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
If the connection failed, Cannot connect. is displayed. Press [OK] (the Right Select key). The screen shown in step 3 reappears. Check and re-enter the destination.
13 If there are additional destinations, press the Add Destination key. Repeat steps 2 to 12 to enter additional destinations. Up to 100 destinations can be specified.
14 Press the Confirm Destination key to confirm the registered destinations.
Press the or key to select a destination and press the OK key. Then, you can edit or delete the destination.
Press [Exit] (the Right Select key) to return to the basic screen.
15 Press the Start key. Transmission starts.
NOTE: If the screen for confirming the destination before transmission (page 8-88) is set to [On], the Confirm Destination screen appears when the Start key is pressed. For more information, refer to Confirm Destination Screen on page 3-25.
Confirm Destination Screen
If the screen for confirming the destination before transmission (page 8-88) is set to [On], Check through the all destination and press [Next]. appears when the Start key is pressed.
Use the procedure below to operate the Confirm Destination screen.

text_image
Destination List: OK ✓ Morgan@########### 0667640000 0667741234 [ Cancel ] [ Next ]1 Press the or key to check all destinations.
Press the OK key to edit or delete the selected destination.
To add a destination, press [Cancel] (the Left Select key) to return to the previous screen.

text_image
Morgan@######... OK 01 Detail 02 Delete2 After the checking is finished, press [Next] (the Right Select key). Set original and press Start key. is displayed on the screen.

text_image
Set original and press Start key. [ Cancel ]If there are destinations that are hidden and not yet checked, the screen displays Check the destination list through the end. and returns to the Destination List screen. Check all destinations.

text_image
Check the destination list through the end.3 Place the original on the platen and press the Start key. Transmission starts.
Specifying Destination
When specifying destination, choose from the Address Book or use the One-touch keys.
Choosing from the Address Book
Select a destination registered in the Address Book.

text_image
Select Addr Book: OK Address Book Ext Address Book [ Exit ]
text_image
Address Book: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]
text_image
Fiala: 0667640000 fiala@########### SMB-PC [ Menu ]1 In the basic screen for sending, press the Address Book key. The Select Addr Book menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Address Book] and then press the OK key. Address Book appears.
To use an address book on the LDAP server, select [Ext Address Book].
NOTE: If extended address book is not registered, [Select Addr Book] is not displayed.
3 Press the or key to select the desired user or group, and then press the OK key.
If you select a user, the list of destinations registered to the user appears.
If you select a group, proceed to step 5.
4 Press the or key to select the desired destination and then press the OK key.
5 Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
Destination Search
Destinations registered in the Address Book can be searched.
The procedures for using the different search modes are explained below.
Search in Address Book

text_image
Address Book: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]1 In Address Book, press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.
3

text_image
Menu: [0 1] Select [0 2] Detail [0 3] Search (Name)2 Press the or key to select [Search(Name)] and then press the OK key. A search screen appears.

text_image
Search (Name) : ma ABC [ Text ]3 Enter the characters you want to search.

text_image
Address Book: ● Maury ● Morgan ● Sally [ Menu ]4 Press the OK key. The address book appears with the user that starts with the entered character string at the top.
Search in External Address Book

text_image
Ext Address Book: OK Fiala Maury Morgan [ Menu ]1 In Ext Address Book, press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.

text_image
Menu: 01 Select 02 Detail 03 Search2 Press the or key to select [Search] and then press the OK key. A search screen appears.

text_image
Search (Name) : ma ABC [ Menu ] [ Text ]
text_image
Ext Address Book: OK ● Maury ● Morgan ● Sally [ Menu ]3 Enter the characters you want to search.
If you press [Menu] (the Right Select key) and then the OK key, Search by appears where you can specify the search key and match condition. Select the desired item for each and then press the OK key.
4 Press the OK key. The address book appears with the user that starts with the entered character string at the top.
NOTE: If you first open the extended address book, the search screen appears first. Then, operate from step 3.
Choosing by One-Touch Key

Select the destination using the One-touch keys.
In the basic screen for sending or the destination entry screen, press the one-touch key where the destination is registered.
NOTE: Refer to Adding a Destination on One-touch Key on page 8-116 for more information on adding one-touch keys.
Sending to Different Types of Destinations (Multi Sending)
You can specify destinations that combine e-mail addresses, folders (SMB or FTP) and fax numbers. This is referred to as Multi Sending. This is useful for sending to different types of destination (e-mail addresses, folders, etc.) in a single operation.
No. of broadcast items E-mail : Up to 100
Folders (SMP, FTP): Total of 1 SMB and FTP
FAX : Up to 100
Also, depending on the settings, you can send and print at the same time.
Procedures are the same as used in specifying the destinations of respective types. Continue to enter E-mail address or folder path so that they appear in the destination list. Press the Start key to launch transmission to all destinations at one time.
Canceling Jobs
Follow the steps below to cancel any print or send job being executed.
Canceling Jobs
You can also cancel jobs by pressing the Stop key.

text_image
Job Cancel List: 01 Print Job List 02 Send Job List 03 Store Job List [ Exit ]
text_image
Print Job List: 0008 Copy 0009 maury's data 0010 Microsoftwor... [ Resume ] [ Menu ]
text_image
Menu: [0 1] Detail [0 2] Cancel Job
text_image
Job will be canceled. Are you sure? →0008 Copy [ Yes ] [ No ]1 During a printing or sending job, press the Stop key. The Job Cancel List menu appears.
NOTE: Pressing the Stop key pauses a printing job but does not pause a sending job.
2 Press the or key to select the type of job you want to stop, and then press the OK key. An output queue of the selected job type is displayed.
3 Press the or key to select the job you want to stop, and then press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Cancel Job] and then press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
5 Press [Yes] (the Right Select key). The screen displays Canceling.... and returns to the output queue of the selected job type after the job is canceled.
To cancel other jobs, repeat steps 3 to 5.
Checking Remaining Toner and Paper
You can check the remaining amount of toner and that of paper in each feeder cassette.
Checking Remaining Toner

text_image
Status: [01] Print Job Status [02] Send Job Status [03] Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Toner Status: 0% 100%1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Toner Status].
3 Press the OK key. Toner Status appears.
The remaining amount of toner is displayed in one of 10 levels.
Checking Remaining Paper

text_image
Status: [01] Print Job Status [02] Send Job Status [03] Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Paper Status: Cassette 1: 1/ 4 Letter ☐ Empty Plain1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Paper Status].
3 Press the OK key. Paper Status appears.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display of remaining paper amount among the main unit cassette, optional cassette (if installed) and MP tray.
4 Copying Functions
This chapter explains the functions available for copying.
- Original Size 4-2
• Paper Selection....4-3 - Original Orientation ....4-6
- EcoPrint....4-8
- Combine Mode 4-9
- Continuous Scan....4-13
• Job Finish Notice....4-14 - File Name Entry......4-16
- Print Override 4-17
Original Size
Specify the size of originals being scanned. Be sure to select the original size before starting the copying process.
The following options are available.
| Item Sizes | |
| Original Sizes | Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Officio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki, Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2 and Custom* |
* For instructions on how to specify the custom original size, refer to Custom Original Size Setup on page 8-7.
Use the procedure below to select the original size.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Paper Selection [0 2] Collate [0 3] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Original Size: [0 1] *Letter [0 2] Legal [0 3] Statement1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Original Size].
5 Press the OK key. Original Size appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired original size and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
7 Press the Start key to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Paper Selection
Select the paper source that contains the required paper size.
NOTE: Specify in advance the size and type of the paper loaded in the cassette (refer to Original/Paper Settings on page 8-7).
Selecting the Cassette
Use the procedure below to select the paper supply cassette.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Paper Selection [02] Collate [03] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Paper Selection: 01 * Auto 02 1 Letter Plain 03 2 Custom Plain1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Paper Selection].
5 Press the OK key. Paper Selection appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired paper size. If [Auto] is selected, the paper matching the size of the original is selected automatically.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
8 Press the Start key to start copying.
Selecting the Multi Purpose Tray
Change the paper size and media type.
The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below.
| Category Item Sizes | ||
| Paper Size | Standard Sizes | Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5,Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6,Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki, Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2 and Custom* |
| SizeEntry**. | Inch modelsHorizontal: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments),Vertical: 2.76 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments) | |
| Metric modelsVertical: 70 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments),Horizontal: 148 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments) | ||
| Media Type | Plain, Transparency, Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled, Preprinted***, Bond, Cardstock, Color, Prepunched***, Letterhead***, Envelope, Thick, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8*** | |
* For instructions on how to specify the custom paper size (Custom), refer to Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print on page 8-10.
** The input units can be changed in the System menu.
Refer to Switching Unit of Measurement on page 8-24.
*** For instructions on how to specify the custom paper types 1 to 8, refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16.
To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to Special Paper Action on page 8-21.
NOTE: You can conveniently select in advance the size and type of paper that will be used often and set them as default (refer to Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Multi Purpose Tray on page 8-14).
Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Paper Selection].

text_image
Paper Selection: OK 01* Auto 02 1 A4 Plain 03 2 A5 Plain
text_image
MP Tray Set.: [0 1] *Standard Size [0 2] Size Entry
text_image
Size Entry(Y): (5.83 - 14.02) ↓ 14.02 "
text_image
Media Type: [01]*Plain 02 Transparency 03 Rough5 Press the OK key. Paper Selection appears.
6 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Set.].
7 Press the OK key. MP Tray Set. appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Standard Size] or [Size Entry] and press the OK key, select the desired paper size, and then press the OK key.
If you select [Size Entry], using the numeric keys to enter the Y (vertical) size and press the OK key, and then enter the X (horizontal) size and press the OK key.
9 Press the or key to select the desired paper type and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
10 Place paper in the multi purpose tray.
11 Press the Start key to start copying.
If Add paper in MP tray. is displayed during the copying process, add paper in the multi purpose tray, and then press the OK key. Copying then resumes.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Original Orientation
Select the original orientation to use the following functions.
- Duplex
- Combine mode
When placing originals on the platen

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer with a screen showing a grid and a small rectangular button (no text or symbols)natural_image
Line drawing of a portable electronic device with a screen and control panel (no text or symbols)When placing originals on the document processor

text_image
A[Top Edge Top]

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer front view showing internal structure and control panel (no text or symbols)[Top Edge Left]
NOTE: To change the default setting for the original orientation, refer to Orig. Orientation on page 8-48.
Use the procedure below to select the orientation when placing the originals on the platen.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Paper Selection [02] Collate [03] Duplex [ Exit ]1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4

text_image
Orig.Orientation: ◆ OK 01 Top Edge Top 02 * Top Edge Left4 Press the or key to select [Orig.Orientation].
5 Press the OK key. Orig.Orientation appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Top Edge Top] or [Top Edge Left].
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
8 Press the Start key to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
EcoPrint
Use EcoPrint to save toner when printing. Use this function for test copies or any other occasion where high quality print is unnecessary.
The procedure for making copies using EcoPrint is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Paper Selection [0 2] Collate [0 3] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
EcoPrint: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [EcoPrint].
5 Press the OK key. EcoPrint appears.
6 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
7 Press the Start key to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Combine Mode
This mode allows you to copy 2 or 4 originals combined onto a single page. 2-in-1 mode or 4-in-1 mode. The page boundary of each original can be indicated.
NOTE: Combine mode is available for the copy paper sizes of Folio, A4, B5, Legal, Oficio II, Letter, Statement and 16K.
2-in-1 Mode
For copying two originals onto a single sheet. This mode can be used with Duplex mode to copy four originals onto one sheet.
The following 2-in-1 options and output orientations are available.

flowchart
graph LR
A["Original"] --> B["Orientation of OriginalCopy"]
B --> C["Document processorPla"]
NOTE: When placing the original on the platen, be sure to copy the originals in page order.
4-in-1 Mode
For copying four originals onto a single sheet. This mode can be used with Duplex mode to copy eight originals onto one sheet.
The following 4-in-1 options and output orientations are available.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Original"] --> B["Orientation of OriginalCopy"]
B --> C["Document processorPla"]
subgraph Original
D1["4"]
D2["3"]
D3["2"]
D4["1"]
D5["1"]
D6["1"]
D7["1"]
D8["1"]
D9["1"]
end
subgraph Orientation
E1["1 2 2 1"]
E2["3 4 3"]
E3["1 3 3 1"]
E4["2 4 2"]
E5["1 3 4 3"]
end
subgraph DocumentPlayerPla
F1["1 2 2 1"]
F2["3 4 3"]
F3["1 3 3"]
F4["2 4 2"]
F5["1 3 4 3"]
end
NOTE: When placing the original on the platen, be sure to copy the originals in page order.
Types of Page Boundary Lines
The following types of the boundary lines are available.








None DottedSolid Positioning
Mark
The procedure for using Combine mode copying is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Combine].
5 Press the OK key. Combine appears.

text_image
Combine: [0 1] *Off [0 2] 2 in 1 [0 3] 4 in 16 Press the or key to select [2 in1] or [4 in 1].
7 Press [Detail] (the Right Select key).
8 Press the or key to select the desired layout and then press the OK key.

text_image
2 in 1 Layout: [0 1] * L to R T to B [0 2] R to L
text_image
Border Line: [0 1] * None [0 2] | Solid Line [0 3] : Dotted Line
text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK 01 Top Edge Top 02 * Top Edge Left9 Press the or key to select the desired border line type and then press the OK key.
10 Press the or key to select the orientation of the original and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
11 Press the Start key. Scanning begins.
If the original is placed on the platen, replace the original and press the Start key.
After scanning all originals, press [End Scan] (the Right Select key) to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Continuous Scan
When a large number of originals cannot be placed in the document processor at one time, the originals can be scanned in separate batches and then copied as one job. With this function, originals are scanned until you press [End Scan] (the Right Select key).
The procedure for making copies using Continuous Scan is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Continuous Scan: 01 * Off 02 On1 Press the Copy key.
2 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Continuous Scan].
4 Press the OK key. Continuous Scan appears.
5 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
6 Place the originals in the document processor or on the platen and press the Start key.
7 Place the next original and press the Start key. Repeat these steps to scan the remaining originals.
After scanning all originals, press [End Scan] (the Right Select key) to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Job Finish Notice
Sends a notice by E-mail when a copy job is complete. User can be notified of the completion of a copy job while working at a remote desk, saving the time spent waiting beside the machine for copying to finish.
NOTE: PC should be configured in advance so that E-mail can be used.
Example of Job Finish Notice

text_image
To: h_pttr@owl-net.net Subject: 1234 Job end report mail Job No.: 000002 Result: OK End Time: Wed 27 Apr 2005 14:56:08 File Name: doc27042005145608 Job Type: Copy ---- 1234 [00:c0:ee:d0:01:14] ----Use the procedure below to enable job finish notification when making copies.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Paper Selection [02] Collate [03] Duplex [ Exit ]1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [JobFinish Notice].
5 Press the OK key. JobFinish Notice appears.
6 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.

text_image
Destination: [0 1] *Address Book [0 2] Address Entry
text_image
Address Book: ✓ Fiala ✓ Maury ✓ Morgan [ Menu ]
text_image
Address Entry: ****@abcdefg.jp ABC [ Text ]7 Press the or key to select [Address Book] or [Address Entry], and then press the OK key.
8 If you select [Address Book], select [Address Book] on the next screen and press the OK key, and then select the notice destination.
Press [Menu] (the Right Select key), select [Detail] on the next screen and press the OK key to view the details of the selected notice destination.
If you select [Address Entry], enter the address of the notice destination.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
9 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
10 Press the Start key to start copying. Upon completion of the job, an E-mail notice is sent to the selected destination.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
File Name Entry
Names a copy job. Add other information such as date and time or job number as necessary. You can check a job history or job status using the job name, date and time, or job number specified here.
Use the procedure below to assign a name to your copy job.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Paper Selection [0 2] Collate [0 3] Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
File Name Entry: doc ABC [ Text ]1 Press the Copy key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [File Name Entry].
5 Press the OK key. File Name Entry appears.
6 Enter the file name, press the OK key. Additional Info. appears.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
7 Enter the date, job number, etc. on the screen, and then press the OK key.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for copying.
8 Press the Start key to start copying.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Print Override
This function allows you to suspend the current print job when you need to make copies immediately. When the interrupt copy job is completed, the machine resumes the suspended print job.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Paper Selection 02 Collate 03 Duplex [ Exit ]
text_image
Print Override: [0 1] *Off [0 2] On1 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Print Override].
3 Press the OK key. Print Override appears.
4 Press the or key to select [On].
5 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed, the machine is put into the interruption copy mode, and the basic screen appears.
6 Perform the interrupt copy job in the same fashion as a normal copy job. When the interrupt copy job is completed, the machine resumes the suspended print job.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
5 Sending Functions
This chapter explains the functions available for sending originals.
- Original Size 5-2
- Sending Size 5-3
- Zoom 5-5
- Duplex Sending 5-7
• Original Orientation 5-8 - File Format 5-10
• Original Image 5-12 - Adjusting Density.... 5-13
- Scan Resolution 5-14
• Color / Grayscale / Black and White Selection...... 5-15
• Continuous Scan....5-16 - File Name Entry 5-17
- Subject and Body Entry 5-18
- WSD Scan....5-19
• Job Finish Notice.... 5-21 - FTP Encrypted TX....5-23
- File Separation 5-24
- Scanning Image using Application 5-25
Original Size
Select the size of originals that will serve as the basis for scanning. Be sure to select the original size before starting the sending process.
Choose the original size from the following groups of original size.
| Item Size | |
| Original Sizes | Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Officio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki, Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2 and Custom* |
* Regarding the setting method of Custom Original Size, refer to Custom Original Size Setup on page 8-7.
Use the procedure below to select the original size when sending scanned images.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Original Size: [0 1] *Letter [0 2] Legal [0 3] Statement1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Original Size].
5 Press the OK key. Original Size appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired original size and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
7 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Sending Size
Select the sending size (the size of image to be sent).
The table below lists the sizes.
| Item Size | |
| Sending Sizes | Same as OrigSize, Legal, Letter, Statement, Executive, Officio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki, Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4 and Youkei 2 |
Relationship between Original Size, Sending Size, and Zoom
Original Size (page 5-2), Sending Size, and Zoom (page 5-5) are related to each other. Refer to the following table.
| Original Size and the size you wish to send as are | the same different | |
| Original Size Specify as | necessary | Specify as necessary |
| Sending Size Select [Same as | OrigSize] | Select the required size |
| Zoom Select [100%] | (or [Auto]) | Select [Auto] |
NOTE: When you select Sending Size that is different from Original Size, and select the Zoom [100%], you can send the image as the actual size (No Zoom).
Use the procedure below to select the size for transmission when sending scanned images.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Sending Size].
5 Press the OK key. Sending Size appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired sending size.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Zoom
Scans the original by automatically zooming it depending on the sending size.
The table below lists the available options.
| Item Detail | |
| 100% No Zoom (to be scanned at actual size) | |
| Auto Zoomed automatically according to the specified sending size. | |
NOTE: When zooming in or out, see Sending Size on page 5-3 when selecting the sending size.
When Custom Size or Size Entry is selected as the original size, the originals are sent at normal size and zooming cannot be used.
Depending on the combination of original size and sending size, the image is placed at the edge.
Use the procedure below to enlarge or reduce the original to match the transmission size.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Select the transmission size.
4 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Zoom].
6 Press the OK key. Zoom appears.

text_image
Zoom: 01*100% 02 Auto7 Press the or key to select [100%] or [Auto] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Duplex Sending
Select the type and binding of original depending on the original.
The table below lists the binding directions for each original type.
| Original Type Binding Binding | ||
| 1-sided Sheet Original 1-sided — — | ||
| 2-sided Sheet Original 2-sided Binding Left/Right, | Binding Top | Top Edge Top,Top Edge Left |
Use the procedure below to select the original type and binding direction when sending scanned originals.

text_image
Function Menu: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Duplex: [01]*1-sided [02] 2-sided1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the originals on the document processor.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [1-sided] or [2-sided].
4 Press the or key to select [Duplex].
5 Press the OK key. Duplex appears.
If you select [2-sided], press [Detail] (the Right Select key), select the binding edge and press the OK key, and then select the original setting orientation on the next screen.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Original Orientation
To send the document in the orientation that can be read properly, specify the upper orientation of original. To use the functions below, select the orientation in which the original is set on the platen.
• 1-sided / 2-sided Selection
When placing the original on the platen

natural_image
Line drawing of a portable electronic device with a screen and control panel (no text or symbols)natural_image
Front view of a portable electronic device with a screen and control panel (no visible text or symbols)When placing the original on the document processor

text_image
A[Top Edge Top]

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer front view showing internal structure and control panel (no text or symbols)[Top Edge Left]
Use the procedure below to select the orientation when placing the originals on the platen for sending.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK 01 Top Edge Top 02 * Top Edge Left1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Orig.Orientation].
5 Press the OK key. Orig.Orientation appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Top Edge Top] or [Top Edge Left].
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
File Format
Select the file format of the image to send.
The table below lists the file formats and their details.
| File Format | Adjustable range of image quality | Color mode |
| PDF 1 Low Quality (High Comp.) to 5 High Quality (Low Comp.) | Full Color, Grayscale, Black and White | |
| TIFF 1 Low Quality (High Comp.) to 5 High Quality (Low Comp.) | Full Color, Grayscale, Black and White | |
| XPS 1 Low Quality (High Comp.) to 5 High Quality (Low Comp.) | Full Color, Grayscale | |
| JPEG 1 Low Quality (High Comp.) to 5 High Quality (Low Comp.) | Full Color, Grayscale | |
NOTE: You cannot select [JPEG] if [Black and White] is selected for the color mode.
Use the procedure below to select the file format for transmission.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
File Format: 01 *PDF 02 TIFF 03 XPS [ Detail ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [File Format].
5 Press the OK key. File Format appears.
6 Press the or key to select the file format from [PDF], [TIFF], [XPS] or [JPEG].
If Full Color or Grayscale has been selected for the color mode for scanning, press [Detail] (the Right Select key) and select the image quality.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Original Image
Select image quality suitable to the type of original.
The table below shows the quality options.
| Item Detail | |
| Text+Photo Text and photos together. | |
| Photo For photos taken with a camera. | |
| Text Only text, no photos. | |
| For OCR For documents to be read by OCR*. | |
* This function is only available for black and white mode.
Use the procedure below to select the quality when sending scanned originals.

text_image
Function Menu: OK [0 1] Color Selection □ [0 2] Original Size □ [0 3] Original Image □ [ Exit ]
text_image
Original Image: [0 1] *Text+Photo [0 2] Photo [0 3] Text1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the originals.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Original Image].
5 Press the OK key. Original Image appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired image quality.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Adjusting Density
Use the procedure below to adjust the density when scanning the originals.
The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Detail | |
| Manual Adjust density using 7 levels. | |
| Auto Optimum density is selected according to the density of the original. | |
The procedure for adjusting the density is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Density: 01 Auto 02 *Manual1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Density].
5 Press the OK key. Density appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Manual].
If you select [Manual], press the OK key, and then select the density on the next screen.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Scan Resolution
Select the fineness of scanning resolution. The finer the scanning becomes (the larger the number becomes), the better the image quality becomes. However, better resolution also results in larger file size (file capacity) and longer scanning and sending times. The selectable resolution is 200x100dpi Normal, 200x200dpi Fine, 200x400dpi Super Fine, 300x300dpi, 400x400dpi Ultra Fine, or 600x600dpi.
The procedure for adjusting the scanning resolution when sending a scanned image is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Scan Resolution: ◆ OK 03 200x400dpi S.Fin 04 *300x300dpi 05 400x400dpi U.Fin1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Scan Resolution].
5 Press the OK key. Scan Resolution appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired scan resolution.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Color / Grayscale / Black and White Selection
This feature allows you to select the select the color mode used for scanning when sending images. You can select from Full Color, Grayscale or Black & White.
Use the procedure below to select the color mode when sending scanned images.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Color Selection: [0 1] * Full Color [0 2] Grayscale [0 3] Black & White1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Color Selection].
5 Press the OK key. Color Selection appears.
6 Press the or key to select the desired color mode.
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Continuous Scan
When the multi-page originals cannot be placed in the document processor at one time, the originals can be scanned in separate batches and then sent as one job. With this function, originals can be scanned one after another until you press [End Scan] (the Right Select key).
The procedure for using continuous scanning when sending scanned images is explained below.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
Continuous Scan: OK [0 1] * Off [0 2] On1 Press the Send key.
2 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Continuous Scan].
4 Press the OK key. Continuous Scan appears.
5 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
6 Specify the destination.
7 Place the original, and press the Start key.
8 Place the next original, and press the Start key. Scan the remaining originals by the same procedure.
When you have scanned all the originals, press [End Scan] (the Right Select key) to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
File Name Entry
This setting allows you to assign a document name to scanned images. You can specify a default for the document name.
Use the procedure below to assign names to scanned documents that you are sending.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
File Name Entry: doc ABC [ Text ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [File Name Entry].
5 Press the OK key. File Name Entry appears.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
6 Enter the file name, press the OK key. Additional Info. appears.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
7 Enter the date and time, job number, etc. on the screen, and then press the OK key.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Subject and Body Entry
When sending E-mail, enter the subject and body of the E-mail.
Use the procedure below to enter the subject and body for an E-mail message and then send the E-mail.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Color Selection 02 Original Size 03 Original Image [ Exit ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Subject/Body].
5 Press the OK key. Subject Entry appears.

text_image
Subject Entry: ABC [ Text ]6 Enter the subject and press the OK key.
NOTE: Up to 60 characters can be entered for the subject.
7 Enter the body and press the OK key.
NOTE: Up to 500 characters can be entered for the body.

text_image
Body Entry: ABC [ Text ]Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
8 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
WSD Scan
WSD Scan saves images of originals scanned on this machine as files on a WSD-compatible computer.
NOTE: For information on operating the computer, refer to the operating system help for your computer. To use WSD Scan, WSD Scan Setup (page 8-133) must be set to [On] in the network settings.
Installing Driver Software to the destination machine
The example shows you how to install the driver software to a Windows Vista PC.
1 Click Start and then Network in the computer.
2 Right-click the machine's icon and then click Install.
NOTE: If the User Account Control window appears, click Continue.
If the Found New Hardware window appears, click Cancel.
3 During the installation, double-click the icon shown on the task bar to display the Driver Software Installation screen. When Your devices are ready to use is displayed on the Driver Software Installation screen, the installation is completed.
Procedure using this machine

text_image
Send to: 02 Folder(SMB) 03 Folder(FTP) 04 WSD Scan1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the platen.
Displays the screen for sending.
NOTE: Depending on the settings, the address book screen may appear. In this event, press [Cancel] to display the screen for sending.
3 Press the or key to select [WSD Scan].
4 Press the OK key. WSD Scan appears.

text_image
WSD Scan: 01 From Computer 02 From Oper. Panel [ Exit ]
text_image
Select Computer: OK Computer01 Computer02 Computer03 [ Cancel ] [ Detail ]Press Start Key.
:Computer01
5 Press the or key to select [From Oper. Panel].
6 Select the destination computer from the computer list.
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) to see the information of the selected computer.
7 Press the OK key to confirm the destination, and then press the Start key. Transmission starts.
NOTE: To change the destination computer, press the Back key and then press [Yes] (the Left Select key). This brings you back to step 6.
NOTE: To use WSD Scan from your computer, press [From Computer] in step 5 and then scan the original from the computer.
Job Finish Notice
This feature sends an e-mail providing notification that transmission has been completed.
Use the procedure below to specify the Job Finish Notice settings.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
JobFinish Notice: ◆ OK [01]*Off [02] On
text_image
Destination: [0 1] *Address Book [0 2] Address Entry
text_image
Address Book: ✓Fiala ✓Maury ✓Morgan [ Menu ]
text_image
Address Entry: ********@abcdefg.jp ABC [ Text ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the original.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [JobFinish Notice].
5 Press the OK key. JobFinish Notice appears.
6 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
7 Press the or key to select [Address Book] or [Address Entry], and then press the OK key.
8 If you select [Address Book], select [Address Book] on the next screen and press the OK key, and then select the notice destination.
Press [Menu] (the Right Select key), select [Detail] on the next screen and press the OK key to view the details of the selected notice destination.
If you select [Address Entry], enter the address of the notice destination.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
9 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
10 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending.
When the sending is completed, the finish notice is sent to the specified E-mail address.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
FTP Encrypted TX
This allows you to encrypt documents when you send them. If you select [On] in this option, you can then select the encryption method in the basic send screen.
Use the procedure below to scan and send originals as encrypted files.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]
text_image
FTP Encrypted TX: ◆ OK [01]*Off [02] On1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the platen.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [FTP Encrypted TX].
5 Press the OK key. FTP Encrypted TX appears.
6 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
NOTE: Click Advanced -> Secure Protocols in the COMMAND CENTER. Be sure that SSL of Secure Protocol Settings is On and more than two effective encryptions are selected in Clientside Settings. For details, refer to the KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide.
File Separation
Create several files by dividing scanned original data page by page, and send the files.
Use the procedure below to split scanned original data into separate files when sending scanned originals.

text_image
Function Menu: [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Original Size [0 3] Original Image [ Exit ]1 Press the Send key.
2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the platen.
3 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [File Separation].
5 Press the OK key. File Separation appears.

text_image
File Separation: 01 *Off 02 Each Page6 Press the or key to select [Each Page] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen for sending.
7 Specify the destination, and press the Start key to start sending. The scanned original is sent after being divided into files of one page each.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Scanning Image using Application
Be sure that you connect your PC with the machine using the USB cable and install the Kyocera TWAIN or WIA Driver. The scan can be carried out from any TWAIN or WIA compatible application program. For details of installation for TWAIN or WIA driver, refer to Quick Installation Guide.
IMPORTANT: When scanning a document from a TWAIN or WIA compatible application, set Auto Sleep to [Off]. For this setting, refer to Auto Sleep ON/OFF on page 8-34.
The following procedure is an example for scan operation using the TWAIN Driver. Operate the WIA Drivers in the same manner.
1 Connect your computer to the machine using a USB cable.
2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the platen.
3 Use the TWAIN-compatible application to scan from your computer.
NOTE: When the login user name and password entry screen appears, enter them and click the OK button.
4 Choose the appropriate settings and click Scan. The scanned data will be sent to your computer.
6 Document Box
This chapter explains the typical procedure for utilizing Document Box.
- Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory ...... 6-2
- Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB)..... 6-6
- Removing USB Memory 6-8
- Printing from a Job Box 6-9
Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory
Plugging USB memory directly into the machine enables you to quickly and easily print the files stored in the USB memory without having to use a computer.
Limitations
- The following file types can be printed:
- PDF file (Version 1.5)
• TIFF file (TIFF V6/TTN2 format) -
XPS file
-
The files you wish to print should have an extension (.pdf, .tif, .xps).
- Files to be printed should be saved no further down than the top 3 folder levels.
- Plug the USB memory directly into the USB memory slot. If connected via a USB hub, the machine may not operate correctly.
Printing
Print documents stored in the removable USB memory.

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer with control panel and scroll (no text or symbols)
text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Polling Box 03 USB Memory
text_image
USB Memory: Store File Folder-1 File-1 [ Menu ] [ Select ]1 Plug the USB memory into the USB memory slot.
2 Press the Document Box key. The Document Box menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [USB Memory].
4 Press the OK key. USB Memory appears.
5 Press the or key to select the the file you want to print.
Select a folder and press the OK key to view the files in the folder. Documents in the top 3 folder levels including the root directory can be viewed.

text_image
USB Memory: Store File Folder-1 File-1 [ Menu ] [ Select ]6 Press [Select] (the Right Select key). The selected file name is indicated by a checkmark next to it.
When you want to print additional files, repeat steps 5 to 6 to select them.
7 Press the OK key. A menu appears.

text_image
USB Memory: [0 1] Print [0 2] Delete8 Press the or key to select [Print].
9 Press the OK key. The basic screen appears. Change the number of copies, 1-sided/2-sided printing, etc., as necessary. For changing print settings, refer to Copying on page 3-7 and Copying Functions on page 4-1.
10 Press the Start key. Printing of the selected file begins.
IMPORTANT: When removing the USB memory, ensure that you use the correct removal procedure, as described in Removing USB Memory on page 6-8.

text_image
Ready to print. Copies: 1 A4 □ ▶ A4 □ 1-Sided [ Duplex ] [ Paper ]TIFF Print
Sets the print mode for TIFF files. The default setting is Paper Size.

text_image
Function Menu: [01] Collate [02] Paper Selection [03] Duplex [ Exit ]1 Follow steps 1 to 9 of Printing on page 6-2.
2 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [TIFF Print].

text_image
TIFF Print: [01]*Paper Size [02] Image Resolution [03] Print Resolution4 Press the OK key. TIFF Print appears.
5 Press the or key to select the the desire print mode.
The print modes are as follows:
Paper Size (scaled to fit the paper size)
Image Resolution (matched to the image resolution)
Print Resolution (matched to the print resolution)
6 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
XPS FitTo Page
If you select On in this setting, XPS data is scaled to fit the paper size during printing. If you select Off, the data is printed at its original size.

text_image
Function Menu: 01 Collate 02 Paper Selection 03 Duplex [ Exit ]1 Follow steps 1 to 8 of Printing on page 6-2.
2 Press the Function Menu key. Function Menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [XPS FitTo Page].
4 Press the OK key. XPS FitTo Page appears.

text_image
XPS FitTo Page: [01]*Off [02] On5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
NOTE: Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in Function Menu.
Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB)
This function allows you to store scanned image files in USB memory connected to the machine. You can store files in PDF, TIFF, JPEG or XPS format.
NOTE: The maximum number of the storable files is 100.
Storing Documents
The procedure for storing documents in removable USB memory is explained below.

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer with control panel and paper feed (no text or symbols)
text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Polling Box 03 USB Memory
text_image
USB Memory: Store File Folder-1 File-1 [ Menu ] [ Select ]1 Plug the USB memory into the USB memory slot.
2 Press the Document Box key. The Document Box menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [USB Memory].
4 Press the OK key. USB Memory appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Store File].
NOTE: To save the data in the folder of USB memory, press the △ or ▽ key to select the folder, and then press [Select] (the Right Select key) followed by the OK key. The machine will display documents in the top 3 folder levels, including the root folder.
Ready to scan.
A4
1-Sided 300x300dpi
[2-Sided] [ScanRes.]
6 Press the OK key. The basic screen appears. Change the original type, file format, etc., as necessary. For changing scan settings, refer to Sending Functions on page 5-1.
7 Press the Start key. The original is scanned and the data is stored in the USB memory.
IMPORTANT: When removing the USB memory, ensure that you use the correct removal procedure, as described in Removing USB Memory on page 6-8.
Removing USB Memory
Remove the USB memory.
IMPORTANT: Be sure to follow the proper procedure to avoid damaging the data or USB memory.

text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Polling Box 03 USB Memory1 Press the Document Box key. The Document Box menu appears.

text_image
USB Memory: Store File Folder-1 File-1 [ Menu ] [ Select ]2 Press the or key to select [USB Memory].
3 Press the OK key. USB Memory appears.
4 Press [Menu] (the Left Select key). A menu appears.

text_image
Menu (Folder) : 01 Memory Detail 02 Remove MemoryNOTE: This is the image on the screen when a folder is selected. [Open] is not displayed when a file is selected.

text_image
USB memory can be safely removed. [ O K5 Press the or key to select [Remove Memory].
6 Press the OK key. A confirmation message appears.
7 Press [OK] (the Right Select key) or remove the USB memory. The screen returns to the Document Box menu.
Printing from a Job Box
When optional memory is installed and RAM Disk Mode is enabled, you can use a Job Box to print.
Job Box is a function that stores print data on the set RAM disk in the machine, enabling the data to be printed as needed from the operation panel of the machine.
If an ID (4-digit number) is set when printing is executed from the computer, the data can be kept more confidential.
When an ID is set, the ID must be entered in order to print the stored data from the machine. For the RAM disk settings, see RAM Disk Mode on page 8-67.
Private Print
Private Print is used to allow printing only after the same 4-digit ID that was entered in the printer driver at the time of printing is entered at the operation panel. The data is erased after printing.
For information on Private Print, see Help in the printer driver.
The procedure for printing stored data is explained below.

text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Polling Box 03 Job Box
text_image
Job Box: [0 1] Private [0 2] Quick Copy
text_image
Private: Fiala Maury
text_image
Fiala: Data01 Data02 Data03 [ Menu ] [ Select ]1 Press the Document Box key. The Document Box menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Job Box].
3 Press the OK key. The Job Box menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Private].
5 Press the OK key. The user selection menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select the user.
7 Press the OK key. The print file selection menu appears.

text_image
Menu: 01 Select All 02 Clear All 03 Detail8 Press the or key to select the file to be printed, and then press [Select] (the Right Select key). The selected file will be marked.
If you need to add another file, repeat this procedure to select the file.
NOTE: To select all files, press Menu (the Left Select key) and select [Select All]. To deselect all files, select [Clear All]. To show file details, select [Detail].

text_image
Fiala: [0 1] Print [0 2] Delete9 Press the OK key. The file print and delete selection menu appears.
10 Press the or key to select [Print] and press the OK key.
NOTE: To delete the selected file without printing it, select [Delete] and press the OK key. The file deletion confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Completed. appears and the file is deleted.

text_image
ID: 1216 OK11 The ID entry screen appears. Enter the ID and press the OK key.

text_image
Copies: (1 - 999, ---) --- copies12 The number of copies screen appears. Set the number of copies and press the OK key.
13 The file print confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Accepted appears and printing begins.
Quick Copy mode
This mode is used to print an additional copy of a document that has already been printed. If a document is printed with Proof and hold selected in the printer driver, the document will be simultaneously stored on the RAM disk. The required number of copies can be printed whenever needed from the operation panel. If more documents than the
set maximum are stored, the oldest job will be overwritten each time a new job is stored. When the machine power is turned off, jobs stored in this mode are erased. For the number of documents that can be stored in Quick Copy mode, see Quick Copy Jobs on page 8-88.

text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Polling Box 03 Job Box1 Press the Document Box key. The Document Box menu appears.

text_image
Job Box: [0 1] Private [0 2] Quick Copy2 Press the or key to select [Job Box].
3 Press the OK key. The Job Box menu appears.

text_image
Quick Copy: Fiala Maury4 Press the or key to select [Quick Copy].
5 Press the OK key. The user selection menu appears.

text_image
Fiala: Data01 Data02 Data03 [ Menu ] [ Select ]6 Press the or key to select the user.
7 Press the OK key. The print file selection menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select the file to be printed, and then press [Select] (the Right Select key). The selected file will be marked.
If you need to add another file, repeat this procedure to select the file.

text_image
Menu: 01 Select All 02 Clear All 03 DetailNOTE: To select all files, press Menu (the Left Select key) and select [Select All]. To deselect all files, select [Clear All]. To show file details, select [Detail].

text_image
Fiala: [0 1] Print [0 2] Delete9 Press the OK key. The file print and delete selection menu appears.
10 Press the or key to select [Print] and press the OK key.
NOTE: To delete the selected file without printing it, select [Delete] and press the OK key. The file deletion confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Completed. appears and the file is deleted.

text_image
Copies: (1 - 999, ---) --- copies11 The number of copies screen appears. Set the number of copies and press the OK key.
12 The file print confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Accepted appears and printing begins.
7 Status / Job Cancel
This chapter explains how to check the status and history of jobs and pause or resume the jobs being processed or waiting to be printed.
This chapter also explains how to check the status of devices.
- Checking Job Status.... 7-2
- Checking Job History 7-8
- Sending the Job Log History 7-13
- Pause and Resumption of Jobs 7-18
- Canceling of Jobs....7-18
• Device/Communication 7-19
Checking Job Status
Check the status of jobs being processed or waiting to be printed.
Available Status Screens
The processing and waiting statuses of jobs are displayed as a list on the Message Display in four different screens - Print Job, Send Job, Store Job, and Scheduled Job. The following job statuses are available.
| Screen Job statuses to be displayed | |
| Print Job • Copy | PrinterFAX receptionDocument BoxE-mail receptionJob Report /ListPrinting data from removable memory |
| Send Job • FAX transmission | PC (SMB/FTP) transmissionE - m a i lApplicationMultiple destinationSending Job FAX using Delayed transmission |
| Store Job • Scan | FAXPrinter |
| Scheduled Job • FAX | |
Print Job Status Screen

text_image
Status: 01 Print Job Status 02 Send Job Status 03 Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Print Job Status: 0008 Copy 0009 maury's data 0010 aaaa [ Pause ] [ Menu ] 1 2 3 4 OK1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Print Job Status].
3 Press the OK key. Print Job Status appears. Press the or key to check the print queue.
0009 Detail:
Status: 1/8
Processing

Press the OK key to check detailed information of the selected job.
NOTE: You can also check the job information by pressing [Menu] (the Right Select key) and selecting [Detail] in the menu that appears.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Status (status of job)
Accepted Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Page and Copy
(number of pages and copies to be printed)
Original Page (number of pages of the original)
Sender Info.
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
When the job name in Job Name is displayed in a short form, press [Detail] (the Right Select key) to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
The table below lists the items displayed in the Printing Jobs Status screen.
| No. | Item / Key Detail | |
| 1 Job | No. Acceptance No. of job | |
| 2 Type | Icons that indicate the job type■Copy job ☑■Printer job ☐■FAX reception ☑■E-mail reception ☑■Job from Document Box ☐■Report / List ☐■Data from Removable Memory ↗ | |
| 3 Job | Name Job Name or file name | |
| 4 Status | Status of job | P r iII: Print Waitingno icon: Pausing print job or errorPreferential print job isrunningSuspended becausepreferential print job isrunning |
Send Job Status screen

text_image
Status: 01 Print Job Status 02 Send Job Status 03 Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Send Job Status: 0010 066764333 0011 Broadcast 0017 0324256345 [ Cancel ] [ Menu ] 1 2 3 4
text_image
0011 Detail: Status: 1/8 Processing1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Send Job Status].
3 Press the OK key. Send Job Status appears. Press the or key to check the send queue.
Press the OK key to check detailed information of the selected job.
NOTE: You can also check the job information by pressing [Menu] (the Right Select key) and selecting [Detail] in the menu that appears.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Status (status of job)
Accepted Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Original Pages (number of pages of the original)
Color/B & W (color mode of the original)
Destination
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Job Name to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When complete destination name not displayed in detailed information
When there is only one destination, press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Destination to see the complete destination name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When there are two or more destinations, press [List] (the Right Select key) in Destination to display the destination list. Press the or key to select the desired destination and press the OK key. This displays the complete name of the destination. Press the OK key to return to the destination list.
Pressing [Exit] (the Right Select key) while the destination list is displayed brings you back to the original screen.
The table below lists the items displayed in the Sending Jobs Status screen.
| No. | Item / Key Detail | |
| 1 | Job No. Acceptance No. of job | |
| 2 | Type Icons that indicate the job type | ■Sending Job FAX (自)■Sending Job PC (SMB) ☑■Sending Job PC (FTP) ☑■Sending Job E-mail ☑■Sending Job TWAIN2 ☑■Sending Job WSD Scan ☑When broadcast sending is done,Broadcast is displayed next to the icon. |
| 3 | Destination Destination (Either destination name,FAX number, E-mail address, or server name) | |
| 4 | Status Status of job | ▸: Sendingno icon: Sending WaitingII: Pausing the jobX: Stop sending |
Store Job Status screen

text_image
Status: 01 Print Job Status 02 Send Job Status 03 Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Store Job Status: 0008 Scan 0009 maury's data 0010 aaaa [ Cancel ] [ Menu ] 1 2 3 4
text_image
0009 Detail: OK Status: 1/8 Processing1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Store Job Status].
3 Press the OK key. Store Job Status appears. Press the or key to check the store queue.
Press the OK key to check detailed information of the selected job.
NOTE: You can also check the job information by pressing [Menu] (the Right Select key) and selecting [Detail] in the menu that appears.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Status (status of job)
Accepted Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Original Pages (number of pages of the original)
Color/B & W (color mode of the original)
Sender Info. (destination information)
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Job Name to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Sender Info. to see the complete destination information. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
The table below lists the items displayed in the Storing Jobs Status screen.
| No. | Display / Key Details | |
| 1 | Job No. Acceptance No. of job | |
| 2 | Type Icons that indicate the job type■Storing Job Scan ↙■Storing Job FAX ↖■Storing Job Printer ↖ | |
| 3 | Job Name Job name or file name is displayed. | |
| 4 | Status Status of job | ▸: Storing Datano icon: Storing Waiting |
Checking Job History
Check the history of completed jobs.
NOTE: Job history is also available by COMMAND CENTER or KMnet Viewer from the computer.
Available Job History Screens
The job histories are displayed separately in three screens - Print Jobs, Send Jobs, Store Jobs, and Scheduled Jobs. The following job histories are available.
| Screen Job histories to be displayed | |
| Print Job • Copy | PrinterFAX receptionE-mail receptionJob Report / ListPrinting data from removable memory |
| Send Job • FAX | PC (SMB/FTP)E-mailApplicationMultiple destination |
| Store Job • Scan | FAXPrinter |
| Scheduled Job • FAX | |
Displaying Print Job Log

text_image
Status: 01 Print Job Status 02 Send Job Status 03 Store Job Status [ Pause ]
1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Print Job Log].
3 Press the OK key. Print Job Log appears. Press the or key to check the print log.
A job result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each job.
OK : Job completed normally
⚠️ : Job error
: Job aborted
NOTE: For details of other items, refer to Print Job Status Screen on page 7-2.

text_image
0006 Detail: Result: 1/9 Error 00100Press the OK key or [Detail] (the Right Select key) to check the detailed information of the selected print log.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Result
Accepted Time
End Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Page and Copy
(number of pages and copies to be printed)
Original Page (number of pages of the original)
Sender Info. (destination information)
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
When the job name in Job Name is displayed in a short form, press [Detail] (the Right Select key) to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Sender Info. to see the complete destination information. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
Displaying Send Job Log

text_image
Status: [01] Print Job Status [02] Send Job Status [03] Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Send Job Log: 0004 ▼Broadcast OK 0003 📞0756545865 OK 0002 ▼Morgan@kyoc... ⚠ [ Detail ]1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Send Job Log].
3 Press the OK key. Send Job Log appears. Press the or key to check the send log.
A job result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each job.
OK : Job completed normally
⚠️ : Job error
: Job aborted
NOTE: For details of other items, refer to Send Job Status screen on page 7-4.

text_image
0004 Detail: Result: 1/9 OKPress the OK key or [Detail] (the Right Select key) to check the detailed information of the selected send log.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Result
Accepted Time
End Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Original Pages (number of pages of the original)
Color/B & W (color mode of the original)
Destination
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Job Name to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When complete destination name not displayed in detailed information
When there is only one destination, press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Destination to see the complete destination name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When there are two or more destinations, press [List] (the Right Select key) in Destination to display the destination list. Press the or key to select the desired destination and press the OK key. This displays the complete name of the destination. Press the OK key to return to the destination list.
Pressing [Exit] (the Right Select key) while the destination list is displayed brings you back to the original screen.
Displaying Store Job Log

text_image
Status: 01 Print Job Status 02 Send Job Status 03 Store Job Status [ Pause ]
text_image
Store Job Log: 0008 Scan OK 0009 maury's data 0010 aaaa [ Detail ]1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Store Job Log].
3 Press the OK key. Store Job Log appears. Press the or key to check the store queue.
A job result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each job.
OK : Job completed normally
⚠️ : Job error
: Job aborted
NOTE: For details of other items, refer to Store Job Status screen on page 7-6.

text_image
0009 Detail: Result: 1/9 Error 10200Press the OK key or [Detail] (the Right Select key) to check the detailed information of the selected job.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Result
Accepted Time
End Time
Job Name
Job Type
User Name
Original Pages (number of pages of the original)
Color/B & W (color mode of the original)
Sender Info. (destination information)
When complete job name not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Job Name to see the complete job name. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information
Press [Detail] (the Right Select key) in Sender Info. to see the complete destination information. Press the OK key to return to the original screen.
Sending the Job Log History
You can send the job log history by e-mail. You can either send it manually as needed or have it sent automatically whenever a set number of jobs is reached.
Displaying Job Log History Menu

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK [01] Report [02] Counter [03] System [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel. The Sys. Menu/Count. menu appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]When you are performing user management and have not logged in, a login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password to log in.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK [01] Report [02] Counter [03] System [ Exit ]2 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Report].

text_image
Report: 01 Report Print 02 Result Rpt Set. 03 Job Log History [ Exit ]3 Press the OK key. The Report menu appears.

text_image
Report: 02 Admin Rpt Set. 03 Result Rpt Set. 04 Job Log History [ Exit ]4 Press the or key to select [Job Log History].

text_image
Job Log History: OK 01 Auto Sending 02 Send History 03 Destination [ Exit ]5 Press the OK key. The Job Log History menu appears.
Setting the destination
Set the destination to which job log histories are sent.
Use the procedure below to set the destination.

text_image
Job Log History: ◆ OK 01 Auto Sending 02 Send History 03 Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Job Log History menu, press the or key to select [Destination].

text_image
Destination: [01] Confirmation [02] Register [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Destination menu appears.
Confirming Current Destination

text_image
Destination: [01] Confirmation [02] Register [ Exit ]1 In the Destination menu, press the or key to select [Confirmation].

text_image
Dest. Confirm.: OK ✓ Morgan@########### [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. Dest. Confirm. appears.
NOTE: Press the OK key to edit/delete the current destination.Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 Press [Exit] (the Right Select key). The basic screen reappears.
Registering Destination

text_image
Destination: 01 Confirmation 02 Register [ Exit ]
text_image
Register: [0 1] Address Book [0 2] Address Entry1 In the Destination menu, press the or key to select [Register].
2 Press the OK key. Register appears.
To select a destination from the address book, press the or key to select [Address Book] and then press the OK key. This displays the address book. Select your desired destination.
NOTE: For selecting a destination from the address book, refer to Specifying Destination on page 3-26.
To directly enter a destination, press the or key to select [Address Entry] and then press the OK key. This displays an entry screen. Enter the destination address directly.
3 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Destination menu.
| Completed. |

text_image
Register: 01 Address Book 02 *Address EntryNOTE: If the address of the selected destination has been changed after you selected the destination from the address book, [*] is displayed before [Address Entry]. Refer to Confirming Current Destination on page 7-14 and reconfirm the destination address.
Automatic Job Log History Transmission
This function automatically sends the job log history to the specified destinations whenever a set number of jobs has been logged.
Use the procedure below to set automatic job log history transmission.

text_image
Job Log History: 01 Auto Sending 02 Send History 03 Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Job Log History menu, press the or key to select [Auto Sending].

text_image
Auto Sending: [01]*Off [02] On2 Press the OK key. Auto Sending appears.

text_image
Jobs: (1 - 16) 16 jobs3 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
If you select [On] and press the OK key, Jobs appears. Use the numeric keys to enter the number of jobs to be sent at a time.
4 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Job Log History menu.
Manual Job Log History Transmission
You can also send the job log history to the specified destinations manually.
Use the procedure below to send the job log history manually.

text_image
Job Log History: ◆ OK 01 Auto Sending 02 Send History 03 Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Job Log History menu, press the or key to select [Send History].

text_image
Send the job log history. Are you sure? [ Yes ] [ No ]2 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
Enter destination.
IMPORTANT: If no destination is registered, Enter destination is displayed. Refer to Registering Destination on page 7-15 and register the desired destination
3 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Accepted. is displayed and the job log is sent to the registered destination before the screen returns to the Job Log History menu.
Setting E-mail Subject
Set the subject automatically entered when sending job log histories by e-mail.
Use the procedure below to set the subject.

text_image
Job Log History: 02 Send History 03 Destination 04 Subject [ Exit ]
text_image
Subject: %printer ABC [ Text ]1 In the Job Log History menu, press the or key to select [Subject].
2 Press the OK key. Subject appears.
3 Enter the e-mail subject.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
4 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Job Log History menu.
Pause and Resumption of Jobs
Pause /resume all printing jobs in printing/waiting.
The procedure for pausing and resuming jobs is explained below.

text_image
Status: [0 1] Print Job Status [0 2] Send Job Status [0 3] Store Job Status [ Pause ]1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.

text_image
Print Job Status: OK 0008 Copy 0009 maury's data 0010 aaaa [ Pause ] [ Menu ]2 Press the or key to select [Print Job Status].
3 Press the OK key. Print Job Status appears.
4 Press [Pause] (the Left Select key). Printing is paused.

text_image
Pausing: 0008 Copy 0009 maury's data 0010 aaaa [ Resume ] [ Menu ]When you press [Resume] (the Left Select key) to resume printing.

text_image
Resume paused jobs. Are you sure? [ Yes ] [ No ]NOTE: When you press the Back key, a confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key) to resume printing.
Canceling of Jobs
For canceling jobs, refer to Canceling Jobs on page 3-29.
Device/Communication
Configure the devices/lines installed or connected to this machine or check their status. You can also control devices depending on their status.
Check of Device Status

text_image
Status: 07 Store Job Log 08 Scanner 09 Printer [ Pause ]1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.
2 Press the or key to select [Scanner], [Printer] or [FAX].
3 Press the OK key. This displays the status of the device selected in step 2.

text_image
Scanner: Ready.
text_image
Printer: OK Processing.
text_image
FAX: Ready. [ Log ]4 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the Status menu.
The items you can check are described below.
Scanner
The information (scanning, pausing, etc.) is displayed.
Printer
Information (waiting, printing, etc.) is displayed.
FAX
The information (sending, waiting, etc.) is displayed.

text_image
Log: 01 Outgoing FAX Log 02 Incoming FAX Log 03 Outgoing FAX RptIf you press [Log] (the Right Select key), the Log menu appears. From this screen, you can check or print the transmission/reception history.
NOTE: If you are using a user management function, the menu for printing the transmission/reception history appears only when you have logged in as an administrator.
Handling the Devices (USB Memory)

text_image
Status: 12 Paper Status 13 Memory Card 14 USB Memory [ Pause ]1 Press the Status/Job Cancel key. The Status menu appears.

text_image
USB Memory: Capacity: 1/3 512.0MB [ Remove ]2 Press the or key to select [USB Memory].
3 Press the OK key. This displays the status of the USB memory.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the display to other information items. The items displayed are as follows:
Capacity
Used Area
Free Space

text_image
USB memory can be safely removed. [ O KWhen you press [Remove] (the Left Select key), a confirmation screen appears and you can remove the USB memory.
4 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the Status menu.
8 Default Setting (System Menu)
This chapter explains how to configure various settings of the machine using the menus on the operation panel.
- Common Settings.... 8-2
• Copy Settings 8-68 - Printer Settings....8-74
- Sending Settings 8-86
- Document Box Settings....8-88
• Printing Reports/Sending Notice 8-93 - Adjustment/Maintenance 8-98
• Editing Destination (Address Book/Adding One-Touch Keys) 8-105 - Restarting the System 8-119
• Network Setup....8-120
• Network Security 8-139 - Interface Block Setting 8-146
• Security Level (Security Level setting) 8-150 - Optional Functions 8-150
Common Settings
Common settings include;
- How to display the Sys. Menu/Count. menu ...8-2
- Switching the Language for Display [Language] ...8-3
- Default Screen ...8-5
- Sound ...8-6
- Display Bright. ...8-7
• Original/Paper Settings ...8-7 - Switching Unit of Measurement ...8-24
- Error Handling ...8-25
- Date/Timer ...8-27
• Function Defaults ...8-42 - Login Operation ...8-66
• RAM Disk Mode ...8-67
How to display the Sys. Menu/Count. menu


text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK [01] Report [02] Counter [03] System [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
When you are performing user management and have not logged in, a login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password to log in.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
2 The Sys. Menu/Count. menu appears.
Switching the Language for Display [Language]
You can select the language of the message display by following the procedure given below. You can optionally download messages in other languages. Contact your service technician for information.
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 1](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/9562ac1eaec6547c653a4c0fe58f59a7469580a4742e8b089447f422c6cd2c0e.jpg)
text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 2](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/1910e6b4ac6cefa9ba7cfab6f0187d76c6fde7209ac5a110956d3736cb6c6228.jpg)
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Switching the Language for Display [Language] - 3](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/dbc3322f211e0789ed5f78084ad0a5175bd536fd12a44cea38265aa54f32c40a.jpg)
text_image
Language: 01 *English 02 Deutsch 03 Français1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Language].
4 Press the OK key. The Language menu appears.
The available languages are as follows:
English
Deutsch
Français
Español
Italiano
Nederlands
Русский
Português
The optional languages are as follows:
| Optional language Message display | |
| Turkish Türkçe | |
| Greek Ελληνικά | |
| Polish Polski | |
| Czech | Český |
| Hungarian Magyar | |
| Finnish Suomi | |
| Hebrew | הַרְׁבָא |
| Arabic | ARBÍK |
| Swedish Svensk | |
| Danish Dansk | |
| Norwegian Norsk | |
| Romanian | Român |
| Korean | 한국어 |
| Simplified Chinese | 简体中文 |
| Traditional Chinese | 繁體中文 |
If you are using one of the optional languages, it is displayed in place of Portugues.
5 Press the or key to select a language.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Default Screen
Select the screen appearing right after start-up (default screen). The options are as follows.
The table below lists the available screens.
| Item Description | |
| Status The Status/Job | Cancel screen (the screen shown when the Status/Job Cancel key is pressed) appears. |
| Copy The Copy screen | (the screen shown when the Copy key is pressed) appears. |
| Send The Send screen | (the screen shown when the Send key is pressed) appears. |
| FAX The FAX screen | (the screen shown when the FAX key is pressed) appears. |
| Document Box The Document Box screen | (the screen shown when the Document Box key is pressed) appears. |
Use the procedure below to select the default startup screen.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Default Screen: 01 Status 02 *Copy 03 FAX1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Default Screen].
4 Press the OK key. Default Screen appears.
5 Press the or key to select the default screen.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Sound
Set options for buzzer sound during the machine operations.
The table below lists the buzzer types and their settings and details. The asterisk in the table is a default setting.
| Item Value | Description | |
| Key Confirmation | Off, On * Emit a sound when the control panel are pressed. | |
| Job Finish Off*, On Emit a sound when a print job is normally completed. | ||
| Ready Off*, On Emit a sound when the warm-up is completed. | ||
| Warning Off, On* Emit a sound when errors occur. | ||
Use the procedure below to set the buzzer sound for Key Confirmation for example.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Sound].

text_image
Sound: 01 Buzzer 02 FAX Speaker 03 FAX Monitor [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. Sound appears.

text_image
Buzzer: [01] Key Confirmation [02] Job finish [03] Ready [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Buzzer].
6 Press the OK key. Buzzer appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Key Confirmation].

text_image
Key Confirmation: OK [01]*Off [02] On8 Press the OK key. Key Confirmation appears.
9 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Buzzer menu.
Display Bright.
Set the brightness of the display.
Use the procedure below to adjust the display brightness.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Display Bright.: 03 Darker -1 04*Normal 0 05 Lighter+13 Press the or key to select [Display Bright.].
4 Press the OK key. Display Bright. appears.
5 Press the or key to select the display brightness from [Darker -3] to [Lighter +3].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Original/Paper Settings
Register additional types and sizes of originals and paper.
Custom Original Size Setup
Set up frequently-used custom original size. The dimensions available are as follows.
The table below lists the sizes that can be registered.
| Input units Dimensions | |
| Inch models X: 1.97 | to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)Y: 1.97 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments) |
| Metric models X: 50 | to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)Y: 50 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments) |
Use the procedure below to set a custom original size.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]
text_image
Size Entry(Y): (1.97 - 8.50) ↑ 8.50"
text_image
Size Entry(X): (1.97 - 14.02) ↔ 14.02 "1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Custom Orig.Size].
6 Press the OK key. Size Entry(Y) appears.
7 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper length (Y).
8 Press the OK key. Size Entry(X) appears.
9 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper width (X).
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Orig./Paper Set. menu.
Default Original Size Setup
In the screen for setting the paper size for the paper feed cassette or multi purpose tray, select the paper size to be used as the default value.
Use the procedure below to select the paper size to be used as the default value.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK [0 1] Custom Orig.Size [0 2] Def. Orig. Size [0 3] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Def. Orig. Size].
6 Press the OK key. Def. Orig. Size appears.

text_image
Def. Orig. Size: 01 *Letter 02 Legal 03 Statement7 Press the or key to select the paper size to be used as the default value.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Orig./Paper Set. menu.
Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print
Set up a frequently-used custom paper size. The custom size options are displayed on the screen to select paper.
The table below lists the sizes that can be registered.
| Input units Dimensions | |
| Inch models Cassette: X: 4.13 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)Y: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)Paper Feeder X: 5.83 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)(Option): Y: 8.27 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)MP Tray: X: 2.75 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)Y: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments) | |
| Metric models Cassette: X: 105 to 216 (in 1 mm increments)Y: 148 to 356 (in 1 mm increments)Paper Feeder X: 148 to 216 (in 1 mm increments)(Option): Y: 210 to 356 (in 1 mm increments)MP Tray: X: 70 to 216 (in 1 mm increments)Y: 148 to 356 (in 1 mm increments) |
NOTE: When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER, a paper size can be set for the cassette.
Custom paper sizes can be added for each paper source.
Use the procedure below to select a custom paper size.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: ◆ OK 01 Custom Orig.Size 02 Def. Orig. Size 03 Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.

text_image
Custom PaperSize 01 Cassette 1 Size 02 Cassette 2 Size 03 Cassette 3 Size5 Press the or key to select [Custom PaperSize].
6 Press the OK key. The Custom PaperSize menu appears.

text_image
Size Entry(Y): (5.83 - 14.02) ↑ 14.02 "7 Select the paper source in which you want to set the custom size and press the OK key. Size Entry(Y) appears.
8 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper length (Y).
9 Press the OK key. Size Entry(X) appears.

text_image
Size Entry(X): (4.13 - 8.50) ↔ 8.50 "10 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper width (X).
11 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Orig./Paper Set. menu.
Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Cassettes
Select paper size and media type for Cassette 1 and optional paper feeders (Cassette 2 to 4).
The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below.
| Item | Description |
| Paper Size Letter, Legal, Statement*, Executive, Oficio II, A4, A5, A6*, B5, Folio, 16K, ISO B5, Envelope C5, Custom | |
| Media Type Plain (105 g/m ^2 or less), Rough, Recycled, Preprint***, Bond**, Color, Prepunched***, Letterhead***, High Quality, Custom 1-8** | |
* Cassette 1 only
** To change to a media type other than Plain, refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16.
*** To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to Special Paper Action on page 8-21.
Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type for each cassette.
NOTE: When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER, a paper size can be set for the cassette.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Cassette 1 Set.], [Cassette 2 Set.], [Cassette 3 Set.] or [Cassette 4 Set.].
Follow the steps below when you select the main unit cassette ([Cassette 1]). Operate in a similar fashion

text_image
Cassette 1 Set.: 01 Cassette 1 Size 02 Cassette 1 Type [ Exit ]
text_image
Cassette 1 Size: 12 ISO B5 13 Envelope C5 14 *Custom
text_image
Cassette 1 Set.: [0 1] Cassette 1 Size [0 2] Cassette 1 Type [ Exit ]
text_image
Cassette 1 Type: [0 1] *Plain [0 2] Rough [0 3] Recycledwhen you select an optional cassette ([Cassette 2, 3 or 4])
6 The Cassette 1 Set. menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Cassette 1 Size].
8 Press the OK key. Cassette 1 Size appears.
9 Press the or key to select the paper size.
10 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the Cassette 1 Set. menu.
11 Press the or key to select [Cassette 1 Type].
12 Press the OK key. Cassette 1 Type appears.
13 Press the or key to select the paper type.
14 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Cassette 1 Set. menu.
Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Multi Purpose Tray
Select size and media type for multi purpose tray. Set up frequently-used size and media type before use.
The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below.
| Item Description | |
| Paper Size | Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki, Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2, Custom* |
| Media Type | Plain (105 g/m ^2 or less), Transparency, Rough, Vellum (64 g/m ^2 or less), Labels, Recycled, Preprinted**, Bond, Cardstock, Color, Prepunched**, Letterhead**, Envelope, Thick (106 g/m ^2 and more), High Quality, Custom 1-8** |
* Refer to Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print on page 8-10 for selecting Custom Paper Size.
** Refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16 for selecting Custom 1-8 from Media Type.
To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to Special Paper Action on page 8-21.
NOTE: To change to a media type other than Plain, refer to Paper Weight on page 8-16
Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type for manual paper feed.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: ◆ OK 01 Custom Orig.Size 02 Def. Orig. Size 03 Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Set.].

text_image
MP Tray Set.: [01] MP Tray Size [02] MP Tray Type [ Exit ]
text_image
MP Tray Size: 01 *A4 02 A5 03 A6
text_image
MP Tray Set.: 01 MP Tray Size 02 MP Tray Type [ Exit ]
text_image
MP Tray Type: [0 1] *Plain [0 2] Transparency [0 3] Rough6 Press the OK key. The MP Tray Set. menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Size].
8 Press the OK key. MP Tray Size appears.
9 Press the or key to select the paper size.
10 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the MP Tray Set. menu.
11 Press the or key to select [MP Tray Type].
12 Press the OK key. MP Tray Type appears.
13 Press the or key to select the paper type.
14 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the MP Tray Set. menu.
Paper Weight
The machine is capable of printing under the optimum setting for the type of paper being used. A different paper type setting can be made for each paper source including the MP tray. Not only can preset paper types be selected, but it is also possible for you to define and select customized paper types. Paper type can be changed using the printer driver and the operation panel. The following types of paper can be used.
IMPORTANT: If selecting the paper weight, print quality may be poor because of improper fixing of toner.
| Paper Type | Paper source | Paper Weight Displayed in Operation Panel | Duplex path | |
| MP tray | Paper Cassette | |||
| Plain Yes Yes Normal2 Yes | ||||
| Transparency Yes No Extra Heavy No | ||||
| Preprinted Yes Yes Normal2 Yes | ||||
| Labels Yes No Heavy1 No | ||||
| Bond Yes Yes Normal3 Yes | ||||
| Recycled Yes Yes Normal2 Yes | ||||
| Vellum | Yes | No | Light | No |
| Rough Yes Yes Normal3 Yes | ||||
| Letterhead | Yes Yes | Normal3 Yes | ||
| Color | Yes Yes | Normal3 Yes | ||
| Prepunched | Yes Yes | Normal2 Yes | ||
| Envelope | Yes No | Heavy3 No | ||
| Cardstock | Yes No | Heavy3 No | ||
| Thick | Yes No | Heavy3 No | ||
| High quality | Yes Yes | Normal2 Yes | ||
| Custom 1 (to 8)* | Yes Yes | Normal2 Yes | ||
| Yes: Can be stored No: Cannot be stored | ||||
* This is a paper type defined and registered by the user. Up to eight types of user settings may be defined. User can also enable or disable the duplex path when using Custom.
For Custom 1-8, settings for duplex printing and media type name can be changed.
| Item | Description | |
| Duplex | Prohibit | Duplex printing not allowed. |
| Permit | Duplex printing allowed. | |
| Name | Change names for Custom 1-8. Names should be not more than 16 characters.Selecting media type at multi purpose tray, the name after change will be displayed. | |
Use the procedure below to set the paper weight.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: ◆ OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]
text_image
Media type Set.: OK [01] Plain [02] Transparency [03] Rough [ Exit ]
text_image
Plain: [0] Paper Weight [ Exit ]
text_image
Paper Weight: 05 Normal 3 06 *Normal 2 07 Normal 11 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Media Type Set.].
6 Press the OK key. Media Type Set. menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select the paper type for which you want to make settings.
8 Press the OK key. The menu for the selected paper type appears.
9 Press the or key to select [Paper Weight].
10 Press the OK key. The Paper Weight menu appears.
11 Press the or key to select the weight of paper.

text_image
Plain: [01] Paper Weight [ Exit ]12 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the menu for the selected paper type.

text_image
Custom X: [0 1] Paper Weight [0 2] Duplex [0 3] Name [ Exit ]When the selected paper type is [Custom 1 to 8], you can further set whether to enable or disable duplex and the name of the custom paper type.

text_image
Duplex: [01] Permit [02] Prohibit [ Exit ]13 Press the or key to select [Duplex].
14 Press the OK key. The Duplex menu appears.
15 Press the or key to select whether to enable or disable duplex.
16 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the menu for the selected custom paper type.

text_image
Custom X: [0 1] Paper Weight [0 2] Duplex [0 3] Name [ Exit ]17 Press the or key to select [Name].
18 Press the OK key. Name Entry is displayed. Enter the name of the custom paper type.

text_image
Name Entry: RD Center ABC [ Text ]NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters. 19 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the menu for the selected custom paper type.

text_image
Custom X: 01 Paper Weight 02 Duplex 03 Name [ Exit ]Media for Auto Selection
When [Auto] is selected in Paper Selection, the paper source that is automatically selected can be limited by media types. If Plain is selected, the paper source with plain paper loaded in the specific size is selected. Select [All Media Types] for the paper source with any kind of paper loaded in the specific size.
Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type used by Auto Selection.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Media for Auto].
6 Press the OK key. Media for Auto appears.

text_image
Media for Auto: 01 All Media Type 02*Plain 03 Transparency7 Press the or key to select [All Media Type] or the paper type to be used for paper selection.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Orig./Paper Set. menu.
Default Paper Source
Select the default paper source from Cassette 1-4 and Multi Purpose Tray.
NOTE: [Cassette 2], [Cassette 3] and [Cassette 4] are displayed when the optional paper feeder installed.
Use the procedure below to select the default paper source.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: OK 01 Custom Orig.Size 02 Def. Orig. Size 03 Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.

text_image
Def. PaperSurce: 01 *Cassette 1 02 Cassette 2 03 Cassette 35 Press the or key to select [Def. PaperSource].
6 Press the OK key. Def. PaperSource appears.
7 Press the or key to select the paper source to be used preferentially.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Special Paper Action
When printing on Prepunched, Preprint, and Letterhead, punch-holes might not be aligned or the print direction might be upside-down depending on how originals are set and the combination of copying functions. In such a case, select [Adj. PrintDirect] to adjust the print direction. When paper orientation is not important, select [Speed Priority].
The table below lists the available settings and their details.
| Item Description | |
| Adj. PrintDirect Adjust print | direction. Print speed is a little slower. Select this item to print on Prepunched, Preprint and Letterhead. |
| Speed Priority Give the job | speed top priority and disregard the paper orientation. Select this item when paper orientation is not important. |
If you select [Adj. PrintDirect], load paper according to the steps below.
Example: copying on Letterhead

Original


Finished

Cassette

Multi Purpose TrayPape

Original

Paper

Finished

Cassette Multi Purpose Tray

NOTE: When loading cover paper in a multi purpose tray, load the face, on which printing is supposed to be done, upward. When loading cover paper in a cassette, load the face, on which printing is supposed to be done, down.
Use the procedure below to specify the actions performed for special paper types.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Orig./Paper Set.: ◆ OK [01] Custom Orig.Size [02] Def. Orig. Size [03] Custom PaperSize [ Exit ]
text_image
SpciaPaper Act.: ◆ OK [01]*Adj. PrintDirect [02] Speed Priority
text_image
SpecialPaper Act.: ◆ OK 01 Adj. PrintDirect 02 *Speed Priority2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Orig./Paper Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Orig./Paper Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [SpecialPaper Act.].
6 Press the OK key. SpcialPaper Act. appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Adj. PrintDirect] or [Speed Priority].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Orig./Paper Set. menu.
Preset Limit
Restrict the number of copies that can be made at one time. Options are 1-999 copies.
Use the procedure below to set the limit on the number of copies.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Preset Limit: (1 - 999) 9991 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Preset Limit].
4 Press the OK key. The Preset Limit menu appears.
5 Press the or key to enter the number of copies.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Switching Unit of Measurement
Select inch or metric for the unit for paper dimensions.
Use the procedure below to change the input units.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Measurement: [0 1] * inch [0 2] mm1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Measurement].
4 Press the OK key. The Measurement menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [inch] or [mm].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
Error Handling
Select whether to cancel or continue the job when error has occurred. The possible errors and what to do for the errors are as follows.
Duplexing Error
Select what to do when duplex printing is not possible for the selected paper size and media type.
| Item Description | |
| 1-sided Printed in 1-sided | |
| Display Error Error message to cancel printing is displayed. | |
Paper Mismatch Error
Select the method to handle if the selected paper size or paper type does not match the paper size or paper type set in the paper source when printing from your computer.
| Item Description | |
| Ignore Printing continues. | |
| Display Error Error message to cancel printing is displayed. | |
Use the procedure below to specify the settings for error handling.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Error Handling: [0 1] DuplexPaperError [0 2] PaperMismatchErr [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Error Handling].
4 Press the OK key. The Error Handling menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [DuplexPaperError].

text_image
DuplexPaperError: ◆ OK [0 1] * 1-sided [0 2] Display Error6 Press the OK key. DuplexPaperError appears.
7 Press the or key to select the method to handle if duplex is disabled.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Error Handling menu.
9 Press the or key to select [PagerMismatchErr].
10 Press the OK key. PagerMismatchErr appears.
11 Press the or key to select the method to handle paper mismatch.
12 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Error Handling menu.
Date/Timer
Date/Timer settings include:
- Date/Time ...8-27
- Date Format ...8-29
- Time Zone ...8-30
- Summer Time ...8-31
• Auto Error Clear ...8-32 - Auto Sleep ...8-34
• Auto Panel Reset ...8-37 - Low Power Timer ...8-39
- Unusable Time ...8-40
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
Date/Time
Set the date and time for the location where you use the machine. If you perform Send as E-mail, the date and time set here will be displayed on the header.
CAUTION: Be sure to set Time Zone before the Date/Time setup.
Use the procedure below to set the date and time.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Date Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Date Setting: 01 Date/Time 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone [ Exit ]
text_image
Date/Time: Year Month Day 2011 01 01 (Time Zone:Greenwich)
text_image
Date/Time: Hour Min. Second 11 : 45: 50 (Time Zone:Greenwich)4 The Date Settings menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Date/Time].
6 Press the OK key. The screen to enter the date of Date/Time appears.
7 Set the date.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move to the item (Year / Month / Day) you want to enter.
Press the or key to set each item.
8 Press the OK key. The screen to enter the time of Date/Time appears.
9 Set the time.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move to the item (Hour / Min. / Second) you want to enter.
Press the or key to set each item.
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Settings menu.
NOTE: If you try to change the date/time when a trial application (page 8-150) is running, the If you change Date/Time setting, trial functions will be unavailable. Are you sure? message is displayed. To change the date/time, press Yes.
Date Format
Select the display format of year, month, and date. The year is displayed in Western notation.
Use the procedure below to select the date format.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Date Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Date Setting: 01 Date/Time 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone [ Exit ]4 The Date Settings menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Date Format]
6 Press the OK key. Date Format appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Month/Day/Year], [Day/Month/Year] or [Year/Month/Day].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Settings menu.
Time Zone
Set the time difference in the location you are from GMT.
Use the procedure below to set the time difference.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Date Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Menu ] [ Login ]
text_image
Date Setting: 01 Date/Time 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone [ Exit ]4 The Date Settings menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Time Zone].
6 Press the OK key. Time Zone appears.

text_image
Time Zone: 30 GMT Casablanca *GMT Greenwich 32 +01:00 Amsterdam7 Press the or key to select your location.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Settings menu.
NOTE: If you select a region that does not utilize summer time, the summer time setting screen will not appear.
Summer Time
Set whether or not to apply summer time to the display of the date.
Use the procedure below to set Summer Time.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Date Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
Date Setting: 02 Date Format 03 Time Zone 04 Summer Time [ Exit ]4 The Date Settings menu appears.

text_image
Summer Time: [01]*Off [02] On5 Press the or key to select [Summer Time].
6 Press the OK key. Summer Time appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Date Settings menu.
Auto Error Clear
If an error occurs during printing, the print job stops to wait for the next step to be taken by the user. In the Auto Error Clear mode, automatically clear the error after a set amount of time elapses.
The following errors are automatically cleared.
Cannot duplex print on this paper.
Send error.
Cannot connect to Authentication Server.
Incorrect account ID. Job is canceled.
Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Cannot print.
Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Cannot scan.
Job not stored. Press [OK].
Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Job is canceled.
Polling box limit exceeded. Job is canceled.
Memory is full. Print job cannot be processed completely.
Maximum Number of scanned pages. Job is canceled.
Print overrun. Job is paused.
KPDL error. Job is canceled.
USB memory error. Job is canceled.
No multi copies. Press [OK].
• Auto Error Clear ON/OFF
Select whether to use Auto Error Clear or not.
Use the procedure below to specify the auto error clear setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Timer Setting: 01 Sleep Timer 02 PanelReset Timer 03 Low Power Timer [ Exit ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Auto Err. Clear: ◆ OK [0 1] * Off [0 2] On5 Press the or key to select [Auto Err. Clear].
6 Press the OK key. Auto Err. Clear appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
- Error Clear Timer
If you select [On] for Auto Error Clear, set the amount of time to wait before automatically clearing errors. Options are between 5 and 495 seconds (every five seconds). The default setting is 30 seconds.
If you set 0 as the time, errors are not displayed.
NOTE: If you select [Off] for Auto Error Clear, the time display does not appear.
Use the procedure below to set the automatic error clear delay.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Timer Setting: [0 1] Err. Clear Timer [0 2] Sleep Timer [0 3] PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Err. Clear Timer: * (5 - 495) 30 sec.5 Press the or key to select [Err. Clear Timer].
6 Press the OK key. Err. Clear Timer appears.
7 Press the or key to set the Error Clear Timer. Set the amount of time before clearing errors in seconds. You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this value.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
Auto Sleep
If no job runs for a certain period of time, automatically enter Sleep Mode. Refer to Sleep and Auto Sleep on page 2-8 for Sleep Mode.
- Auto Sleep ON/OFF
Select whether to use Auto Sleep or not. The default setting is On.
NOTE: Time remaining before Auto Sleep can be modified as necessary.
Use the procedure below to specify the auto sleep setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Timer Setting: 01 Err. Clear Timer 02 Sleep Timer 03 PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Auto Sleep].
6 Press the OK key. Auto Sleep appears.

text_image
Auto Sleep: 01 Off 02*On7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
- Sleep Timer
If you select [On] for Auto Sleep, set the amount of time to wait before Auto Sleep. Options are between 1 and 240 minutes (every one minute)
Use the procedure below to set the Auto Sleep time. The default setting is 15 minutes.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Timer Setting: 01 Err. Clear Timer 02 Sleep Timer 03 PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Sleep Timer].
6 Press the OK key. Sleep Timer appears.

text_image
Sleep Timer: (1 - 240) 15 min.7 Press the or key to set the Sleep Timer. Set the amount of time before entering the sleep state in minutes. You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this value.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
Auto Panel Reset
If no jobs are run for a certain period of time, automatically reset settings and return to the default setting.
NOTE: Refer to page 8-42 for the default settings.
• Auto Panel Reset ON/OFF
Select to use Auto Panel Reset or not.
Use the procedure below to specify the auto panel reset setting. The default setting is On.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
8

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Timer Setting: 01 Err. Clear Timer 02 Sleep Timer 03 PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Auto Panel Reset: ◆ OK 01 Off 02 *On5 Press the or key to select [Auto Panel Reset].
6 Press the OK key. Auto Panel Reset appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
- Panel Reset Timer
If you select [On] for Auto Panel Reset, set the amount of time to wait before Auto Panel Reset. Options are between 5 and 495 seconds (every five seconds). The default setting is 90 seconds.
NOTE: If you select [Off] for Auto Panel Reset, the time display does not appear.
Use the procedure below to set the reset time.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.

text_image
Timer Setting: [0] Err. Clear Timer [0 2] Sleep Timer [0 3] PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
4 The Timer Settings menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Panel Reset Timer].

text_image
PanelReset Timer: OK (5 - 495) 90 sec.6 Press the OK key. Panel Reset Timer appears.
7 Press the or key to set the Panel Reset Timer. Set the amount of time before resetting the message display on the panel in seconds. You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this value.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
Low Power Timer
You can specify the amount of time to wait before Low Power Mode.
Specify a value from 1 - 240 minutes (1 minute increments). The default setting is 2 minutes.
For more information on Low Power Mode, refer to Auto Low Power Mode on page 2-8.
Use the procedure below to set the Low Power Mode.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: ◆ OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Timer Setting: [01] Err. Clear Timer [02] Sleep Timer [03] PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Low Power Timer: ⋆ OK (1 - 240) 2 min.5 Press the or key to select [Low Power Timer].
6 Press the OK key. Low Power Timer appears.
7 Press the or key or numeric keys to set the Low Power Timer. Set the amount of time before entering the low power state in minutes.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
Unusable Time
You can specify the prohibition period to use.
NOTE: Even during unusable time, the machine can be operated by entering the Unlock Code.
Use the procedure below to set the Unusable Time.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]3 Press the or key to select [Timer Setting], and press the OK key.
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Timer Setting: 01 Err. Clear Timer 02 Sleep Timer 03 PanelReset Timer [ Exit ]4 The Timer Settings menu appears.

text_image
Unusable Time: [07] *Off [08] On [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Unusable Time].
6 Press the OK key. Unusable Time appears.
7 Press the or key to select [On].
8 Press the OK key. Start Time appears.
9 Press the or key to set the Start Time.
9 Press the or key to set the Start Time.
10 Press the OK key. End Time appears.

text_image
Start Time: Hour Min. 00: 00 (Current Time 11:45)
text_image
End Time: Hour Min. 00: 00 (Current Time 11:45)
text_image
Unlock Code: (0000 - 9999) 000011 Press the or key to set the End Time.
12 Press the OK key. Unlock Code appears.
13 Press the or key or numeric keys to set the unlock code.
14 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Timer Settings menu.
Function Defaults
Defaults are the values automatically set after the warm-up is completed or the Reset key is pressed.
Set the defaults for available settings such as copying and sending. Setting the frequently-used values as defaults makes subsequent jobs easier.
Color Selection
Select the default color mode setting. The available default settings are shown below.
| Color mode Description | |
| Full Color Scan document in full color. | |
| Grayscale Scan document in grayscale for smoother and finer finish. | |
| Black & White Scan document in black and white. |
Use the procedure below to select the default color mode setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Color Selection].
6 Press the OK key. Color Selection appears.

text_image
Color Selection: 01*Full Color 02 Grayscale 03 Black & White7 Press the or key to select [Full Color], [Grayscale] or [Black & White].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Scan Resolution
Select the default scanning resolution. The options are 600x600dpi, 400x400dpi U.Fin (Ultra Fine), 300x300dpi, 200x400dpi S.Fin (Super Fine), 200x200dpi Fine, 200x100dpi Norm. (Normal).
Use the procedure below to select the default resolution setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Scan Resolution [0 3] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
Scan Resolution: OK 03 200x400dpi S.Fin 04 *300x300dpi 05 400x400dpi U.Fin1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Scan Resolution].
6 Press the OK key. Scan Resolution appears.
7 Press the or key to select [200x100dpi Norm.], [200x200dpi Fine], [200x400dpi S.Fin], [300x300dpi], [400x400dpi U.Fin] or [600x600dpi].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Original Image
Set the default original document type. The available default settings are shown below.
| Item | Description |
| Text+Photo Text and photos together. | |
| Photo For photos taken with a camera. | |
| Text Only text, no photos. | |
| for OCR Image quality suitable for OCR software. | |
Use the procedure below to select the default quality setting for originals.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
Original Image: [0 1] *Text+Photo [0 2] Photo [0 3] Text1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Original Image].
6 Press the OK key. Original Image appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Text+Photo], [Photo], [Text] or [for OCR].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Density
Set the default density. The available default settings are shown below.
| Item | Description |
| Manual (Normal 0) Set to | (Normal 0) in the Manual density. |
| Auto Set to Auto density. |
Use the procedure below to select the default zoom setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Density].
6 Press the OK key. Density appears.

text_image
Density: 01 Auto 02*Manual7 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Manual].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Zoom
Select the enlarged/reduced default when paper size/sending size changed after the originals set. The available default settings are shown below.
| Item | Description |
| 100% Copy (send/save) at actual size (100%). | |
| Auto Automatically reduce or enlarge the originals to match paper size/ sending size. | |
Use the procedure below to select the default zoom setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: ◆ OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Zoom].
6 Press the OK key. Zoom appears.

text_image
Zoom: [0 1] * 100% [0 2] Auto7 Press the or key to select [100%] or [Auto].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Collate
Set the defaults for Collate. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| Collate Off Collate not performed. | |
| On Collate performed. |
NOTE: Refer to page 3-15 for Collate/Offset.
Use the procedure below to set the default Collate/Offset settings.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Scan Resolution [0 3] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Collate].
6 Press the OK key. Collate appears.

text_image
Collate: 01 Off 02 *On7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Orig.Orientation
Set the original orientation defaults. The available default settings are shown below.
| Item Description |
| Top Edge Top Select the original's top edge at the top. |
| Top Edge Left Select the original's top edge at the left. |
Refer to page 4-6 for Original Orientation.
Use the procedure below to select the default orientation when originals are placed on the platen.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Scan Resolution [0 3] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Orig.Orientation: OK 0 1 Top Edge Top 0 2 * Top Edge Left5 Press the or key to select [Orig.Orientation].
6 Press the OK key. Orig.Orientation appears.
7 Press the or key to select [☐ Top Edge Top] or [☐ Top Edge Left].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
EcoPrint
Select the EcoPrint default. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| Off No EcoPrint performed. | |
| On EcoPrint performed. |
NOTE: Refer to page 4-8 for EcoPrint.
Use the procedure below to set the default EcoPrint setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: OK [0] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
EcoPrint: [01]*Off [02] On1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [EcoPrint].
6 Press the OK key. EcoPrint appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
File Name Entry
Set an automatically entered name (default) for jobs. Additional information such as Date and Time and Job No. can also be set.
The table below lists the additional information available.
| Item | Description |
| None No additional information available. | |
| Date Adds date and time. | |
| Job No. Adds the job number. | |
| Job No. + Date Adds the job number plus date and time. | |
| Date + Job No. Adds date and time plus the job number. | |
NOTE:
• Refer to page 4-16 and page 5-17 for name entry.
• Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
Use the procedure below to set the default file name.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [File Name Entry].

text_image
File name Entry: doc 1 ABC [ Text ]6 Press the OK key. File Name Entry appears. Enter the document name (up to 32 characters).

text_image
Additional Info.: OK 03 Job No. 04 *Job No.+Date 05 Date+Job No.7 Press the OK key. Additional Info appears.
8 Press the or key to select [None], [Date], [JobNo.], [JobNo. + Date] or [Date + JobNo.].
9 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Subject/Body
Set the subject and body automatically entered (default subject and body) when sending the scanned originals by E-mail.
NOTE:
• Refer to Send as E-mail on page 3-19.
• Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
Use the procedure below to set the default e-mail subject and message body.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].

text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Subject Entry: ABC [ Text ]5 Press the or key to select [Subject/Body].
6 Press the OK key. Subject Entry appears. Enter the e-mail subject (up to 60 characters).
If you press the Back key, you can return to the Function Default menu.

text_image
Body Entry: ABC [ Text ]7 Press the OK key. Body Entry appears. Enter e-mail body text (up to 500 characters).
If you press the Back key, you can return to Subject Entry.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
Continuous Scan
Set the continuous scan defaults. The available default settings are shown below.
| Item | Description |
| Off Continuous scan not performed | |
| On Continuous scan performed | |
Refer to page 4-6 for Original Orientation.
Use the procedure below to select the default settings for continuous scanning.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Continuous Scan].
6 Press the OK key. Continuous Scan appears.

text_image
Continuous Scan: OK [0 1] * Off [0 2] On7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
File Format
Select the default file type to send the scanned originals. The available default settings are shown below.
| File Format Description | |
| PDF Send files in PDF format. | |
| TIFF Send files in TIFF format. | |
| XPS Send files in XPS format. | |
| JPEG Send files in JPEG format. |
NOTE: Refer to page 5-10 for file formats.
Use the procedure below to select the default file format.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Scan Resolution [0 3] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
File Format: [0 1] *PDF [0 2] TIFF [0 3] XPS1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [File Format].
6 Press the OK key. File Format appears.
7 Press the or key to select [PDF], [TIFF], [XPS] or [JPEG].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
File Separation
Select the default file separation setting. The available default settings are shown below.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
File Separation: [0 1] *Off [0 2] Each Page5 Press the or key to select [File Separation].
6 Press the OK key. File Separation appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [Each Page].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
TIFF Print
Select the TIFF Print default. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| Paper Size Scaled to fit the paper size. | |
| Image Resolution Matched to the image resolution. | |
| Print Resolution Matched to the print resolution. | |
NOTE: Refer to page 6-3 for TIFF Print.
Use the procedure below to set the default TIFF Print setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [TIFF Print].
6 Press the OK key. TIFF Print appears.

text_image
TIFF Print: [0 1] * Paper Size [0 2] Image Resolution □ [0 3] Print Resolution □7 Press the or key to select [Paper Size], [Image Resolution] or [Print Resolution].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
XPS FitTo Page
Select the XPS FitTo Page default.
NOTE: Refer to page 6-4 for XPS FitTo Page.
Use the procedure below to set the default XPS FitTo Page setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
XPS FitTo Page: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On5 Press the or key to select [XPS FitTo Page].
6 Press the OK key. XPS FitTo Page appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Function Default menu.
2 in 1 Layout
Select the default value for layout when [2 in 1] is selected for Combine. Items available for the default value are as follows:
| Item Description | |
| L to R T to B | Arranges from left to right or top to bottom. |
| R to L Arranges from right to left. | |
Use the procedure below to select the default value for layout.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].

text_image
Function Default: a b 1 Color Selection 2 Scan Resolution 3 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Detail Setting: a b 1 2 in 1 layout 2 4 in 1 Layout 3 Border Line [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.

text_image
2 in 1 Layout a b 1 * L to R T to B 2 R to L7 Press the or key to select [2 in 1 Layout].
8 Press the OK key. 2 in 1 Layout appears.
9 Press the or key to select [L to R T to B] or [R to L].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
4 in 1 Layout
Select the default value for layout when [4 in 1] is selected for Combine. Items available for the default value are as follows:
| Item Description | |
| Right then Down Arranges from upper left to right. | |
| Down then Right | Arranges from upper left to bottom. |
| Left then Down Arranges from upper right to left. | |
| Down then Left Arranges from upper right to bottom. | |
Use the procedure below to select the default value for layout.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: a b 3 System 4 User/Job Account 5 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Function Default: OK [01] Color Selection [02] Scan Resolution [03] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
Detail Setting: [0 1] 2 in 1 layout [0 2] 4 in 1 Layout [0 3] Border Line [ Exit ]
text_image
4 in 1 Layout: [0 1] * Z Right then Down [0 2] ↓ Down then Right [0 3] ← Left then Down2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [4 in 1 Layout].
8 Press the OK key. 4 in 1 Layout appears.
9 Press the or key to select [Z Right then Down], [14 Down then Right], [Σ Left then Down] or [N Down then Left].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Border Line
Select the default value for border line when [2 in 1] is selected for Combine. Items available for the default value are as follows:
| Item Description | |
| None No border line. | |
| Solid Line Draws solid border lines. | |
| Dotted Line Draws dotted border lines. | |
| Positioning Mark Puts a mark on the border line position. |
Use the procedure below to select the default value for border line.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: OK [0 1] Color Selection [0 2] Scan Resolution [0 3] FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Detail Setting: [0 1] 2 in 1 layout [0 2] 4 in 1 Layout [0 3] Border Line [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Border Line].

text_image
Border Line: 01 * None 02 | Solid Line 03 : Dotted Line8 Press the OK key. Border Line appears.
9 Press the or key to select [ None], [ | Solid Line], [ : Dotted Line] or [ + Positioning Mark].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Orig. Binding
Select the default value for the binding edge of the original when [2-sided>>1-sided] or [2-sided>>2-sided] is selected for Duplex. Items available for the default value are as follows:
| Item Description | |
| Left/Right Left/right binding | |
| Top Top binding | |
8
Use the procedure below to select the default value for the binding edge of the original.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
Function Default: ◆ OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].
4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].

text_image
Detail Setting: 01 2 in 1 layout 02 4 in 1 Layout 03 Border Line [ Exit ]6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.

text_image
Orig. Binding: 01 * Left/Right 02 Top7 Press the or key to select [Orig. Binding].
8 Press the OK key. Orig. Binding appears.
9 Press the or key to select [☑ Left/Right] or [☑ Top].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Finish Binding
Select the default value for the binding edge of the finished copies when [1-sided>>2-sided] or [2-sided>>2-sided] is selected for Duplex. Items available for the default value are as follows:
| Item Description | |
| Left/Right Left/right binding | |
| Top Top binding |
Use the procedure below to select the default value for the binding edge of the finished copies.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: 01 Language 02 Default Screen 03 Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].

text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Detail Setting: [0 1] 2 in 1 layout [0 2] 4 in 1 Layout [0 3] Border Line [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Finish Binding].
8 Press the OK key. Finish Binding appears.

text_image
Finish.. Binding: OK [0 1] * Left/Right [0 2] Top9 Press the or key to select [ Left/Right] or [ Top].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Image Quality
Select the default value for image quality when File Format is selected. Select the default value in the range from [1 Low(High Comp)] (high compression) to [5 High(Low Comp)] (low compression).
Use the procedure below to select the default value for image quality.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].

text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.

text_image
Detail Setting: [0 1] 2 in 1 layout [0 2] 4 in 1 Layout [0 3] Border Line [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Image Quality].
8 Press the OK key. Image Quality appears.

text_image
Image Quality: [0 1] * 1 Low(High Comp) [0 2] 2 [0 3] 39 Press the or key to select from [1 Low(High Comp)] to [5 High(Low Comp)].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Color TIFF Comp.
Set the default value for compression method for TIFF images handled by this machine.
Use the procedure below to set the default value for color TIFF compression method.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [01] Language [02] Default Screen [03] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Function Default].

text_image
Function Default: OK 01 Color Selection 02 Scan Resolution 03 FAX Resolution [ Exit ]
text_image
Detail Setting: [0 1] 2 in 1 layout [0 2] 4 in 1 Layout [0 3] Border Line [ Exit ]
text_image
Color TIFF Comp.: OK [01]*TIFF V6 [02] TTN24 Press the OK key. The Function Default menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Detail Setting].
6 Press the OK key. The Detail Setting menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Color TIFF Comp.].
8 Press the OK key. Color TIFF Comp. appears.
9 Press the or key to select [TIFF V6] or [TTN2].
10 Press the OK key. Completed, is displayed and the screen returns to the Detail Setting menu.
Login Operation
Specify the character entry method in the login screen that appears when user management is enabled.
| Item Description | |
| Use Numeric Key Use the characters. | numeric keys to select and enter characters. |
| Select Character Enter characters by selecting them from.the character palette that appears. | |
Use the procedure below to adjust the Login Operation.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Common Settings: [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]
text_image
Login Operation: OK [0 1] *Use Numeric Key [0 2] Select Character1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].
2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Login Operation].
4 Press the OK key. Login Operation appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Use Numeric Key] or [Select Character].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Common Settings menu.
RAM Disk Mode
When optional memory is installed, a RAM disk can be created and its size can be set. Creating a RAM disk makes it possible to print from a Job Box.
The procedure for setting the RAM Disk Mode is explained below.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 03 System 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Common Settings].

text_image
Common Settings: OK [0 1] Language [0 2] Default Screen [0 3] Sound [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Common Settings menu appears.

text_image
RAM Disk Mode: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On3 Press the or key to select [RAM Disk Mode].
4 Press the OK key. RAM Disk Mode appears.

text_image
RAM Disk Size: (1 - 64) 64 MB5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 If [On] is selected and the OK key is pressed, the RAM disk size screen appears.
If [Off] is selected and the OK key is pressed, proceed to step 8.

text_image
Restart. Are you sure? [ Yes ] [ No ]7 Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the size of the RAM disk.
8 A confirmation screen appears. Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The machine is restarted.
Copy Settings
The following settings are available for copying functions.
• Photo Processing ...8-68
• Paper Selection ...8-69
• Auto Paper Selection ...8-70
• Auto % Priority ...8-71
- Select Key Set ...8-72
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
Photo Processing
Set the resolution for copying a photo.
| Item Description | |
| Dithering(Normal) Sets the resolution to standard. | |
| Dithering(Rough) Sets the resolution to low. | |
Use the procedure below to set Photo Processing.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings 06 Copy [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Copy].

text_image
Copy: 01 Photo Processing 02 Paper Selection 03 AutoPaperSelect. [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Copy menu appears.

text_image
Photo Processing: OK [01]*Dithering(Normal) [02] Dithering(Rough)3 Press the or key to select [Photo Processing].
4 Press the OK key. Photo Processing appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Dithering(Normal)] or [Dithering(Rough)].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy menu.
Paper Selection
Set the default paper selection. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| Auto Automatically select the cassette containing paper in the same size as originals. | |
| Def. PaperSource Select paper source set by Default Paper Source (refer to page 8-20). | |
Use the procedure below to set the default paper selection.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings 06 Copy [ Exit ]
text_image
Copy: 01 Photo Processing 02 Paper Selection 03 AutoPaperSelect. [ Exit ]
text_image
Paper Selection: ◆ OK [01]*Auto [02] Def. PaperSource1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Copy].
2 Press the OK key. The Copy menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Paper Selection].
4 Press the OK key. Paper Selection appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Def. Paper Source].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy menu.
Auto Paper Selection
If [Auto] is selected for Paper Selection, set the paper size selection method when the zoom changes. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| MostSuitableSize Select paper based on the current zoom and the size of the original. | |
| Same as OrigSize Select paper that matches the size of the original, regardless the zoom. | |
Use the procedure below to specify the action performed for Auto Paper Selection.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 0.4 User/Job Account 0.5 Common Settings 0.6 Copy [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Copy].

text_image
Copy: 01 Photo Processing 02 Paper Selection 03 AutoPaperSelect. [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Copy menu appears.

text_image
AutoPaperSelect.: ◆ OK [01]*MostSuitableSize [02] Same as OrigSize3 Press the or key to select [AutoPaperSelect.].
4 Press the OK key. AutoPaperSelect. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [MostSuitableSize] or [Same as OrigSize].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy menu.
Auto % Priority
When a paper source of different size from the original is selected, select whether automatic zoom (reduce/zoom) is performed.
The table below shows the available settings. The default setting is Off.
| Item Detail | |
| Off No zoom performed (copied in original size). | |
| On Automatic zoom performed as appropriate. | |
Use the procedure below to specify the automatic zoom priority.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 0.4 User/Job Account 0.5 Common Settings 0.6 Copy [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Copy].

text_image
Copy: 01 Photo Processing 02 Paper Selection 03 AutoPaperSelect. [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Copy menu appears.

text_image
Auto % Priority: 01 *Off 02 On3 Press the or key to select [Auto % Priority].
4 Press the OK key. AutoPaperSelect. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy menu.
Select Key Set
If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key, you can quickly set the function when using copy functions.
You can register one of the following functions to each key.
- None
- Paper Selection
- Collate
- Duplex
• Z o o m - Combine
• Original Size - Orig.Orientation
- Original Image
- Density
- EcoPrint
- Continuous Scan
- File Name Entry
- JobFinish Notice
- Print Override
Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 Common Settings 06 Copy [ Exit ]
text_image
Copy: 01 Photo Processing 02 Paper Selection 03 AutoPaperSelect. [ Exit ]
text_image
Select Key Set.: [01] Left [02] Right [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Copy].
2 Press the OK key. The Copy menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Select Key Set.].
4 Press the OK key. Select Key Set. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Left] or [Right].

text_image
Left: 0.4 Duplex 0.5 *Zoom 0.6 Combine6 Press the OK key. This displays the function selection screen for the flexible key selected in step 5. The screen shown is the one when [Left] is selected.
7 Press the or key to select the function you want to register to the flexible key.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy menu.
This function is already registered.
IMPORTANT: If you try to set the function that is registered to the other flexible key, you cannot set it and This function is already registered. is displayed.
Printer Settings
Printing from computers, settings are generally made on the application software screen. However, the following settings are available for configuring the defaults to customize the machine.
- Emulation Set ...8-74
- EcoPrint ...8-77
- Override A4/LTR ...8-78
- Duplex ...8-79
- Copies ...8-80
- Orientation ...8-81
- FormFeed Timeout ...8-82
- LF Action ...8-82
- CR Action ...8-83
• Paper Feed Mode...8-84
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
Emulation Set
Select the emulation for operating this machine by commands oriented to other types of printers.
Selection of emulation
This machine can emulate the following printers:
- Line Printer
- IBM Proprinter
• DIABLO 630 - EPSON LQ-850
• P C L 6
• K P D L - KPDL(Auto)
Use the procedure below to select the emulation.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 CoPy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
Emulation Set.: 0 5 PCL6 0 6 KPDL 0 7 *KPDL (Auto)1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Emulation Set.].
4 Press the OK key. Emulation Set. appears.
5 Press the or key to select the printer you want to emulate.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
NOTE: If you select [KPDL] or [KPDL(Auto)], the operation after selecting the emulation is different from others.
If you select [KPDL], refer to page 8-76. If you select [KPDL(Auto)], refer to page 8-76.
When KPDL Is Selected for Emulation
When you use the KPDL emulation mode, set whether or not to output KPDL error reports. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Emulation Set.: 05 PCL6 06 KPDL 07 KPDL(Auto)1 In Emulation Set, press the or key to select [KPDL].

text_image
KPDL Error Rpt: 01 Off 02 *On2 Press the OK key. KPDL Error Rpt appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
4 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
When KPDL(Auto) Is Selected for Emulation
If you use the KPDL(Auto) emulation mode, KPDL and another emulation mode can be automatically switched according to the data (alternative emulation).
For alternative emulation, you can select one of the following printers. The default setting is PCL6.
- Line Printer
- IBM Proprinter
• DIABLO 630 - EPSON LQ-850
• P C L 6
Also, as when you select [KPDL], set whether or not to output KPDL error reports. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Emulation Set.: 0 5 PCL6 0 6 KPDL 0 7 KPDL(Auto)1 In Emulation Set, press the or key to select [KPDL(Auto)].

text_image
Alt. Emulation: 03 DIABLO 630 04 EPSON LQ-850 05* PCL62 Press the OK key. Alt. Emulation appears.
3 Press the or key to select the printer for alternative emulation.
4 Press the OK key. KPDL Error Rpt appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
EcoPrint
EcoPrint conserves toner when printing. This is recommended for test copies where faded printing is not a problem.
Use the procedure below to specify the EcoPrint setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].

text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.

text_image
EcoPrint: [01]*Off [02] On3 Press the or key to select [EcoPrint].
4 Press the OK key. EcoPrint appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Override A4/LTR
Select whether to treat A4 size and Letter, which are similar in size, as the same size when printing. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description | |
| On A4 and Letter are regarded as the same in size. The machine will use whichever size is in the paper source. | |
| Off A4 and Letter are not regarded as the same in size. | |
Use the procedure below to specify the override A4/Letter setting. The default setting is On.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: [0 1] Emulation Set. [0 2] EcoPrint [0 3] Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
Override A4/LTR: 01 Off 02 *On1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Override A4/LTR].
4 Press the OK key. Override A4/LTR appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off] or [On].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Duplex
Select binding orientation for duplex mode. The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description Finish | ||
| Off No duplex mode | ||
| Bind Long Edge | Longer edge bound | ![]() |
| Bind Short Edge | Shorter edge bound | [zczx] ![]() |
Use the procedure below to select a duplex setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
Duplex: [01]*Off 02 Bind Long Edge 03 Bind Short Edge1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Duplex].
4 Press the OK key. Duplex appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off], [Bind Long Edge] or [Bind Short Edge].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Copies
Set the default number of copies, from 1 to 999.
Use the procedure below to specify the default number of copies.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: [0 1] Emulation Set. [0 2] EcoPrint [0 3] Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
Copies: (1 - 999) 999 copies1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Copies].
4 Press the OK key. Copies appears.
5 Press the or key or the numeric keys to set the default number of copies.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Orientation
Set the default orientation, Portrait or Landscape.

text_image
Portrait Printer Printer LandscapeUse the procedure below to set the default orientation for printing.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
Orientation: [0 1] * Portrait [0 2] Landscape1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Orientation].
4 Press the OK key. Orientation appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Portrait] or [Landscape].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
FormFeed Timeout
Receiving print data from the computer, the machine may sometimes wait if there is no information signalling that the last page does not have any more data to be printed. When the preset timeout passes, the machine automatically prints paper. The options are between 5 and 495 seconds.
Use the procedure below to set the form feed timeout.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].

text_image
Printer: [01] Emulation Set. [02] EcoPrint [03] Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.

text_image
FormFeed TimeOut:* (5 - 495) 30 Sec.3 Press the or key to select [FormFeed Timeout].
4 Press the OK key. FormFeed Timeout appears.
5 Press the or key to set the Form Feed Timeout. You can set the timeout delay in seconds. You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this value.
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
LF Action
Set the line feed action when the machine receives the line feed code (character code 0AH). The table below shows the available settings. The default setting is LF Only.
| Item Description | |
| LF Only Only line feed performed. | |
| LF and CR Line feed and character return performed. | |
| Ignore LF No line feed performed. | |
Use the procedure below to specify a LF action.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]
text_image
Printer: [0 1] Emulation Set. [0 2] EcoPrint [0 3] Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]
text_image
LF Action: [0 1] *LF Only [0 2] LF and CR [0 3] Ignore LF1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].
2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [LF Action].
4 Press the OK key. LF Action appears.
5 Press the or key to select [LF Only], [LF and CR] or [Ignore LF].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
CR Action
Set the character return action when the machine receives the character return code (character code 0DH). The table below shows the available settings. The default setting is CR Only.
| Item Description | |
| CR Only Only character return performed. | |
| LF and CR Character return and line feed performed. | |
| Ignore CR No character return performed. | |
Use the procedure below to specify a CR action.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].

text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.

text_image
CR Action: [01]*CR Only [02] LF and CR [03] Ignore CR3 Press the or key to select [CR Action].
4 Press the OK key.
5 Press the or key to select [CR Only], [LF and CR] or [Ignore CR].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Paper Feed Mode
Set the default value of the paper feed direction used for the printer functions. The default setting is Auto.
| Item Description | |
| Auto Sets the paper feed | direction automatically. |
| Fixed Sets the paper feed | direction the same as in the previous printing operation. |
Use the procedure below to set Paper Feed Mode.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 05 Common Settings 06 Copy 07 Printer [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Printer].

text_image
Printer: 01 Emulation Set. 02 EcoPrint 03 Override A4/LTR [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Printer menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Paper Feed Mode].

text_image
Paper Feed Mode: 01 *Auto 02 Fixed4 Press the OK key. Paper Feed Mode appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Fixed].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Printer menu.
Sending Settings
The sending settings allow you to specify the following sending function options.
- Select Key Set ...8-86
- Document Box Settings ...8-88
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
Select Key Set
If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key, you can quickly set the function when using sending functions.
You can register one of the following functions to each key.
- None
- Color Selection
• Original Size - Original Image
- Scan Resolution
- Sending Size
• Z o o m - Orig.Orientation
- Continuous Scan
- File Format
- File Name Entry
- Subject/Body
- JobFinish Notice
- FAX Resolution
- FAX Direct TX
- FAX Delayed TX
- FAX RX Polling
- Density
- Duplex
- FTP Encrypted TX
- File Separation
Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 06 Copy 07 Printer 08 Send [ Exit ]
text_image
Send: 01 Select Key Set. 02 DestinationCheck [ Exit ]
text_image
Select Key Set.: [01] Left [02] Right [ Exit ]
text_image
Left: 02 Color Selection 03 Original Size 04 Original ImageThis function is already registered.
1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Send].
2 Press the OK key. The Send menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Select Key Set.].
4 Press the OK key. Select Key Set. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Left] or [Right].
6 Press the OK key. This displays the function selection screen for the flexible key selected in step 5. The screen shown is the one when [Left] is selected.
7 Press the or key to select the function you want to register to the flexible key.
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Send menu.
IMPORTANT: If you try to set the function that is registered to the other flexible key, you cannot set it and This function is already registered. is displayed.
Document Box Settings
The following settings are available for Document Box.
- Job Box ...8-88
- Select Key Set ...8-90
Job Box
Job Box settings can be set. Select settings for Quick Copy Jobs and Job Retention Deletion. Quick Copy Jobs sets the number of files that can be saved using Quick Copy. Job Ret. Deletion sets the period of time a job retention file can be saved. When a file has been saved for longer than the period, it is automatically deleted.
Quick Copy Jobs
The procedure for setting Quick Copy Jobs is explained below.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 08 Send 09 FAX 10 Document Box [ Exit ]
text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Job Box 03 Select Key Set. [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Box: [01] Quick Copy Jobs [02] JobRet. Deletion [ Exit ]
text_image
Quick Copy Jobs: (0 - 50) 32 job(s)1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Document Box].
2 Press the OK key. The Document Box menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Job Box].
4 Press the OK key. The Job Box screen appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Quick Copy Jobs].
6 Press the OK key. The Quick Copy Jobs screen appears.
7 Enter the number of Quick Copy Jobs that can be saved with the numeric keys.
8 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the Job Box screen.
Job Retention Deletion
The procedure for setting Job Retention Deletion is explained below.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 08 Send 09 FAX 10 Document Box [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Document Box].

text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Job Box 03 Select Key Set. [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Document Box menu appears.

text_image
Job Box: [01] Quick Copy Jobs [02] JobRet. Deletion [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Job Box].
4 Press the OK key. The Job Box screen appears.
5 Press the or key to select [JobRet. Deletion].
6 Press the OK key. The Job Retention Deletion screen appears.

text_image
JobRet. Deletion: ◆ OK [0 1] *Off [0 2] 1 hour [0 3] 4 hours7 Press the or key to select the period that jobs are retained.
8 Press the OK key. The screen returns to the Job Box screen.
Select Key Set
If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key, you can quickly set the function when printing from or saving to a document box.
You can register one of the following functions to each key for either of printing from and saving to a document box.
- None
- Collate
- Paper Selection
- Duplex
- File Name Entry
- JobFinish Notice
- Print Override
- Encrypted PDF
• TIFF Print - XPS FitTo Page
- Del. afterPrint
Store
- None
- Color Selection
- Original Size
- Original Image
- Scan Resolution
- Storing Size
• Z o o m - Orig.Orientation
- Continuous Scan
- File Format
- File Name Entry
- JobFinish Notice
- Density
- D u p l e x
Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 08 Send 09 FAX 10 Document Box [ Exit ]
text_image
Document Box: 01 Sub Address Box 02 Select Key Set. 03 Polling Box [ Exit ]
text_image
Select Key Set.: [01] Print [02] Store [ Exit ]
text_image
Print: [01] Left [02] Right [ Exit ]
text_image
Left: 03 Paper Selection 04 *Duplex 05 File Name Entry1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Document Box].
2 Press the OK key. The Document Box menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Select Key Set.].
4 Press the OK key. Select Key Set. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Print] or [Store].
6 Press the OK key. This displays the flexible key selection screen for the function selected in step 5. The screen shown is the one when [Print] is selected.
7 Press the or key to select [Left] or [Right].
8 Press the OK key. This displays the function selection screen for the flexible key selected in step 7. The screen shown is the one when [Left] is selected.
9 Press the or key to select the function you want to register to the flexible key.
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Document Box menu.
This function is already registered.
IMPORTANT: If you try to set the function that is registered to the other flexible key, you cannot set it and This function is already registered. is displayed.
Printing Reports/Sending Notice
Print reports to check the machine settings and status. Default settings for printing the result reports can also be configured.
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only print by logging in with administrator privileges.
Printing Reports
Printable reports are as follows.
Menu map
Outputs a menu map of this machine.

text_image
Menu Map MFP Firmware VersionStatus Page
Check the information including current settings, available memory space, and optional equipment installed.

text_image
Status Page MFP Firmware VersionFont List
Check the font samples installed in the machine.

text_image
Internal Scalable and Bitmapped Fonts List PRESCRIBE Font Name Scalable/Bilmap Password Selection [FSET] Font ID ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------Use the procedure below to print a Menu Map / Status Page / Font List.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the △ or ▽ key to select [Report].

text_image
Report: 01 Report Print 02 Admin Rpt Set. 03 Result Rpt Set. [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Report menu appears.

text_image
Report Print: 01 Menu Map 02 Status Page 03 Font List [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Report Print].
4 Press the OK key. The Report Print menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Menu Map], [Status Page] or [Font List].

text_image
Print. Are you sure? →Status Page [ Yes ] [ No ]6 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
The screen shown is the one when Status Page is selected.
7 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The selected report is output. Accepted. is displayed and the screen returns to the Report Print menu.
NOTE: When acceptance of jobs is prohibited, Print, storing functions are restricted now. is displayed and the output is canceled.
Service Status Page
More detailed information is available than on the Status Page. Service personnel usually print the service status pages for maintenance purpose.
Network Status Page
Check the information including network interface firmware version, network address and protocol.

text_image
Network Status Page MFP Firmware VersionUse the procedure below to print a Service Status / Network Status.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].

text_image
Adjust/Maint.: 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.

text_image
Service Setting: OK 01 Service Status 02 Network Status 03 New Developer [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Service Setting].
4 Press the OK key. Service Setting appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Service Status] or [Network Status].
6 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
The screen shown is the one when Network Status is selected.

text_image
Print. Are you sure? →Network Status [ Yes ] [ No ]7 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The selected report is output. Accepted. is displayed and the screen returns to the Service Setting menu.
NOTE: When acceptance of jobs is prohibited, Print, storing functions are restricted now. is displayed and the output is canceled.
Send Result Report
Automatically print a report of transmission result when a transmission is complete. The table below shows the available settings. The default setting is Error Only.
| Item | Description |
| Off No result report printed. | |
| On Result report automatically printed.Transmitted images can also be attached. | |
| Error Only Result report printed only when a transmission ends in an error. If two or more destinations are registered, the reports are printed only for the destinations with the errors. Transmitted images can also be attached. | |
Use the procedure below to send a Result Report.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK [01] Report [02] Counter [03] System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Report].

text_image
Report: 01 Report Print 02 Admin Rpt Set. 03 Result Rpt Set. [ Exit ]
text_image
Result Rpt Set.: 01 Send Result 02 FAX RX Result 03 JobFinish Notice [ Exit ]
text_image
Send Result: [0] E-mail/Folder [0 2] FAX [0 3] CancelBeforeSend [ Exit ]
text_image
E-mail/Folder: 01 Off 02 On 03 *Error Only2 Press the OK key. The Report menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Result Rpt Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The Result Rpt Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Send Result]. The Send Result menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [E-mail/Folder], [FAX] or [CancelBeforeSend]. Selected menu appears.
NOTE: Selecting [CancelBeforeSend] can be specified whether the machine prints the report when canceling the operation before sending.
When selecting [Off] in both E-mail/Folder and FAX menu, [CancelBeforeSend] is not displayed.
7 Press the or key to select [Off], [On] or [Error Only]. When selecting [CancelBeforeSend], press the or key to select [Off] or [On]
8 Press the OK key. A Result Report is sent. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Send Result menu.
Adjustment/Maintenance
Adjust printing quality and conduct machine maintenance.
• Copy Denst. Adj. ...8-98
- Send/Box Density ...8-99
- Correct. Bk Line ...8-100
- New Developer...8-101
• Auto Drum Refresh...8-102
- Drum Refresh...8-103
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
Copy Denst. Adj.
Adjust copy density. Adjustment can be made in 7 levels both in auto and manual density modes.
Use the procedure below to adjust the copy density.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]
text_image
Adjust/Maint. : 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]
text_image
Copy Denst. Adj.: OK [01] Auto [02] Manual [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].
2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Copy Denst. Adj.].
4 Press the OK key. Copy Denst. Adj. appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Manual].

text_image
Manual: 0 3 -1 0 4* 0 Normal 0 5 +16 Press the OK key. This displays the density selection screen for the mode selected in step 5. The screen shown is the one when [Manual] is selected.
7 Press the or key to select the density from [-3 Lighter] to [+3 Darker].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Copy Denst. Adj. menu.
Send/Box Density
Adjust scan density when sending or storing the data in Document Box. Adjustment can be made in 7 levels both in auto and manual density modes.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].

text_image
Adjust/Maint.: 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.

text_image
Send/Box Density: OK [0 1] Auto [0 2] Manual [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Send/Box Density].
4 Press the OK key. Send/Box Density appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Auto] or [Manual].
6 Press the OK key. This displays the density selection screen for the mode selected in step 5. The screen shown is the one when [Manual] is selected.
7 Press the or key to select the density from [-3 Lighter] to [+3 Darker].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Send/Box Density menu.
Correct. Bk Line
Correct fine black lines (black streaks caused by contamination), which may appear on the copies, when the document processor used.

text_image
Paper feed direction KThe table below shows the available settings.
| Item | Description |
| Off No correction performed. | |
| On(Low) Correction performed. The reproduction of the image becomes lower when using Off. | |
| On(High) Correction performed. Select this item if black streak remains after using On (Low). The reproduction of the image becomes lower when using On (Low). | |
NOTE: Using Correcting Fine Black Line can impair reproduction of fine characters. It is recommended to keep the default ([Off]).
Use the procedure below to specify the setting for correcting fine black lines.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].

text_image
Adjust/Maint.: 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]
text_image
Correct. Bk Line: ◆ OK [0 1] * Off 0 2 On (Low) 0 3 On (High)2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Correct. Bk Line].
4 Press the OK key. Correct. Bk Line appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Off], [On(Low)] or [On(High)].
6 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Adjust/Maint. menu.
New Developer
When the printing is too light or incomplete, even though there is enough toner, refresh the developer.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]
text_image
Adjust/Maint.: [0 1] Copy Denst. Adj. [0 2] Send/Box Density [0 3] Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]
text_image
Service Setting: ◆ OK [0 1] Service Status [0 2] Network Status [0 3] New Developer [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].
2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Service Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Service Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [New Developer].
New Developer.
Are you sure?
[ Yes ] [ No ]
6 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
7 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Service Setting menu.
Auto Drum Refresh
When the machine is turned on or is woken up from Low-Power mode or Sleep mode, the drum is sometimes automatically refreshed. Automatic drum refreshing is carried out to maintain printing quality and allows for the ambient temperature and humidity.
Use this setting to specify the duration of automatic drum refreshing.
| Item | Description |
| Off Disables automatic drum refreshing. | |
| Standard Sets the standard duration for automatic drum refreshing. | |
| Long Sets a longer time for automatic drum refreshing. If the printed image is faint due to moisture, set [Long]. | |

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]
text_image
Adjust/Maint.: 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].
2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Service Setting].

text_image
Service Setting: 01 Service Status 02 Network Status 03 New Developer [ Exit ]
text_image
Auto Drum Refresh: OK [0 1] *Off 0 2 Standard 0 3 Long4 Press the OK key. The Service Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Auto Drum Refresh].
6 Press the OK key. Auto Drum Refresh appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Off], [Standard] or [Long].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Service Setting menu.
Drum Refresh
This sets the refresh mode for the drum. When the printing quality declines, refreshing the drum can restore the printing quality. This is primarily used for maintenance by service personnel.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination 12 Adjust/Maint. [ Exit ]
text_image
Adjust/Maint.: 01 Copy Denst. Adj. 02 Send/Box Density 03 Correct. Bk Line [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Adjust/Maint.].
2 Press the OK key. The Adjust/Maint. menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Service Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Service Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Drum Refresh].
Start the drum refresh.
Are you sure?
[ Yes ] [ No ]
6 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
7 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Drum refresh is executed.
Editing Destination (Address Book/Adding One-Touch Keys)
Save frequently used destinations to Address Book or One-touch keys. The saved destinations can be changed. The destinations are available for Send as E-mail, Send to Folder, and Fax Transmission.
NOTE: COMMAND CENTER can be used to efficiently save and edit multiple destinations.
Adding an Individual Destination
A maximum of 100 individual addresses can be registered. Each address can include the information such as destination name, E-mail address, FTP server folder path, computer folder path, and FAX No..
NOTE:
- If user login administration is enabled, you can only edit destinations in the Address Book by logging in with administrator privileges.
• Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
Use the procedure below to register a new individual contact.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 09 FAX 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Edit Destination].

text_image
Edit Destination: OK [01] Addressbook [02] Print List [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Edit Destination menu appears.

text_image
Addressbook: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]3 Press the or key to select [Address Book].
4 Press the OK key. The Address Book list screen appears.
NOTE: If the destinations are not registered, there is no list in the Address Book.

text_image
Menu: 01 Detail Edit 02 Delete 03 Add Address5 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.

text_image
Add Address: 01 Contact 02 Group
text_image
Detail: Contact Name 1/7 Sally [ Edit ]6 Press the or key to select [Add Address].
7 Press the OK key. Add Address appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Contact].
9 Press the OK key. This displays the screen for editing destinations.
NOTE: If the maximum number of destinations has already been registered, the screen will display Registered numbers exceeded. and return to the Address Book.
10 Enter each item and then press the OK key. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book list screen.
Refer to the descriptions below for how to enter each item.
Entering Contact Name

text_image
Detail: Contact Name 1/7 Sally [ Edit ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to select [Contact Name].

text_image
Contact Name: Sally ABC [ Text ]2 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Enter the contact name.
If creating a new contact name, the address number allocated to the destination is already entered.
4 Press the OK key. The contact name is registered.
Entering E-mail Address

text_image
Detail: ✓E-mail Address: 4/7 t_maury@########### [ Edit ]
text_image
Address Entry: ABC [ Text ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display E-mail Address.
2 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Enter the e-mail address.
NOTE: Destination can be specified using the Address Book or the One-touch keys. Refer to Specifying Destination on page 3-26.
4 Press the OK key. The e-mail address is registered.
Entering Folder (SMB/FTP) Address
Folder (SMB) Address
The table below explains the items to be entered.
| Item Description | Max. No. of Characters | |
| Host Name* | Host name or IP address of the sending computer | 64 chars |
| Path Path to the folder used to save filesE.g. "\User\ScanData" | 128 chars | |
| Login User Name | User name for folder accessFor example,abcdnet\james.smith | 64 chars |
| Login Password | Password for folder access 64 chars |
* If you specify a port number other than the default (139), use the "Host name: port number" format. (E.g. SMBhostname: 140)
Folder (FTP) Address
The table below explains the items to be entered.
| Item Description | Max. No. of Characters | |
| Host Name* | Host name or IP address of the sending computer | 64 chars |
| Path Path to the folder used to save filesE.g. "\User\ScanData" | 128 chars | |
| Login User Name User name for folder accessFor example,abcdnet\james.smith | 64 chars | |
| Login Password Password for folder access 64 chars | ||
| Encryption If secure communication is On,encryption method can be selected from Auto, DES, 3DES and AES. | - |
* If you specify a port number other than the default (21), use the "Hostname: port number" format. (E.g. FTPhostname: 140)

text_image
Detail: Folder(SMB): 4/6 Ntid7004 [ Edit ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display Folder(SMB) or Folder(FTP).

text_image
Host Name(SMB): RD Center ABC [ Text ]2 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Enter the host name.

text_image
Host Name(FTP): RD Center ABC [ Text ]NOTE: Destination can be specified using the Address Book or the One-touch keys. Refer to Specifying Destination on page 3-26.
Enclose the IPv6 address in brackets [].

text_image
Path: RD3\report ABC [ Text ]4 Press the OK key. Path appears.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Maury ABC [ Text ]5 Enter the path name.
6 Press the OK key. Login User Name appears.
7 Enter the login user name.
8 Press the OK key. Login Password appears.

9 Enter the login password.
10 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
Check the connection.
Are you sure?
[ Yes ] [ No ]
NOTE: If the screen for confirming the entry of a new destination (page 8-88) is set to [On], screens to confirm the entered host name and path name appear. Enter the same host name and path name again and press the OK key on their respective screens.

text_image
Dest. Confirm.: OK Morgan@########### 0667640000 0667741234 [ Exit ]11 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). This makes a connection with the entered destination.
If the connection is successful, Connected. is displayed on the screen. Press [OK] (the Right Select key). Completed. is displayed and the folder (SMB/FTP) address is registered.
If the connection failed, Cannot connect. is displayed. Press [OK] (the Right Select key). The screen shown in step 2 reappears. Check and re-enter the destination.
Address Number
Address Number is an ID for a destination. When creating a new destination, the smallest unused address number is automatically allocated. You can select any available number out of 100 numbers for individuals and 20 numbers for groups.

text_image
Detail: Address Number: 6/6 053 [ Edit ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display Address Number.

text_image
Address Number: (001 - 120) 0532 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the address number.
4 Press the OK key. The address number is registered.
NOTE: If you enter an address number that is already registered, the screen will display This address number is already registered. and return to the screen of step 2.
Adding a Group
Compile two or more individuals into a group. Designations in the group can be added at the same time. When adding a group, a maximum of 20 groups can be added in the Address Book.
NOTE: If user login administration is enabled, you can only edit destinations in the Address Book by logging in with administrator privileges.
Before adding a group in the Address Book, the individuals to be included in the group must be added first. Up to 100 destinations can be added as the addresses. Among them, one destination can be assigned for a FTP or SMB address. The available addresses will be 99 in total for email and/or fax addresses. For example, you can add 75 email addresses, 24 fax addresses, and a FTP address.
Use the procedure below to register a group.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 09 FAX 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Edit Destination].

text_image
Edit Destination: OK [01] Addressbook [02] Print List [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The Edit Destination menu appears.

text_image
Addressbook: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]3 Press the or key to select [Address Book].
4 Press the OK key. The Address Book list screen appears.
5 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.

text_image
Menu: 01 Detail/Edit 02 Delete 03 Add Address6 Press the or key to select [Add Address].
7 Press the OK key. Add Address appears.

text_image
Add Address: 01 Contact 02 *Group8 Press the or key to select [Group].
9 Press the OK key. This displays the screen for editing groups.

text_image
Detail: Group Name: 1/4 Sales Section [ Edit ]NOTE: If the maximum number of groups has already been registered, the screen will display Registered numbers exceeded. and return to the Address Book.
10 Enter each item and then press the OK key. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book list screen.
Refer to the descriptions below for how to enter each item.
Entering Group Name

text_image
Detail: Group Name: 1/4 Sales Section [ Edit ]
text_image
Group Name: Sales ABC [ Text ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display Group Name.
2 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Enter the group name.
If creating a new group name, the address number allocated to the destination is already entered.
4 Press the OK key. The group name is registered.
Entering Group Member

text_image
Detail: Group Member: 2/3 30 [ Edit ]
text_image
Group Member: ✓ Sally Morgan Morgan [ Menu ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display Group Member.
2 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). This displays the list of destinations registered to the group.
3 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key). The group editing menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Add Member].

text_image
Contacts: Fiala Maury Morgan [ Menu ]5 Press the OK key. This displays the list of destinations registered in the Address Book.
NOTE: If 100 members have already been registered in the group, the screen will display Registered numbers exceeded. and return to the Group Member.

text_image
Sally: 0667643277 sally@########### Ntid7004 [ Menu ]6 Press the or key to select the destination you want to add to the group.
7 Press the OK key. This displays the sending address registered to the selected destination.
8 Press the or key to select the sending address.
9 Press the OK key. The selected destination is added to the group and the screen returns to Group Member.
NOTE: If you select an individual destination that has already been registered to the group, the screen will display This address is already registered. and return to the screen of step 7.
Deleting member from group
To delete a member registered to the group, follow the procedure below.

text_image
Group Member: ✓ Sally Morgan Morgan [ Menu ]
text_image
Menu: 01 Detail 02 Delete 03 Add Member1 While Group Member is displayed, press [Edit] (the Right Select key). This displays the list of destinations registered to the group.
2 Press the or key to select the destination you want to delete.
3 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key). The group editing menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Delete].

text_image
Delete. Are you sure? →☑Sally [ Yes ] [ No ]5 Press the OK key. A confirmation message appears.
6 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to Group Member.
Entering Address Number
Address Number is an ID for a destination. When creating a new destination, the smallest unused address number is automatically allocated. You can select any available number out of 100 numbers for individuals and 20 numbers for groups.

text_image
Detail: Address Number: 4/4 019 [ Edit ]1 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to display Address Number.

text_image
Address Number: (001 - 120) 0532 Press [Edit] (the Right Select key). An entry screen appears.
3 Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the address number.
4 Press the OK key. The address number is registered.
NOTE: If you enter an address number that is already registered, the screen will display This address number is already registered. and return to the screen of step 2.
Editing a Destination
Edit/delete the destinations (individuals) you added to the Address Book.
Use the procedure below to edit a destination.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 09 FAX 10 Document Box 11 Edit Destination [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Edit Destination].

text_image
Edit Destination: OK [01] Addressbook [02] Print List [ Exit ]
text_image
Addressbook: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]
text_image
Menu: 01 Detail Edit 02 Delete 03 Add Address
text_image
Detail: Contact name 1/7 Sally [ Edit
text_image
Overwrite. Are you sure? →☑Sally [ Yes ] [ No ]2 Press the OK key. The Edit Destination menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Address Book].
4 Press the OK key. The Address Book list screen appears.
5 Press the or key to select the destination you want to edit.
6 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key). Menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Detail/Edit].
8 Press the OK key. This displays the screen for editing the selected destination.
The screen shown is the one when an individual's destination is selected.
9 Edit items as necessary.
For how to edit each item, refer to Adding an Individual Destination on page 8-105 and Adding a Group on page 8-110.
10 After completing editing, press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
11 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book list screen.
Adding a Destination on One-touch Key
This machine has 11 one-touch keys and you can register 2 destinations to each of them.
The one-touch keys are arranged as shown below:
| No.1 No.2 | No.3 No.4 | ||
| No.12 No.13 | No.14 No.15 | ||
| No.5 No6 | No.7 No.8 | ||
| No.16 No.17 | No.18 No.19 | ||
| No.9 No.10 | No.11 | SHIFT | |
| No.20 No.21 | No.22 |
NOTE: Refer to One-Touch Key on page 3-3 for how to use them.
Registering new destination
Use the procedure below to register a new destination under a One-touch key.

text_image
Select Key No.: [01] No. 1 [02] No. 12 [ Exit ]
text_image
Addressbook: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]1 In the Send or FAX screen, press the one-touch key to which you want to register the destination and hold it (2 seconds or longer). Select Key Set. appears.
The screen shown is the one when No.1/No.12 is pressed and held.
2 Press the or key to select the key number to which you want to register the destination.
3 Press the OK key. The Address Book list screen appears.
4 Press the or key to select the destination you want to register.
NOTE: If you want to search from the Address Book, refer to Search in Address Book on page 3-27.
5 Press the OK key. The selected destination is registered to the one-touch key. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
Editing One-touch Key
Edit/delete the destinations you added to One-touch Key.
Use the procedure below to edit the one-touch key.

text_image
Select Key No.: [01] No. 1 [02] No. 12 [ Exit ]
text_image
Key Edit: [01] Edit [02] Detail [03] Delete [ Exit ]1 In the Send or FAX screen, press the one-touch key where you want to edit the destination and hold it (2 seconds or longer). Select Key Set. appears.
The screen shown is the one when No.1/No.12 is pressed and held.
2 Press the or key to select the key number where you want to edit the destination.
3 Press the OK key. The Key Edit appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Edit].
NOTE: If you select [Delete] here and press the OK key, you can delete the registration of the destination. If you press [Yes] (the Left Select key) in the screen that appears, Completed. is displayed and the registration of the destination is deleted.

text_image
Addressbook: Design Fiala Maury [ Menu ]5 Press the OK key. The Address Book list screen appears.
6 Press the or key to select the destination you want to newly register.
NOTE: If you want to search from the Address Book, refer to Search in Address Book on page 3-27.
7 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.

text_image
Overwrite. Are you sure? →No. 1 [ Yes ] [ No ]8 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The selected destination is registered to the one-touch key, overwriting the previous one. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to the basic screen.
Restarting the System

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]Restart the printer without turning the main power switch off. Use this to deal with any unstable operation by the machine. (Same as the computer restart.)
Use the procedure below to restart the system.
1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: [01] Network Setting [02] I/F Block Set. [03] Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Restart. Are you sure? [ Yes ] [ No ]3 Press the or key to select [Restart].
4 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
5 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The printer is restarted.
If you press [No] (the Right Select key), the printer does not restart and the screen returns to the System menu.
Network Setup
The following network settings are available.
• LAN Interface Setup ...8-120
• TCP/IP (IPv4) Setup ...8-121
• TCP/IP (IPv6) Setup ...8-130
- NetWare Setup ...8-131
- AppleTalk Setup ...8-132
- Protocol Detail ...8-136
LAN Interface Setup
Specify the settings for the LAN interface to be used. The default setting is Auto.
Use the procedure below to select the interface.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK 01 TCP/IP Setting 02 NetWare 03 AppleTalk3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [LAN Interface].

text_image
LAN Interface: [0 1] *Auto [0 2] 10Base-Half [0 3] 10Base-Full6 Press the OK key. LAN Interface appears.
7 Press the or key to select the desired LAN interface.
The available LAN interfaces are as follows:
Auto 10Base-Half 10Base-Full 100Base-Half 100Base-Full
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Setting menu.
TCP/IP (IPv4) Setup
Set up TCP/IP to connect to the Windows network. Set the IP addresses, subnet masks, and gateway addresses. The default settings are "TCP/IP Protocol: On, DHCP: On, Bonjour: Off".
NOTE: Prior to the IP address entries, obtain permission from the network administrator.
Use the procedure below to setup the TCP/IP (IPv4) setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK 01 TCP/IP Settings 02 NetWare 03 AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP Settings].
6 Press the OK key. The TCP/IP Settings menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP].
8 Press the OK key. TCP/IP appears.
9 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the TCP/IP Settings menu.
10 Press the or key to select [IPv4 Setting].
11 Press the OK key. The IPv4 Setting menu appears.
12 Press the or key to select [DHCP].

text_image
DHCP: 01 Off 02 *On13 Press the OK key. DHCP appears.
14 Press the or key to select [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
15 Press the or key to select [Bonjour].

text_image
IPv4 Setting: 01 DHCP 02 Bonjour 03 IP Address [ Exit ]16 Press the OK key. Bonjour appears.

text_image
Bonjour: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On17 Press the or key to select [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
18 Press the or key to select [IP Address].

text_image
IPv4 Setting: 01 DHCP 02 Bonjour 03 IP Address [ Exit ]19 Press the OK key. IP Address appears.

text_image
IP Address: 000.000.000.00020 Use the arrow keys to enter the IP address.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move the cursor position horizontally.

text_image
IP Address: 123.145.167.189Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the IP Address. Each 3 digits can be set between 000 and 255.
IMPORTANT: When the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) is [On], the current IP address is displayed and cannot be changed.
When setting an IP address, set the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) to Off.

text_image
IPv4 Setting: 03 IP Address 04 Subnet Mask 05 Default Gateway [ Exit ]21 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
22 Press the or key to select [Subnet Mask].

text_image
Subnet Mask: 000.000.000.00023 Press the OK key. Subnet Mask appears.
24 Use the arrow keys to enter the Subnet Mask.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move the cursor position horizontally.
Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the Subnet Mask. Each 3 digits can be set between 000 and 255.
IMPORTANT: When the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) is [On], the current Subnet Mask is displayed and cannot be changed.
When setting an Subnet Mask, set the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) to Off.

text_image
IPv4 Setting: 03 IP Address 04 Subnet Mask 05 Default Gateway [ Exit ]25 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
26 Press the or key to select [Default Gateway].

text_image
Default Gateway: ✓ OK 000.000.000.00027 Press the OK key. Default Gateway appears.
28 Use the arrow keys to enter the Default Gateway.
Press the ◀ or ▷ key to move the cursor position horizontally.
Press the or key or the numeric keys to enter the Default Gateway. Each 3 digits can be set between 000 and 255.
IMPORTANT: When the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) is [On], the current Default Gateway is displayed and cannot be changed.
When setting an Default Gateway, set the DHCP Setting (page 8-126) to Off.
29 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
DHCP Settings
Select whether or not to use the DHCP server. The default setting is On.
Use the procedure below to specify the DHCP setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [0 1] TCP/IP Settings [0 2] NetWare [0 3] AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP Settings].
6 Press the OK key. The TCP/IP Settings menu appears.

text_image
TCP/IP Settings: 01 TCP/IP 02 IPv4 Setting 03 IPv6 Setting [ Exit ]7 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP].

text_image
TCP/IP: 01 Off 02 *On8 Press the OK key. TCP/IP appears.
9 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the TCP/IP Settings menu.
10 Press the or key to select [IPv4 Setting].

text_image
TCP/IP Settings: 01 TCP/IP 02 IPv4 Setting 03 IPv6 Setting [ Exit ]11 Press the OK key. The IPv4 Setting menu appears.

text_image
IPv4 Setting: [0 1] DHCP [0 2] Bonjour [0 3] IP Address [ Exit ]12 Press the or key to select [DHCP].
13 Press the OK key. DHCP appears.

text_image
DHCP: 01 Off 02 *On14 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
Bonjour Settings
Select whether or not to use Bonjour. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to specify the Bonjour setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: [01] Network Setting [02] I/F Block Set. [03] Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [01] TCP/IP Settings [02] NetWare [03] AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP Settings].
6 Press the OK key. The TCP/IP Settings menu appears.

text_image
TCP/IP Settings: 01 TCP/IP 02 IPv4 Setting 03 IPv6 Setting [ Exit ]7 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP].

text_image
TCP/IP: [0 1] Off [0 2]*On8 Press the OK key. TCP/IP appears.
9 Press the or key to select [On] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the TCP/IP Settings menu.
10 Press the or key to select [IPv4 Setting].

text_image
TCP/IP Settings: 01 TCP/IP 02 IPv4 Setting 03 IPv6 Setting [ Exit ]11 Press the OK key. The IPv4 Setting menu appears.

text_image
IPv4 Setting: 01 DHCP 02 Bonjour 03 IP Address [ Exit ]12 Press the or key to select [Bonjour].
13 Press the OK key. Bonjour appears.

text_image
Bonjour: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On14 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu.
TCP/IP (IPv6) Setup
Set up TCP/IP (IPv6) to connect to the network. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to setup the TCP/IP (IPv6) setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [01] TCP/IP Settings [02] NetWare [03] AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.

text_image
TCP/IP Settings: [0 1] TCP/IP [0 2] IPv4 Setting [0 3] IPv6 Setting [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP Settings].
6 Press the OK key. The TCP/IP Settings menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [IPv6 Setting].

text_image
IPv6 Setting: [01]*Off [02] On [ Exit ]8 Press the OK key. IPv6 Setting appears.
9 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the TCP/IP Settings menu.
NetWare Setup
Select the NetWare network connection. After that, select frame types for NetWare network from Auto, Ethernet-II, 802.3, 802.2, or SNAP. The default settings is "Off".
Use the procedure below to setup the NetWare setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [01] TCP/IP Settings [02] NetWare [03] AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [NetWare].

text_image
NetWare: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On
text_image
Frame Type: 01 * Auto 02 802.3 03 Ether-II6 Press the OK key. NetWare appears.
7 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
If you select [On] and press the OK key, Frame Type appears. Press the or key to select the desired frame type.
The available frame types are as follows:
Auto
802.3
Ether-II
802.2
SNAP
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Setting menu.
For detailed information on restarting the system, refer to Restarting the System on page 8-119.
AppleTalk Setup
Select the Apple Talk network connection. The default setting is On.
Use the procedure below to setup the AppleTalk setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: ◆ OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [0 1] TCP/IP Settings [0 2] NetWare [0 3] AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [AppleTalk].
6 Press the OK key. AppleTalk appears.
7 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off] and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Setting menu.
WSD Scan Setup
Select whether or not to use WSD Scan. The default setting is On.
Use the procedure below to setup the WSD-SCAN setting. The machine must be restarted after the setting is changed.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].

text_image
Network Setting: OK 01 TCP/IP Settings 02 NetWare 03 AppleTalk [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.

text_image
WSD-SCAN 01 off 02 *On5 Press the or key to select [WSD-SCAN].
6 Press the OK key. The WSD-SCAN menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Settings menu.
WSD Print Setup
Select whether or not to use WSD Print. The default setting is On.
Use the procedure below to setup the WSD-PRINT setting. The machine must be restarted after the setting is changed.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].

text_image
Network Setting: OK 01 TCP/IP Settings 02 NetWare 03 AppleTalk [ Exit ]
text_image
WSD-PRINT: 01 Off 02 *On4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [WSD-PRINT].
6 Press the OK key. The WSD-PRINT menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Settings menu.
Protocol Detail
Make other network related settings.
| Item Description | Default Setting | Restarting the System* | |
| NetBEUI Selects | whether or not to receive documents using NetBEUI. | On × | |
| LPD Select whether | or not to receive documents using LPD as the network protocol. | On ● | |
| FTP (Server) Select | whether or not to receive documents using FTP. | On ● | |
| FTP (Client) Select | whether or not to send documents using FTP, and the number of the port to be used. | On Port number: 21 | × |
| Raw Port Select | whether or not to receive documents using Raw Port. | On ● | |
| LDAP Select whether | or not to use LDAP. | Off × | |
| SNMP Select whether | or not to communicate using SNMP. | On ● | |
| SNMPv3 Set SNMPv3. Off ● | |||
| SMB | Select whether or not to send documents using SMB. | On × | |
| SMTP (E-mail TX) | Select whether or not to send e-mail using SMTP. | Off × | |
| POP3 (E-mail RX) | Select whether or not to receive e-mail using POP3. | Off × | |
| HTTP Select whether or not to communicate using HTTP. | On ● | ||
| HTTPS | Select whether or not to communicate using HTTPS. SSL must be set to [On] in SSL Setting on page 8-140. | On ● | |
| IPP | Select whether or not to use IPP, and the number of the port to be used. | Off Port number: 631 | ● |
| IPP over SSL Select | whether or not to useIPP over SSL.SSL must be set to [On] inSSL Setting on page 8-140. | On ● | |
* ●: The machine must be restarted after the setting is changed.
×: The machine does not need to be restarted after the setting is changed.
Use the procedure below.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK 01 TCP/IP Settings 02 NetWare 03 AppleTalk [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [TCP/IP Settings].
6 Press the OK key. The TCP/IP Settings menu appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Protocol Detail].

text_image
Protocol Detail: 01 NetBEUI 02 SNMPv3 03 FTP(Server)8 Press the OK key. The Protocol Detail menu appears.
9 Press the or key to select the item for which you want to make settings.
10 Press the OK key. This displays the setting screen for the item selected in step 9.
The screen shown is the one when [FTP(Client)] is selected.
11 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
If you select [On] for each of [FTP(Client)] and [IPP] and press the OK key, a port number entry screen appears.
Press the or key or the numeric keys to set the port number.

text_image
FTP(Client) : [0 1] * Off [0 2] On
text_image
Port Number: (1 - 65535) 2112 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Protocol Detail menu.
Network Security
The network security functions can be set up to protect printer operation and the print data.
The following network security settings are available.
- IPSec Setting ...8-139
- SSL Setting ...8-140
• SNMPv3 Setting ...8-145
IPSec Setting
Make this setting when you use IPSec. The default setting is On and that of Rule Setting is also Off.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK 0 4 WSD-SCAN 0 5 WSD-PRINT 0 6 IPSec [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [IPSec].

text_image
IPSec: [01]*Off [02] On6 Press the OK key. IPSec appears.

text_image
Rule Setting: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On7 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
If you select [On] and press the OK key, Rule Setting appears. Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Network Setting menu.
SSL Setting
This allows you to use SSL network security for communication. You can use SSL Setup to select whether or not SSL is used and to specify the IPP port and HTTP port security settings.
SSL
Make this setting Make this setting when you use SSL. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].

text_image
Network Setting: OK 07 Secure Protocol 08 Host Name 09 LAN Interface [ Exit ]4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.

text_image
Secure Protocol: ◆ OK [0 1] SSL [0 2] IPP Security [0 3] HTTP Security [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Secure Protocol].
6 Press the OK key. Secure Protocol appears.
7 Press the or key to select [SSL].
8 Press the OK key. SSL appears.

text_image
SSL: [0 1] * Off [0 2] On9 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu.
IPP Security
Specify the protocol to be used for IPP. The default setting is IPP/IPP over SSL.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK 07 Secure Protocol 08 Host Name 09 LAN Interface [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.

text_image
Secure Protocol: ◆ OK 01 SSL 02 IPP Security 03 HTTP Security [ Exit ]5 Press the or key to select [Secure Protocol].
6 Press the OK key. Secure Protocol appears.
7 Press the or key to select [IPP Security].
7 Press the or key to select [IPP Security].
8 Press the OK key. IPP Security appears.

text_image
IPP Security: 01 IPP/IPP over SSL 02 *IPPoverSSL only9 Press the or key to select [IPP/IPP over SSL] or [IPPoverSSL only].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu.
HTTP Security
Specify the protocol to be used for HTTP. The default setting is HTTPS only.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
System: [0 1] Network Setting [0 2] I/F Block Set. [0 3] Security Level [ Exit ]
text_image
Network Setting: OK 07 Secure Protocol 08 Host Name 09 LAN Interface [ Exit ]
text_image
Secure Protocol: ✓ OK 01 SSL 02 IPP Security 03 HTTP Security [ Exit ]
text_image
HTTP Security: 01 HTTP/HTTPS 02 *HTTPS onlyA login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
2 The System menu appears.
3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Secure Protocol].
6 Press the OK key. Secure Protocol appears.
7 Press the or key to select [HTTP Security].
8 Press the OK key. HTTP Security appears.
9 Press the or key to select [HTTP/HTTPS] or [HTTPS only].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu.
LDAP Security
Specify the protocol to be used for LDAP. The default setting is Off.
Use the procedure below to make the setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
Network Setting: OK [07] Secure Protocol [08] Host Name [09] LAN Interface [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [Network Setting].
4 Press the OK key. The Network Setting menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Secure Protocol].
6 Press the OK key. Secure Protocol appears.
7 Press the or key to select [LDAP Security].

text_image
Secure Protocol: OK 02 IPP Security 03 HTTP Security 04 LDAP Security [ Exit ]
text_image
LDAP Security: [0 1] *Off [0 2] LDAPv3 / TLS [0 3] LDAP over SSL8 Press the OK key. LDAP Security appears.
9 Press the or key to select [Off], [LDAPv3/TLS] or [LDAP over SSL].
10 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu.
SNMPv3 Setting
Sets up SNMPv3. The default setting is Off. Use the procedure below.
Refer to Protocol Detail on page 8-136 about the procedures.
Interface Block Setting
This allows you to protect this machine by blocking the interface with external devices such as USB hosts or optional interfaces.
The following interface block settings are available:
- USB Host (USB memory slot setting)
- USB Device (USB interface setting)
- Optional interface (Optional interface card setting)
USB Host (USB memory slot setting)
This locks and protects the USB memory slot (A1) or USB port (A2) (USB host). The default setting is Unblock.
Use the procedure below to specify the USB Host setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
I/F Block Set.: 01 USB Host 02 USB Device 03 Option I/F [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [I/F Block Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The I/F Block Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [USB Host].

text_image
USB Host: 01 *Unblock 02 Block6 Press the OK key. USB Host appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Unblock] or [Block].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the I/F Block Set. menu.
USB Device (USB interface setting)
This locks and protects the USB interface connector (B1) (USB Device). The default setting is Unblock.
Use the procedure below to specify the USB Device setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System], and press the OK key.
8

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 The System menu appears.

text_image
I/F Block Set.: 01 USB Host 02 USB Device 03 Option I/F [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [I/F Block Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The I/F Block Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [USB Device].

text_image
USB Device: [0 1] *Unblock [0 2] Block6 Press the OK key. USB Device appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Unblock] or [Block].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the System menu.
Optional interface (Optional interface card setting)
This locks and protects the optional interface slot. The default setting is Unblock.
Use the procedure below to specify the optional interface setting.

text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]1 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [System].

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
System: 01 Network Setting 02 I/F Block Set. 03 Security Level [ Exit ]2 Press the OK key. The System menu appears.

text_image
I/F Block Set.: 01 USB Host 02 USB Device 03 Option I/F [ Exit ]3 Press the or key to select [I/F Block Set.].
4 Press the OK key. The I/F Block Set. menu appears.
5 Press the or key to select [Option I/F].

text_image
Option I/F: [0 1] *Unblock [0 2] Block6 Press the OK key. Option I/F appears.
7 Press the or key to select [Unblock] or [Block].
8 Press the OK key. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the System menu.
Security Level (Security Level setting)
The Security Level setting is primarily a menu option used by service personnel for maintenance work. There is no need for customers to use this menu.
Optional Functions
You can use the optional applications installed on this machine.
Opt. Functions
Although nothing is currently displayed, when the optional functions that will be released in the future is installed, the licenses can be set using this menu.
9 Maintenance
This chapter describes cleaning and toner replacement.
- Cleaning 9-2
- Toner Container Replacement....9-5
- Replacing the Waste Toner Box 9-7
- Replacing the maintenance kit (MK-370) 9-8
Cleaning
Clean the machine regularly to ensure optimum output quality.
CAUTION: For safety, always unplug the power cord before cleaning the machine.
Glass Platen
Wipe the inside of the document processor and the glass platen with a soft cloth dampened with alcohol or mild detergent.
IMPORTANT: Do not use thinner or other organic solvents.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand using a printer to clean or spread a green screen (no text or symbols visible)Document Processor
If black streaks or dirt appears in copies when using the document processor, clean the slit glass with the supplied cleaning cloth. The message Clean the slit glass. may be displayed if the slit glass requires cleaning.
NOTE: Wipe the slit glasses with the dry cloth. Do not use water, soap or solvents for cleaning.

text_image
a1 Open the document processor and wipe the slit glass (a).

text_image
b2 Wipe the white guide (b) on the document processor.
3 Close the document processor.
Cleaning the Machine
To avoid print quality problems, the interior of the machine must be cleaned with every toner container and waste toner box replacement.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer internal structure showing green cover and ventilation slots (no text or symbols)1 Open the top cover and front cover.

natural_image
Illustration of hands installing a green plastic component into an open printer (no text or symbols visible)2 Lift the developer unit together with the toner container out of the machine.

natural_image
Line drawing of a hand inserting a component into a machine (no text or symbols)3 Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the registration roller (metal).

natural_image
Illustration of hands installing or adjusting a green mechanical component inside a printer (no text or symbols visible)4 Insert the developer unit together with the toner container, back into the machine.
5 Close the top cover and front cover.

natural_image
Technical line drawing of a refrigerator interior showing internal components and ventilation slots (no text or symbols)6 Open the left cover. Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the vents.

natural_image
Line drawing of a printer or scanner device with no visible text, numbers, or symbols7 Close the left cover.
8 Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the vent on the right side of the machine.
Toner Container Replacement
When the message display displays Add toner, replace the toner.
Every time you replace the toner container, be sure to clean the parts as instructed below. Dirty parts may deteriorate output quality.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to incinerate the toner container or the waste toner box. Dangerous sparks may cause burns.
Toner Container Replacement

natural_image
Diagram of a printer's internal structure showing green and yellow components, with arrows indicating motion direction (no text or symbols)NOTE: You do not have to turn machine power off before starting the replacement. Any data that may be processing in the machine will be deleted if you turn the machine power off.
1 Open the top cover and front cover.

text_image
Diagram showing hands operating a printer with an arrow indicating press direction and a green button labeled 'Press' pointing to the printer.2 Push toner container lock lever to the right and pull out the toner container.

natural_image
Diagram of a green mechanical component with an arrow indicating direction, wrapped in a white sheet (no text or symbols)3 Put the old toner container in the plastic bag (contained in the toner kit) and discard it later according to the local code or regulations for waste disposal.
4 Take the new toner container out of the toner kit.

text_image
105 Shake the new toner container at least 10 times as shown in the figure in order to distribute the toner evenly inside the container.

natural_image
Diagram of a mechanical component with a green section and arrow indicating force or movement (no text or symbols)6 Remove the label from the toner container.

text_image
PUSH PUSH7 Set the new toner container in the machine and push down on the top of the toner container to install it firmly in place as shown at the left.
8 Close the top cover and front cover.
Proceed to the next section.
NOTE: Return the exhausted toner containerto your dealer or service representative. The collected toner container will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
Replacing the Waste Toner Box
When replacing the toner container, the used waste toner box in the machine should also be replaced with the new one from the new toner kit. A new waste toner box is included with the toner kit. The machine will not operate without replacing the waste toner box.

text_image
Diagram illustrating a device's internal structure and installation, with an inset showing hand positioning and no text labels.1 Open the left cover. While holding the waste toner box, press the lock lever and then gently remove the waste toner box.
NOTE: Remove the waste toner box as gently as possible so as not to scatter the toner inside. Do not let the opening of the waste toner box face downward.

natural_image
Line drawing of a mechanical component with a green handle and black ring (no text or symbols)2 Close the cap to the old waste toner box after removing the box from the machine.

natural_image
Simple line drawing of a bag with a green container and black arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)3 To prevent toner from spilling, put the old waste toner box in the plastic bag (contained in the toner kit) and discard it later according to the local code or regulations for waste disposal.

natural_image
Line drawing of a mechanical component with a green clip attached (no text or symbols)4 Open the cap of the new waste toner box.

text_image
Diagram showing a hand inserting a device into a car seat, with an inset highlighting the seat assembly.5 Insert the new waste toner box as shown at the left. When the box is set correctly, it will snap into place.
6 Make sure that the waste toner box is correctly inserted and close the left cover.
7 After replacing the toner containers and the waste toner box, clean the internal parts. For instructions, refer to Cleaning on page 9-2.
NOTE: Return the exhausted waste toner box to your dealer or service representative. The collected waste toner box will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
Prolonged Non-Use and Moving of the Machine
Prolonged Non-use
If you ever leave the machine unused for a long period of time, remove the power cord from the wall outlet.
We recommend you consult with your dealer about the additional actions you should take to avoid possible damage that may occur when the machine is used next time.
Moving the Machine
When you move the machine:
- Move it gently.
- Keep it as level as possible to avoid spilling toner inside the machine.
- Be sure to consult a service technician before attempting long distance transportation of the machine.
WARNING: If you ship the machine, remove and pack the developer unit in a plastic bag and ship them separately from the machine.
Replacing the maintenance kit (MK-370)
When the print position shifts out of place or originals are not feeded, components must be replaced. Contact your Service Representative and purchase the maintenance kit. Follow the procedure below to replace the maintenance kit.
Replace the paper feed roller

natural_image
Illustration of a printer's internal structure being inserted into a machine, with no visible text or symbols.1 Open the left cover of the document processor.

text_image
Technical diagram showing a printer's internal structure with labeled parts and an inset view of the component being inserted.2 Lift the lever to release the lock.

text_image
Diagram showing mechanical assembly with labeled parts and a magnified inset highlighting a tool or component.3 Move the front side and remove the paper feed roller.
9
Replace the separation pad

text_image
Technical diagram showing car engine compartment with labeled parts and a magnified inset of the component1 While pressing down on the hooks (x2) shown in the diagram, lift up and remove the separation pad.
Install a new paper feed roller and separation pad

natural_image
Technical line drawing of a mechanical device with two views: one showing a shaft and housing, the other showing a separate housing (no text or symbols)1 Remove the new separation pad and paper feed roller from the maintenance kit and follow the removal procedures in reverse to install.
10 Troubleshooting
This chapter explains how to solve problems with the machine.
- Solving Malfunctions ...... 10-2
- Responding to Error Messages.... 10-6
- Clearing Paper Jams.... 10-13
Solving Malfunctions
The table below provides general guidelines for problem solving.
If a problem occurs with your machine, look into the checkpoints and perform procedures indicated on the following pages. If the problem persists, contact your Service Representative.
| Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions | Reference Page | |
| The operation panel does not respond when the main power switch is turned on. | Is the machine plugged in? Plug the power cord into an AC outlet. | — |
| Pressing the Start key does not produce copies. | Is there a message on the Message Display? | Determine appropriate response to the message and respond accordingly. |
| Is the machine in Sleep mode? | Press the Power key to recover the machine from Sleep mode. The machine will be ready to copy within 15 seconds. | |
| Blank sheets are ejected. | Are the originals loaded correctly? | When placing originals on the platen, place them face-down and align them with the slit glass. |
| When placing originals in the document processor, place them face-up. | ||
| Printouts are too light. Is the machine in Manual Density mode? | Select the correct density level. 5-13 | |
| When changing the default density level, adjust the density manually and choose the desired level. | ||
| Is the toner distributed evenly within the toner container? | ||
| Is there a message indicating the addition of toner? | ||
| Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. 2-41 | ||
| Is EcoPrint mode enabled? Disable EcoPrint mode. 4-8 | ||
| — Make sure the paper type setting is correct the paper being used. | ||
| — Refresh drum. 8-102 | ||
| Printouts are too dark. Is the machine in Auto Density mode? | Set the correct density level for auto density. | |
| Is the machine in Manual Density mode? | ||
| — Refresh drum. 8-102 | ||
| Symptom | Checkpoints | Corrective Actions | Reference Page | |
| Copies have a moire pattern (dots grouped together in patterns and not aligned uniformly). | Is the original a printed photograph? | Set the image quality to [Photo]. 5-12 | ||
| Printouts are not clear. | Did you choose appropriate image quality for the original? | Select appropriate image quality. 5-12 | ||
| Printouts are dirty. Is the | platen or the document processor dirty? | Clean the platen or the document processor. | 9-2 | |
| — Refresh drum. 8-102 | ||||
| Printouts are fuzzy. Is the | the machine being used in very humid conditions? | Use in a location that has suitable humidity. | — | |
| — Refresh drum. 8-102 | ||||
| Images are skewed. Are | the originals placed correctly? | When placing originals on the platen, align them with the slit glass. | 2-54 | |
| When placing originals in the document processor, align the original width guides securely before placing the originals. | 2-55 | |||
| Is the paper loaded correctly? | Check the position of the paper width guides. | 2-55 | ||
| Cannot feed originals. Are the originals placed correctly? | When placing originals in the document processor, align the original width guides securely before placing the originals. | 2-55 | ||
| Is the paper feed roller or the separation pad dirty? | Wipe the paper feed roller or the separation pad with a moistened cloth.If the problem is not solved, contact your Service Representative. Replace the paper feed roller and separation pad. | 9-8 | ||
| Paper often jams. Is the | paper loaded correctly? | Load the paper correctly. 2-41 | ||
| Is the paper of the supported type? Is it in good condition? | Remove the paper, turn it over, and reload it. | 2-41 | ||
| Is the paper curled, folded or wrinkled? | Replace the paper with new paper. 2-41 | |||
| Are there any loose scraps or jammed paper in the machine? | Remove any jammed paper. 10-13 | |||
| Printouts are wrinkled or curled. | Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. 2-41 | |||
| Symptom Checkpoints | Corrective Actions | Reference Page | |
| Cannot print. Is the machine plugged in? Plug the power cord into an AC outlet. | — | ||
| Documents are printed improperly. | Are the application software settings at the PC set properly? | Check that the printing system driver and application software settings are set properly. | — |
| Cannot print with USB memory. | Is the USB host blocked? | Select Unblock in the USB host settings. | 8-146 |
| — Check that the USB memory is securely plugged into the machine. | — | ||
| When displaying an image sent from the machine on the PC, an image size is shrunk vertically or horizontally. | Have you selected 200×100dpi Normal or 200×400dpi Super Fine for the scan resolution? | Select a scan resolution other than 200×100dpi Normal or 200×400dpi Super Fine when sending an image. | 5-14 |
| USB memory not recognized. | — Check that the USB memory is securely plugged into the machine. | — | |
| Is the USB host blocked? | Select Unblock in the USB host settings. | 8-146 | |
| Vertical streaks appear on prints. | Is the slit glass dirty? Clean the slit glass. 9-2 | ||
| The inside of the machine may be dirty. | Check the toner container and if necessary replace. | 9-5 | |
| Refresh drum. 8-102 | |||
| The top edge or back of the paper is dirty. | The inside of the machine may be dirty. | Clean the inside of the machine. 9-3 | |
| Part of the image is periodically faint or shows white lines. | Is the developer unit attached correctly? | Attach the developer unit correctly. | — |
| — Open and then close the rear cover. | — | ||
| — Refresh drum. 8-102 | |||
| Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions | Reference Page | ||
| Cannot send via SMB. Is the network cable connected? | Connect the correct network cable securely. | 2-5 | |
| Have the network settings for the equipment been configured properly? | Configure the TCP/IP settings properly. | ||
| Have the folder sharing settings been configured properly? | Check sharing settings and access privileges under the folder properties. | ||
| Has the SMB protocol been set to [On]? | Set the SMB protocol setting to [On]. | ||
| Has the [Host Name] been entered properly? | Check the name of the computer to which data is being sent.* | ||
| Has the [Path] been entered properly? | Check the share name for the shared folder. | ||
| Has the [Login User Name] been entered properly? | Check the domain name and login user name.** | ||
| Has the same domain name been used for the [Host Name] and [Login User Name]? | Delete the domain name and backslash ("") from the [Login User Name]. | ||
| Has the [Login Password] been entered properly? | Check the login password. 3-21 | ||
| Have exceptions for Windows Firewall been configured properly? | Configure exceptions for Windows Firewall properly. | ||
| Do the time settings for the equipment, domain server, and data destination computer differ? | Set the equipment, domain server, and data destination computer to the same time. | ||
| Is the touch panel displaying Send error.? | Refer to Responding to Send Error. | ||
* You can also enter a full computer name as the host name (for example, pc001.abcdnet.com).
** You can also enter login user names in the following formats: Domain_name/user_name (for example, abcdnet/james.smith) User_name@domain_name (for example, james.smith@abcdnet)
Responding to Error Messages
If the control panel displays any of these messages, follow the corresponding procedure.
Alphanumeric
| Error Message Check points Corrective Actions | Reference Page | |||
| Load paper in cassette 1. | Is the indicated cassette out of paper? | Load paper. 2-42 | ||
| Load paper in MP Tray. | Is the paper of the selected size loaded in the multi purpose tray? | Load the paper in the multi purpose tray which is of the size and type indicated on the Message Display. | 2-45 | |
| Toner is running out. | - | Prepare the toner container. | 9-5 | |
| Add toner. Is the displayed message accompanied by a lit error LED? | Replace the toner container. 9-5 | |||
| Check waste toner box. | - Prepare the waste toner box. 9-7 | |||
| Waste toner box is full. | - | Replace the waste toner box. | 9-7 | |
| Check cassette 1. Does a paper lift error occur in the paper source's cassette? | Pull out the cassette for the paper source displayed (either the paper cassettes or optional paper feeders) and check if the paper is loaded correctly. | - | ||
| Cannot connect to Authentication Server. | - Press the OK key and check the following items:• Registration to Authentication Serve• Password and computer address for Authentication Server• Connection of Network | - | ||
| Cannot duplex print on this paper. | Did you select a paper size/ media type that cannot be duplex printed? | Select the available paper type. Press the OK key to print without using Duplex. | 3-12 | |
| Account error. | - Set the accounting settings using PRESCRIBE again. | - | ||
| Incorrect account ID. Job is canceled. | - This job is canceled because it is restricted by Job Accounting. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| Restricted by Job Accounting. Cannot print. | - This job cannot be printed because it is restricted by Job Accounting. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| Cannot execute this job. Restricted by Group Authorization. | - This job is canceled because it is restricted by Group Authorization. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| Close front cover. Is there any cover which is open? | Close the cover indicated on the operation panel. | — | ||
| Close Document Processor. | Is the document processor open? | Close the document processor. — | ||
| Is the top cover of the document processor open? | Close the top cover of the document processor. | — | ||
| Left cover is open. | Is the left cover open? | Close the left cover. | — | |
| Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Cannot print. | – The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Cannot scan. | – The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Polling box limit exceeded. Job is canceled. | – Polling box is full, and no further storage is available. The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Incorrect Login User Name or Password. Job Is canceled. | – Enter correct login user name or password. | — | ||
| Failed to store job retention data. Job is canceled. | Is there insufficient space available on the RAM disk? | Printing using the Job Box function failed because there was insufficient space available on the RAM disk. Change the size of RAM disk with the numeric keys. | 8-67 | |
| RAM disk error. Press [OK]. ## | – A RAM disk error has occurred. Look at the error code given in place of ##. The possible error codes and their descriptions are as follows.01: Format error. Try turning the power off and on again.02: RAM disk mode is Off. Turn RAM disk mode On from the operation panel.04: No disk space. Purge unnecessary files.05: Specified file is not on disk.06: Insufficient memory to support the RAM disk system. Expand the memory. | — | ||
| Incorrect ID Is the user ID entered for private job correct? | The user ID entered for a private job is not correct. Check the user ID that you specified on the printer driver. | 6-9 | ||
| Job Accounting restriction exceeded. Job is canceled. | Is the acceptable printing count restricted by Job Accounting exceeded? | The printing count exceeded the acceptable count restricted by Job Accounting. Cannot print any more. This job is canceled. Press the OK key. | ||
| Machine failure. Call service. | - Internal error has occurred. | - | ||
| Is Error code "C4200" displayed? | Internal condensation has occurred as a result of a sudden change in temperature. Turn off the machine and let stand for 30 to 90 minutes, and then back on again. If this message still remains, turn off the machine, unplug the power cord, and contact your Service Representative. | |||
| Memory is full. Print job cannot be processed completely. | - Unable to continue the job as the memory is used up. Press the OK key to print the scanned pages. The print job cannot be processed completely. Press the Stop key to cancel the job. | - | ||
| Memory is full. Job is canceled. | - The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| USB memory error. Job is canceled. | - This job is canceled. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| Removable memory is full. Job is canceled. | - This job is canceled. Press the OK key. | - | ||
| Cannot feed paper set cassette 1. | Is any of the paper feeders or the printer cassette upper than the selected one properly closed when one or more optional feeders are installed? | Close the paper feeder properly. 2-42 | ||
| Place original and press Start key. | - Remove originals from the document processor, put them back in their original order, and place them again. Press the Start key to resume printing. Press the Stop key to cancel the job. | 2-55 | ||
| Paper jammed. - If a paper jam occurs, the machine will stop and the location of the jam will be indicated on the Message Display. Leave the machine on and follow the instruction to remove the jammed paper. | 10-13 | |||
| Job not stored. Press [OK]. | -Press the OK key to store the job. — | |||
| Remove original from document processor. | Are there any originals left in the document processor? | Remove originals from the document processor. | ||
| Maximum Number of scanned pages. Job is canceled. | -Scanning cannot be performed due to insufficient memory of scanner. The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Is the acceptable scanning count exceeded? | Press the OK key to print, send or store the scanned pages. Press the Stop key to cancel printing, sending or storing. | |||
| Send error. #### | -An error has occurred during transmission. The possible error codes and their descriptions are as follows.1101: The server name of the SMTP server is not set correctly or the host name is incorrect when sending scan data to an FTP server. Use COMMAND CENTER and register the SMTP server name and the host name correctly.1102: The login user name is incorrect or the domain name has not been entered. Enter login user name, domain name and password correctly.1103: The network path name is incorrect or you do not have access to the folder specified. Use COMMAND CENTER and register the path name correctly.1104: No recipient address. Enter E-mail address correctly.1105: E-mail - The SMTP protocol setting is turned off. Use COMMAND CENTER and turn on the SMTP protocol setting.Scan to PC (SMB) - SMB setting is turned off. Use COMMAND CENTER and turn on the SMB setting.Scan to PC (FTP) - FTP setting is turned off. Use COMMAND CENTER and turn on the FTP setting.1106: The sender address setting under E-mail: SMTP is not registered. Use COMMAND CENTER and register the sender address. | — | ||
| Send error.#### | 2101, 2102, 2103, 2201, 2202, 2203, 3101: The network cable is disconnected or the hub that it is connected to is not operating properly. Check the cable and the hub. Otherwise, the server name or the host name of the SMTP server is not set correctly. Use COMMAND CENTER and register the SMTP server name and the host name correctly.2204: The E-mail size exceeds the acceptable send data capacity. Decrease the size or resolution of the scanned data to be transmitted and resend the E-mail.5101, 5102, 5103, 5104, 7102, 720f: Turn the main power switch off and back on. If this error occurs several times, make a note of the displayed error code and contact your service representative.(Refer to the corrective action for the error message “An error has occurred.”)9181: The scanned original exceeds the acceptable number of pages of 999. Send the excess pages separately. | |||
| Error occurred.Turn the main power switch off and on. | - System error has occurred. | Turn the main power switch off and on. | ||
| Incorrect account ID. - | The Account ID does not match. | Check the registered Account ID. | ||
| The phone receiver is off the hook.Hang Up. | - Put down the receiver. — | |||
| File is not found.Job is canceled. | - The specified file is not found. The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| KPDL error. Job is canceled. | - The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Print overrun. Job is canceled. | - The job is canceled. Press the OK key. | — | ||
| Inner Tray is full of Paper.Remove the paper. | - Remove paper from the inner tray, and press the OK key to resume the job. | — | ||
| Unknown toner Installed. | Is the installed toner container our own brand? | We will not be liable for any damage caused by the use of third party supplies in this machine. | ||
| Error Message Check points Corrective Actions | Reference Page | ||
| Unknown toner Installed. PC | Does the installed toner container's regional specification match the machines's? | Install the specified container. 9-5 | |
| Insufficient memory. Cannot start the job | – Further scanning cannot be | performed due to insufficient memory. Press the OK key to print the scanned pages. Press the Cancel key to cancel the printing job. | — |
| Match the paper type and the envelope switch position. | Are envelopes printing using the envelope mode? | Press the two envelope buttons to change the paper feed mode to envelope mode. | 2-47 |
| Match the position of envelope switches. | Is either of the envelope switches is pressed? | Press the both switches. 2-47 | |
| The developer unit is not installed. | Is the developer unit installed correctly? | Contact your service technician. — | |
| Replace Process Unit. | – Replacement of the parts in the maintenance kit is necessary at every 300,000 pages of printing and requires professional servicing. Contact your service technician. | — | |
Responding to an Error Lamp Flashes
If an error lamp flashes, press [Status/Job Cancel] to check an error message. If the message is not indicated on the Message Display when [Status/Job Cancel] is pressed or the error lamp flashes for 1.5 seconds, check the following.
| Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions Reference Page | |||
| Cannot send fax. Is the modular cord connected correctly? | Connect the modular cord correctly. | — | |
| Is Permitted FAX No. or Permitted ID No. registered correctly? | Check Permitted FAX No. and Permitted ID No.. | ||
| Has a communication error occurred? | Check error codes in the TX/RX Result Report and Activity Report. If the error code starts with "U" or "E", perform the corresponding procedure. | ||
| Is the destination FAX line busy? | Send again. — | ||
| Does the destination FAX machine respond? | Send again. — | ||
| Is there an error other than above? | Contact your Service Representative. | ||
Clearing Paper Jams
If a paper jam occurs, a message will be displayed about the jam and copying or printing will stop.
Leave the main power switch on and to remove the jammed paper refer to the following information below.
Jam Location Indicators
If a paper jam occurs, the error message displays the location of the jam.
| Paper Jam Location Reference Page | |
| Document processor 10-17 | |
| Inside the machine 10-15 | |
| MP Tray 10-14 | |
| Cassettes 10-14 | |
| Duplexer 10-15 | |
| Rear unit 10-17 | |
Precautions with Paper Jams
If a paper jam occurs, a message will be displayed about the jam and copying or printing will stop.
- Do not reuse jammed papers.
- If the paper tears during removal, be sure to remove any loose scraps of paper from inside the machine. Scraps of paper left in the machine could cause subsequent jamming.
- A page affected by a paper jam will be printed again.
CAUTION: The fixing unit is extremely hot. Take sufficient care when working in this area, as there is a danger of getting burned.
Online Help Messages
When Paper Jam is displayed, press Help to display the procedure to clear the jam.
Press to display the next step or press to display the previous step.
Press the OK key to exit the online help message display.
MP Tray
Follow the steps below to clear paper jams in the MP tray.

natural_image
Illustration of a printer's front panel being inserted into a green cover, with a hand holding the cover (no text or symbols present)1 Remove the paper jammed at the MP tray.
2 Open and close the top cover and front cover to clear the error.
Cassette/Paper Feeder
Follow the steps below to clear paper jams in cassette or paper feeder.

natural_image
Two-step diagram showing printer press and disc disposal process, with no visible text or symbols1 Pull out the cassette or optional paper feeder.
2 Remove any partially fed paper.
NOTE: Check to see if paper is loaded correctly. If not, reload the paper.
3 Push the cassette back in securely. The printer warms up and resumes printing.
Duplexer
Paper is jammed in the duplexer. Remove the jammed paper using the procedure given below.

natural_image
Technical line drawing of a printer internal structure (no text or symbols)
CAUTION: Do not touch parts in this area, because it may result in burn injury.

text_image
Diagram showing printer press operation with arrows indicating process steps1 Pull the cassette all the way out of the printer.
2 Open the duplexer's cover and remove any jammed paper.
3 Push the cassette back in securely. The machine warms up and resumes printing.
Inside the Machine
Follow the steps below to clear paper jams inside the machine.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer's internal structure showing green cover and paper feed, with arrows indicating motion direction (no text or symbols)1 Open the top cover and front cover.

natural_image
Illustration of hands installing or adjusting a green plastic component into an air conditioner unit (no text or symbols visible)2 Lift the developer unit together with the toner container out of the machine.

natural_image
Diagram of a mechanical component with a hand pressing a section, showing internal structure and a green highlighted area (no text or symbols)3 Open the feed cover.

natural_image
Illustration of hands inserting a green component into a printer case (no text or symbols visible)4 Remove the paper from the machine
If the jammed paper appears to be pinched by rollers, pull it along the normal running direction of the paper.
NOTE: If you cannot find a paper jam, try checking inside the rear of the printer. Refer to Rear Unit on page 5-18.

natural_image
Illustration of hands cleaning a printer's internal structure with green components and arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)5 Insert the developer unit together with the toner container, back into the machine.
6 Close the top cover and front cover. The machine warms up and resumes printing.
Rear Unit
Follow the steps below to clear paper jams of the rear unit.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green drive into a computer tower (no text or symbols visible)1 If paper is not completely ejected into the output tray, open the rear cover.

natural_image
Diagram of a printer or printer with hands operating the cover and pressing down, showing green internal structure and black directional arrows indicating process flow (no text or symbols present)2 Open the fuser cover and remove the jammed paper by pulling it out.
NOTE: If you cannot find a paper jam, try checking inside the rear of the machine.

CAUTION: The fuser unit inside the machine is hot. Do not touch it with your hands as it may result in burn injury. Remove jammed paper carefully.

natural_image
Illustration of hands inserting a green card into a computer case (no text or symbols visible)3 Close the rear cover. The machine warms up and resumes printing out.
Document Processor
Follow the steps below to clear paper jams in the document processor.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green card into a printer (no text or symbols visible)1 Remove all of the originals from the document feed tray.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green leaf into a printer (no text or symbols visible)2 Open the left cover of the document processor.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green card into an open printer (no text or symbols visible)3 Remove the jammed original.
If the original is caught in the rollers or difficult to remove, proceed to the next step.

natural_image
Illustration of a green printer with a hand operating it, showing the paper being placed on top (no text or symbols present)4 Open the document processor.

natural_image
Illustration of a hand inserting a green cover into an open printer (no text or symbols visible)5 Remove the jammed original.
If the original tears, remove every loose scrap from inside the machine.
6 Close the document processor.
7 Place the originals.
11 Management
This chapter explains the following operations.
- User Login Administration 11-2
• Job Accounting.... 11-15 - Checking the Counter...... 11-37
User Login Administration
User login administration specifies how the user access is administered on this machine. Enter correct login user name and password for user authentication to log in.
Access are in three levels - User, Administrator, and Machine Administrator. The security levels can be modified only by the machine administrator.
First User Login Administration
Follow these steps for the first user login administration.
Enable user login administration. (page 11-2)

Add a user.(page 11-6)

Log out.(page 11-5)

The registered user logs in for operations.(page 11-5)
Enabling/Disabling User Login Administration
This enables user login administration. Select one of the following authentication methods:
| Item Description | |
| Local Authentication | User authentication based on user properties on the local user list stored in the machine. |
| Network Authentication | User authentication based on Authentication Server. Use a user property stored in Authentication Server to access the network authentication login page. |
Use the procedure below to enable user login administration.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK [0] User Login Set. [0 2] Job Account. Set. [0 3] Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
User Login Set.: OK [0] User Login [0 2] Local User List [0 3] Group Auth. [ Exit ]
text_image
User Login: 01 *Off 02 Local Authentic. 03 Netwk Authentic.1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [User Login Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The User Login Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [User Login].
7 Press the OK key. User Login appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Local Authentic.] or [Netwk Authentic.], and then press the OK key.

text_image
Server Type: 01 NTLM 02*Kerberos 03 Ext.
text_image
Host Name: ABC [ Text ]Select [Off] to disable user login administration.
When "Network Authentication" is selected, select [NTLM], [Kerberos], or [Ext.] for the server type and press the OK key.
If [NTLM] or [Kerberos] is selected for the server type, enter the host name (up to 64 characters) and domain name (up to 256 characters) of the authentication server, and press the OK key. If [Ext.] is selected for the server type, enter the host name (up to 64 characters) and port number of the authentication server, and press the OK key.
NOTE: If the login user name and password are rejected, check the following settings.
• Network Authentication setting of the machine
- User property of the Authentication Server
- Date and time setting of the machine and the Authentication Server
If you cannot login because of the setting of the machine, login with any administrator registered in the local user list and correct the settings. If the server type is [Kerberos], only domain names entered in uppercase will be recognized.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the User Login Set. menu.
Login/Logout
Once you enable user login administration, a login user name and password entry screen appears each time you use this machine.
Login
Log in using the procedure below.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Login User Name Login Password: [ Login ]1 If the screen below appears during the operations, perform the following login operations.
2 Press the OK key, enter the login user name, and then press the OK key.
3 Press the ▽ key to select [Login Password], press the OK key, enter the login password, and then press the OK key.
4 Check the login user name and password are correct, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
Logout

To log out the machine, press the Logout key to return to the login user name/login password entry screen.
Auto Logout
Logout is automatically executed in the following cases:
- When the Power key is pressed to enter the sleep mode
- When auto sleep is activated
- When auto panel reset is activated
- When auto low power mode is activated
Adding a User
This adds a new user. You can add Up to 21 users (including the default login user name). The table below explains the user information to be registered.
| Item Description | |
| User Name* | Enter the name displayed on the user list (up to 32 characters). |
| Login User Name* | Enter the login user name to log in (up to 32 characters). The same login user name cannot be registered. |
| Login Password* | Enter the password to log in (up to 64 characters). |
| Access Level* Select Administrator or User for user access privileges. | |
| Account Name Add an account where the user belongs. The user, who registered his/her account name, can log in without entering the account ID. Refer to Job Accounting on page 11-15. | |
| E-mail Address The user can register his/her E-mail address. The registered address will be automatically selected for subsequent operations that need any E-mail function. | |
* Mandatory at user registration.
NOTE: By default, one of each default user with machine administrator rights and administrator privileges is already stored. The following are the default user's properties.
User Name: DeviceAdmin
Login User Name: 4000
Login Password: 4000
Access Level: Administrator
It is recommended to periodically change the user name, login user name and login password regularly for your security.
Use the procedure below to register a new user.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
User/Job Account: OK [01] User Login Set. [02] Job Account. Set. [03] Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [User Login Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The User Login Set. menu appears.

text_image
User Login Set.: OK 01 User Login 02 Local User List 03 IC Card Setting [ Exit ]6 Press the or key to select [Local User List].
7 Press the OK key. Local User List appears.

text_image
Local User List: • Admin • DeviceAdmin [ Menu ]8 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key), press the or key to select [Add User], and then press the OK key.

text_image
Menu: 01 Detail/Edit 02 Delete 03 Add User9 Enter the user name and press the OK key, enter the login user name in the next screen, and then press the OK key.

text_image
User Name: ABC [ Text ]
text_image
User01: 01 Exit 02 Detail10 Press the or key to select [Exit] and then press the OK key.
Select [Detail] and press the OK key to see information of the registered users.

text_image
Local User List: ◆ OK • DeviceAdmin • Admin • User 1 [ Menu ]11 In Local User List, press the or key to select the added user and then press the OK key.

text_image
Detail: Login Password: 3/6 [ Edit ]12 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to select [Login Password:], press [Edit] (the Right Select key), enter the login password, and then press the OK key.

text_image
Detail: ✓E-mailAddress: 4/6 *****@abcdef.jp [ Edit ]13 Enter the same login password to confirm and press the OK key.
14 Press the ▷ key to select [E-mailAddress:], press [Edit] (the Right Select key), enter the e-mail address, and then press the OK key.

text_image
Detail: Access Level: 5/6 Administrator [ Change ]15 Press the ▷ key to select [Access Level:], press [Change] (the Right Select key), select the user access privilege, and then press the OK key.

text_image
Detail: Account Name: 6/6 RD Center [ Change ]NOTE: If the user list is for device administrator, [Change] is not displayed.
16 Press the ▷ key to select [Account Name:], press [Change] (the Right Select key), select the account, and then press the OK key.
NOTE: If the user list is for device administrator and the device administrator does not log in, [Change] is not displayed.
17 After entering the user information, press the OK key again.
Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to Local User List.
Changing User Properties
User information can be changed. It can be changed only by a user with administrator privileges.
Use the procedure below to change the user properties.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK [0] User Login Set. [0 2] Job Account. Set. [0 3] Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
User Login Set.: OK 01 User Login 02 Local User List 03 Group Auth. [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [User Login Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The User Login Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Local User List].

text_image
Local User List: DeviceAdmin Admin User1 [ Menu ]7 Press the OK key. Local User List appears.
The procedure differs depending on the details to be edited.
Changing user information

text_image
Local User List: DeviceAdmin Admin User1 [ Menu ]
text_image
Detail: User Name: 1/6 User1 [ Edit ]1 Press the or key to select the user whose information you want to change, and then press the OK key.
2 In the same fashion as registering a new user, press the ◀ or ▷ key to select the desired item, press [Edit] (the Right Select key), change information, and then press the OK key.
3 Repeat step 2 to change items as necessary.
4 After completing changing the user information, press the OK key again.
5 The overwrite confirmation screen appears.
Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The user information is changed and the screen returns to Local User List.
Deleting a user

text_image
Local User List: DeviceAdmin Admin User1 [ Menu ]1 Press the △ or ▽ key to select the user you want to delete, and then press [Menu] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Menu: 01 Detail/Edit 02 Delete 03 Add User2 Press the or key to select [Delete] and then press the OK key.
3 In the delete confirmation screen, press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The user is deleted and the screen returns to Local User List.
Enabling/Disabling Group Authentication
This enables group authentication using the LDAP server. This menu can be used only when [Netwk Authentic.] is selected as the user authentication method. For details of LDAP server settings, refer to the Operation Guide of the LDAP server.
Use the procedure below to enable group authentication.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK [0] User Login Set. [0 2] Job Account. Set. [0 3] Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
User Login Set.: OK 01 User Login 02 Local User List 03 Group Auth. [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [User Login Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The User Login Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Group Auth.].

text_image
Group Auth.: [0 1]*Off [0 2] On7 Press the OK key. Group Auth. appears.
8 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
9 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the User/Job Account menu.
Displaying Network User Propertiy
Use the procedure below to display the property of the user logged on using the network authentication. This menu can be used only when [Netwk Authentic.] is selected as the user authentication method.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [User Login Set.].

text_image
User/Job Account: OK [01] User Login Set. [02] Job Account. Set. [03] Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
User Login Set.: 01 User Login 02 Local User List 03 Group Auth. [ Exit ]5 Press the OK key. The User Login Set. menu appears.

text_image
NW User Property: ◆ OK [0 1] *Off [0 2] On6 Press the or key to select [NW User Property].
7 Press the OK key. NW User Property appears.
8 Press the or key to select [On] or [Off].
9 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the User/Job Account menu.
Unknown login user name Job
This specifies the behavior for handling the jobs sent with unknown login user names or User ID (i.e. unsent IDs). If the User Login is set to invalid and Job Accounting is set to valid, follow the procedure when the Account ID is unknown.
The table below shows the available settings.
| Item Description |
| Reject The job is rejected (not printed). |
| Permit The job is permitted to be printed. |
Use the procedure below to process jobs sent from unknown users.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK [0 4] User/Job Account [0 5] User Property [0 6] Common Settings [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
User/Job Account: ◆ OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account. Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Unknown ID Job].
5 Press the OK key. Unknown ID Job appears.

text_image
Unknown ID Job: [0 1] *Reject [0 2] Permit6 Press the or key to select [Reject] or [Permit].
7 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the User/Job Account menu.
Job Accounting
Job accounting Manages the copy/print count accumulated by individual accounts by assigning an ID to each account.
Job accounting helps the following activities in business organizations.
- Manageability of up to 20 individual accounts.
• Availability for account IDs with as many as eight digits (between 0 and 99999999) for security. - Integrated management of printing and scanning statistics through the use of an identical account ID.
- Tracking the print volume for each account and for all accounts combined.
- Restricting the print counter in one-page increments up to 9,999,999 copies.
- Resetting the print counter for each account or for all accounts combined.
First Job Accounting Setup
Follow these steps for the first job accounting setup.
Enable job accounting. (page 11-15)

Log out. (page 11-17)

Other users log in for operations. (page 11-17)
Enabling/Disabling Job Accounting
Enable job accounting. Use the procedure below to specify the job accounting setting.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).

text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.

text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK [01] Job Accounting [02] Account. Report [03] Total Accounting [ Exit ]6 Press the or key to select [Job Accounting].
7 Press the OK key. Job Accounting appears.

text_image
Job Accounting: [01]*Off [02] On8 Press the or key to select [On]. To disable job accounting, select [Off].
9 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Job Account. Set. menu.
NOTE: When the display returns to the System Menu default screen, logout is automatically executed and the screen to enter the Account ID appears. To continue the operation, enter the Account ID.
Login/Logout
If job accounting is enabled, an account ID entry screen appears each time you use this machine.
Use the procedure below to login and logout.
Login
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
Account ID: [Counter ]1 In the screen below, enter the account ID using the numeric keys and press the OK key.
NOTE: If you entered a wrong character, press the Clear key and enter the account ID again.
If the entered account ID does not match the registered ID, a warning beep will sound and login will fail. Enter the correct account ID.
By pressing [Counter] (the Left Select key), you can refer to the number of pages printed and the number of pages scanned.
When the screen to enter the login user name and password appears
If user login administration is enabled, the screen to enter the login user name and password appears. Enter a login user name and password to log in. (Refer to Login/Logout on page 11-5.) If the user has already registered the account information, the account ID entry would be skipped. (Refer to Adding a User on page 11-6.)
2 Proceed to complete the rest of the steps.
Logout

When the operations are complete, press the Logout key to return to the account ID entry screen.
Managing Accounts
This section explains how to add a new account. The following entries are required.
| Item Description | |
| Account Name Enter the account name (up to 32 characters). | |
| Account ID Enter the account ID as many as eight digits (between 0 and 99999999). | |
| Restriction This Prohibits printing/scanning or restricts the number of sheets to load. Refer to Restricting the Use of the Machine on page 11-23. |
Use the procedure below to register a new account.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].

text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK 04 Each Job Account 05 Account. List 06 Default Setting [ Exit ]5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.

text_image
Account. List: ● UI R&D DEP. ● GUI Design ● RD Center [ Menu ]6 Press the or key to select [Account. List].
7 Press the OK key. Account. List appears.
8 Press [Menu] (the Right Select key), press the or key to select [Add Account], and then press the OK key.

text_image
Menu: 01 Detail/Edit 02 Delete 03 Add Account9 Enter the account name and press the OK key.

text_image
Account Name: ABC [ Text ]10 Enter the account code and press the OK key.

text_image
Account ID: OKNOTE: Any account ID that has already registered cannot be used. Enter any other account ID.

text_image
Dep.01: 01 Exit 02 Detail11 Press the or key to select [Exit] and then press the OK key.
Select [Detail] and press the OK key to see information of the registered accounts.
12 Account. List is displayed and the new account is added to the account list.
Managing Accounts
This changes the registered account information or deletes the account.
Use the procedure below to manage accounts.
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: ◆ OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK 04 Each Job Account 05 Account. List 06 Default Setting [ Exit ]
text_image
Account. List: UI R&D DEP. GUI Design RD Center [ Menu ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Account. List].
7 Press the OK key. Account. List appears.
The procedure differs depending on the details to be edited.

text_image
Account. List: ● UI R&D DEP. ● GUI Design ● RD Center [ Menu ]
text_image
Detail: Account Name: 1/7 GUI Design [ Edit ]
text_image
Overwrite. Are you sure? →●GUI DESIGN [ Yes ] [ No ]
text_image
Account. List: ● UI R&D DEP. ● GUI Design ● RD Center [ Menu ]
text_image
Menu: 01 Detail/Edit 02 Delete 03 Add AccountChanging account information
1 Press the or key to select the account whose information you want to change, and then press the OK key.
2 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to select the item you want to change, press [Edit] (the Right Select key), change account information and restriction of use, and then press the OK key.
NOTE: Activate or deactivate restriction. Refer to Restricting the Use of the Machine on page 11-23.
3 Repeat step 2 to change items as necessary.
4 After completing changing the account information, press the OK key again. A confirmation screen appears.
5 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The account information is changed. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to Account. List.
Deleting an account
1 Press the or key to select the account you want to delete, and then press [Menu] (the Right Select key).
2 Press the or key to select [Delete].

text_image
Delete. Are you sure? → UI R&D DEPT. [ Yes ] [ No ]3 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
4 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The account is deleted. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to Account. List.
Managing the Copier/Printer Counts
You can select how the copying and printing page counts are shown - either the total of both or each of copying and printing individually. The selection may influence restriction on the count and count method. Refer to Restricting the Use of the Machine on page 11-23, Counting the Number of Pages Printed on page 11-31 and Printing an Accounting Report on page 11-35 for details.
Use the procedure below to set the counting methods.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].

text_image
Job Account.Set: OK 01 Job Accounting 02 Account Report 03 Total Accounting [ Exit ]5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.

text_image
Default Setting: ◆ OK 01 Apply Limit 02 Copy/Print Count 03 Counter Limit [ Exit ]6 Press the or key to select [Default Setting].
7 Press the OK key. The Default Setting menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Copy/Print Count].
9 Press the OK key. Copy/Print Count appears.

text_image
Copy/Print Count: ◆ OK 01 Total 02 *Split10 Press the or key to select [Total] or [Split].
11 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Default Setting menu.
Restricting the Use of the Machine
This section explains how to restrict the use of the machine by account or the number of sheets available.
The items that can be restricted differ depending on whether [Split] or [Total] is selected for Managing the Copier/Printer Counts on page 11-22.
Restriction Items
◆ [Split] selected for Copier/Printer Count
| Item Detail | |
| Print Restriction (Copier) | Limits the number of sheets used for copying. |
| Print Restriction (Printer) | Limits the number of sheets used for printing. |
| Scan Restriction (Others) | Limits the number of sheets scanned (excludes copying and sending fax). |
| Fax TX Restriction | Limits the number of sheets sent by fax. (For FS-3140MFP+ only) |
◆ [Total] selected for Copier/Printer Count
| Item Detail | |
| Print Restriction Limits the total number of sheets used for copying and printing. | |
| Scan Restriction (Others) | Limits the number of sheets scanned (excludes copying). |
| Fax TX Restriction | Limits the number of sheets sent by fax. (For FS-3140MFP+ only) |
Applying Restriction
Restriction can be applied in two modes as follows:
| Item Description |
| Off No restriction given |
| Counter Limit Restricts the print counter in one-page increments up to 9,999,999 copies. |
| Reject Usage Restriction is applied. |
Use the procedure below to select a restriction method.

text_image
Account. List: ● UI R&D DEP. ● GUI Design ● RD Center [ Menu ]1 Follow steps 1 to 7 of Managing Accounts on page 11-18.
2 In Account. List, press the or key to select the account to which you want to set restriction of use, and then press the OK key.
Detail: OK
Print Restrict.: 4/6
Total
Off
[ Edit ]
3 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to select the item to be restricted and then press [Edit] (the Right Select key).
Detail: OK
Print Restrict.: 4/7
Copier
Off
[ Edit ]
When selecting [Split] in Copy/Print Count, screen changes as shown in the left.
Print Restrict.: OK
[0 1]*Off
[0 2] Counter Limit
[0 3] Reject Usage
4 Press the or key to select the desired restriction method and then press the OK key.
Limit Pages: OK
(1 - 9999999)
123456 pages
If you select [Counter Limit], enter the upper limit number of pages in the next screen, and then press the OK key.
Overwrite.
Are you sure?
→ GUI DESIGN
[ Yes ] [ No ]
5 Repeat step 3 to 4 to set items as necessary.
6 Press the OK key again. A confirmation screen appears.
7 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The restriction of use is changed. Registered. is displayed and the screen returns to Account. List.
Applying Limit of Restriction
This specifies how the machine behaves when the counter has reached the limit of restriction. The table below describes the action taken.
| Item Description | |
| Immediately * | Job stops when the counter reaches its limit. |
| Subsequently Printing/scanning of the job continues but the subsequent job will be rejected. | |
| Alert Only Job continues while displaying an alert message. | |
* The next job will be prohibited in sending or in storing in the box.
Use the procedure below to apply the restriction limit.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK 04 Each Job Account 05 Account. List 06 Default Setting [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The User/Job Account menu appears. Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.

text_image
Default Setting: OK 01 Apply Limit 02 Copy/Print Count 03 Counter Limit [ Exit ]
text_image
Apply Limit: 01 Immediately 02 *Subsequently 03 Alert Only6 Press the or key to select [Default Setting].
7 Press the OK key. The Default Setting menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select [Apply Limit].
9 Press the OK key. Apply Limit appears.
10 Press the or key to select [Immediately], [Subsequently] or [Alert Only].
11 Press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Default Setting menu.
Default Counter Limit
When you add a new account, you can change the default restrictions on the number of sheets used.
You can set any number from 1 to 9,999,999 in 1-sheet increments.
The items that can be set differ depending on whether [Split] or [Total] is selected for Managing the Copier/Printer Counts on page 11-22.
Available Settings
◆ [Split] selected for Copier/Printer Count
| Item Detail | |
| Copy Restriction Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for copying. | |
| Print Restriction Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for printing. | |
| Scan Restriction (Other) | Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for scanning (excludes copying). |
| FAX TX Restriction | Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for sending faxes. (For FS-3140MFP+ only) |
◆ [Total] selected for Copier/Printer Count
| Item Detail | |
| Print Restriction Sets the default restriction on the total number of sheets used for copying and printing. | |
| Scan Restriction (Other) | Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for scanning (excludes copying). |
| FAX TX Restriction | Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for sending faxes. (For FS-3140MFP+ only) |
Use the procedure below to specify the counter limits.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].

text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The User/Job Account menu appears. Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.

text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.

text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK 01 Each Job Account 02 Account. List 03 Default Setting [ Exit ]6 Press the or key to select [Default Setting].
7 Press the OK key. The Default Setting menu appears.

text_image
Default Setting: OK 01 Apply Limit 02 Copy/Print Count 03 Counter Limit [ Exit ]8 Press the or key to select [Counter Limit].
9 Press the OK key. Counter Limit appears.

text_image
Counter Limit: 01 Copy Restriction 02 Print Restrict. 03 ScanRest.(Other)10 Press the or key to select the item for which you want to set the default restriction on the number of sheets, and then press the OK key.

text_image
Copy Restriction: OK (1 - 9999999) 12345611 Use the numeric keys to enter the default restriction on the number of sheets, and then press the OK key.
Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to Counter Limit.
12 Repeat steps 10 to 11 set other default restrictions on the number of sheets.
Counting the Number of Pages Printed
This counts the number of pages printed. Counts are classified into Total Job Accounting and Each Job Accounting. A new count can also be started after resetting the count data which was stored for a certain period of time.
Types of the counts are as follows.
| Item Detail | |
| Printed Pages Displays the number of pages copied and printed, and the total number of pages used. You can also use [Duplex Pages] and [Combine Pages] to check the number of pages used. | |
| Scanned Pages Displays the number of pages scanned for copying, faxing* and other functions, as well as the total number of pages scanned. | |
| FAX TX Pages* Displays the number of pages faxed. | |
| FAX TX Time* | Displays the total duration of fax transmissions. |
* FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+.
Total Job Accounting/Resetting the Counter
This counts the number of pages for all accounts and resets the counts for those accounts together at the same time.
Use the procedure below to check and reset the counter.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The User/Job Account menu appears. Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.

text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Account.Set: OK [0 1] Job Accounting [0 2] Account. Report [0 3] Total Accounting [ Exit ]
text_image
Total Accounting: OK [01] Printed Pages [02] Scanned Pages [03] FAX TX Pages [ Exit ]
text_image
Copy/Print Pages: OK Copy: 1/3 1234567
text_image
Total Accounting: OK 01 Printed Pages 02 Scanned Pages 03 Counter Reset [ Exit ]
text_image
Reset counter. Are you sure? →Total JobAccounting [ Yes ] [ No ]4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Total Accounting].
7 Press the OK key. The Total Accounting menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select the function of which you want to check counts, and then press the OK key.
If you select [Printed Pages] or [Scanned Pages], press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the counted items.
9 After confirming the content, press the OK key. The screen returns to the Total Accounting menu.
10 To reset the counter, press the or key to select [Counter Reset].
11 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
12 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The counter is reset. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the Total Accounting menu.
Each Job Accounting/Resetting the Counter
This counts the number of pages for each account and resets the counts by account.
Use the procedure below to display and reset the counter.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]
text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Account.Set.: OK 04 Each Job Account 05 Account List 06 Default Setting [ Exit ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The User/Job Account menu appears. Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.
4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Each Job Account].

text_image
Each Job Account: OK GUI DESIGN RD Center UI R&D DEPT.
text_image
GUI DESIGN: [0 1] Printed Pages [0 2] Scanned Pages [0 3] FAX TX Pages [ Exit ]
text_image
FAX TX Pages: FAX: 1/3 1234567 Limit:1234567
text_image
GUI DESIGN: 01 Printed Pages 02 Scanned Pages 03 Counter Reset [ Exit ]
text_image
Reset counter. Are you sure? →●GUI DESIGN [ Yes ] [ No ]7 Press the OK key. The Each Job Accounting menu appears.
8 Press the or key to select the account of which you want to check counts.
9 Press the OK key. A menu for the account appears.
10 Press the or key to select the function of which you want to check counts, and then press the OK key.
If you select [Printed Pages], select the item for which you want to check printed page counts, and then press the OK key. Press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the counted items.
If you select [Scanned Pages], press the ◀ or ▷ key to switch the counted items.
If the number of output sheets is restricted by an account management function, the upper limit on the number of output sheets is also displayed.
11 After confirming the content, press the OK key. The screen returns to the menu for the account.
12 To reset the counter, press the or key to select [Counter Reset].
13 Press the OK key. A confirmation screen appears.
14 Press [Yes] (the Left Select key). The counter is reset. Completed. is displayed and the screen returns to the menu for the account.
Printing an Accounting Report
Total pages counted at all relevant accounts can be printed as an accounting report.
Reports have different formats depending on how the count of copiers and printers is administered.
When Split is selected for Managing the Copier/Printer Count

bar
ACCOUNT.REPORT | Category | Value | |---|---| | MFP | 100 | | Firmware Version | 80 |For the count by paper size, the report will be printed by size.
Use the procedure below to print a job accounting report.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 04 User/Job Account 05 User Property 06 Common Settings [ Exit ]
text_image
Login User Name: OK Login Password: [ Login ]1 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 Press the or key to select [User/Job Account].
A login screen will appear. Then, enter the user ID and password with administrator privileges to log in, and press [Login] (the Right Select key).
NOTE: The User/Job Account menu appears. Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix-5 for details on entering characters.
3 The User/Job Account menu appears.

text_image
User/Job Account: OK 01 User Login Set. 02 Job Account.Set. 03 Unknown ID Job [ Exit ]
text_image
Job Account.Set: OK [0 1] Job Accounting [0 2] Account. Report [0 3] Total Accounting [ Exit ]
text_image
Print. Are you sure? →Total JobAccounting [ Yes ] [ No ]4 Press the or key to select [Job Account. Set.].
5 Press the OK key. The Job Account. Set. menu appears.
6 Press the or key to select [Account. Report] and then press the OK key.
7 In the confirmation screen, press [Yes] (the Left Select key). A job accounting report is printed.
Checking the Counter
You can check the number of pages printed and scanned.
The number is counted by the following items:
| Item Description | ||
| Printed Pages | By Function You | You can check the number of pages copied, faxed*, and printed, and the total number of pages used. |
| By Paper Size | You can check the number of pages printed for each paper size. | |
| Scanned Pages You can | check the number of pages copied, faxed*, and otherwise scanned, and the total number of pages used. | |
* FAX functions available only in FS-3140MFP+.


text_image
Sys. Menu/Count.: OK 01 Report 02 Counter 03 System [ Exit ]
text_image
Counter: [01] Printed Pages [02] Scanned Pages [ Exit ]
text_image
Printed Pages: 01 by Function 02 by Paper Size [ Exit ]
text_image
Printed Pages: Copy: 1/4 12345671 Press the System Menu/Counter key on the main unit operation panel.
2 In the Sys. Menu/Count. menu, press the or key to select [Counter], and then press the OK key.
3 Press the or key to select [Printed Pages] or [Scanned Pages], and then press the OK key.
If you select [Printed Pages], select [by Function] or [by Paper Size] in the next screen, and then press the OK key.
4 Press the ◀ or ▷ key to check the count.
5 After completing checking the count, press the OK key. The screen returns to the menu for the account.
Appendix
- Optional Equipment......Appendix-2
• Character Entry Method ...... Appendix-5
• Paper......Appendix-9 - Specifications ...... Appendix-18
- Glossary ...... Appendix-22
Optional Equipment
Overview of Optional Equipment
The following optional equipment is available for the machine.

text_image
Paper Feeder Expansion MemoryPaper Feeder
The paper feeder allows you to add three more paper cassettes to the bottom of the machine for continuous feeding of a large volume of paper. Paper capacity and loading method are the same as Cassettes 1.
Expansion Memory
To expand the printer memory for more complex print jobs and faster print speed, you can plug in optional memory module (dual in line memory module) in the memory slot provided on the main controller board. You can select additional memory module from 128, 256 or 512 MB. The maximum memory size is 768 MB.
NOTE: The expansion memory should only be installed by your service technician. We shall not be liable for any damages caused by improper installation of expansion memory.
Precautions for Handling the Memory Module

text_image
Correct IncorrectInstalling the Memory Module
To protect electronic parts, discharge static electricity from your body by touching a water pipe (faucet) or other large metal object before handling the memory module. Or, wear an antistatic wrist strap, if possible, when you install the memory module.

natural_image
Illustration of hands holding a green rectangular object with an arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)1 Turn off the machine and disconnect the power cord and interface cable.
2 Remove the right cover.

text_image
Diagram showing airflow or heat transfer between a device with labeled components and directional arrows3 Remove the screws and the memory slot cover as shown in the figure.

flowchart
graph TD
A["Internal Device"] --> B["Inserting Memory"]
B --> C["Assembly Step"]
C --> D["Rotation Rotation"]
D --> E["Final Display"]
4 Remove the memory module from its package.
5 Aligning the cutouts of the memory module with the matching keys of the socket, carefully plug the memory module into the memory socket until it clicks in place. Then, push down the memory module to secure.
CAUTION: Before inserting a memory module in the machine, make sure that the machine is switched off.
6 After you finish installing the memory module, secure the memory slot cover with screws removed in step 3.
7 Reinstall the right cover.
Removing the Memory Module
To remove a memory module, remove the right cover and the memory slot cover from the machine. Then, carefully push out the two socket clamps. Ease the memory module out of the socket to remove.
Verifying the expanded memory
To verify that the memory module is working properly, test it by printing a status page.
Character Entry Method
In character entry screens, use the procedure below to enter characters.
Keys Used
Use the following keys to enter characters.

text_image
1 Function Menu OK Back 3 4 75 2 Clear 6 Reset / Stop * Symbols Start- OK Key Press this key to finalize the entered character(s).
- Clear Key Press this key to delete the character at the cursor position. If the cursor is at the end of the line, the character to the left of it is deleted.
- Back Key Press this key to return to the screen from which you invoked the character entry screen.
- Cursor Keys Use these to select the entry position, or select a character from the character list.
- Numeric Keys Use these keys to select the character you want to enter.
- Reset Key Press this key to cancel the character entry procedure and return to the standby screen.
- Right Select Key Press this key to select the type of characters you want to enter. (When [Text] is displayed)
Selecting Type of Characters
To enter characters, the following three types are available:
ABC To enter alphabets.
123 To enter numerals.
Symbols To enter symbols.

text_image
File name input: Report3 123 Text Current character typeIn a character entry screen, press [Text] (the Right Select key) to select the type of characters you want to enter.

flowchart
graph TD
A["ABC\n[ Text "]] --> B["123\n[ Text "]]
Each time you press [Text] (the Right Select key), the character type switches as follows: ABC, 123, Symbol, ABC ...

text_image
Symbols: ↓,..!" # $ %&' () *+, -, / : ; <= >?@ [¥] ^_ ` { | } ~ €, f,, ... † [ Text ]NOTE: By pressing on the numeric keys while entering characters, you can directly display the Symbols screen.
Entering Characters
After selecting a character type, use the procedure below to enter characters.
Entering Alphabets and Numerals
Referring to the table below, press the key corresponding to the character you want to enter until it is displayed.
| Key Entry mode Available characters | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol . @ - | _/ : ~ 1 |
| Numeric 1 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol a b c | A B C 2 |
| Numeric 2 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol d e f | D E F 3 |
| Numeric 3 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol g h i | G H I 4 |
| Numeric 4 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol j k l J | K L 5 |
| Numeric 5 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol m n o | M N O 6 |
| Numeric 6 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol p q r | s P Q R S 7 |
| Numeric 7 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol t u v | T U V 8 |
| Numeric 8 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol w x y | z W X Y Z 9 |
| Numeric 9 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol . , - _ | ’ ! ? (space) 0 |
| Numeric 0 | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol Switch between upper-/lowercase | |
| Numeric * or . (decimal point)* | ||
![]() | Alphabetic/Symbol Numeric | # |
* '*' is entered when [123] is selected in the character type selection, or '.' is entered when only numerals are entered and no character type is selected.

Characters associated with different keys can be entered consecutively. To enter a character associated with the same key after another, use cursor keys to move the cursor to the next entry position before entering it.
If you use cursor keys to move the cursor to an entry position apart from the end of the line and enter a character there, spaces are automatically entered in between.
Entering Symbols

text_image
Symbols: ↓_! " # $ % & ' () *+, -. / : ; <= >?@ [¥] ^ _ ` { | } ~ €, f,, ... † [ Text ]Press [Text] (the Right Select key) or # on the numeric keys to display the Symbols screen. Use cursor keys to select the symbol you want to enter and then press the OK key.
Entry When [Select Character] Is Selected in Login Operation Settings
In the login screen that appears when user management is enabled, the character entry method may vary depending on the settings. (Refer to Login Operation on page 8-66.)
![KYOCERA FS-3040MFP+/KL3 - Entry When [Select Character] Is Selected in Login Operation Settings - 1](/content/2026/06/1244942/images/4b3924df4cae5391c43b81de8e994959da6376ed5e905643a36ad8c501fa65df.jpg)
text_image
Login User Name: OK Morgan abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ [ Next ]If a character palette appears on the screen, use cursor keys to select the desired character from the displayed characters, and then press the OK key to enter it.
NOTE: Numerals can be entered directly by pressing numeric keys.
Paper
This section explains the paper sizes and types that can be used in the paper source.
Cassette
| Supported types Supported | paper sizes No. of sheets | |
| Plain, Preprinted, Bond, Recycled, Rough, Letterhead, Color (Colour), Prepunched, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8 | A4, JIS B5, A5, Folio, Legal, Letter, Oficio II, Statement, Executive, A6, B6, ISO B5, Envelope C5, 16K, Custom (105 x 148 to 216 x 356mm (4-1/8 x 5-13/16 to 8-1/2 x 14 inches) | 500 ( 80g/m^2 ) |
Optional paper feeder
| Supported types Supported | paper sizes No. of sheets | |
| Plain, Preprinted, Bond, Recycled, Rough, Letterhead, Color (Colour), Prepunched, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8 | A4, JIS B5, A5, Folio, Legal, Letter, Oficio II, Executive, B6, ISO B5, Envelope C5, 16K, Custom (148 x 210 to 216 x 356mm (5-13/16 x 8-5/16 to 8-1/2 x 14 inches) | 500 ( 80g/m^2 ) |
Multi Purpose tray (MP tray)
| Supported types Supported | paper sizes No. of sheets | |
| Plain, , Preprinted, Labels, Bond, Recycled, Rough, Vellum, Letterhead, Color (Colour), High Quality, Custom 1 to 8 | Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II, A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 16kOther sizes:Portrait-2.76 to 8.50" or 70 to 216 mmLandscape-5.83 to 14.02" or 148 to 356 mm | 100 ( 80g/m^2 ) |
| Thick paper A4, JIS B5, A5, Folio, Legal | Letter,Oficio II, Statement, Executive, A6,B6, ISO B5, 16KOther sizes:Portrait-2.76 to 8.50" or 70 to 216 mmLandscape-5.83 to 14.02" or 148 to 356 mm | 1 |
| PostcardsOufuku Hagaki (return postcard) | Postcards ( 100 × 148 mm)Return postcard ( 148 × 200 mm) | 1 |

| Supported types Supported | paper sizes No. of sheets | |
| Envelopes ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9,Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch,Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki,Oufuku Hagaki, Youkei 4, Youkei 2Other sizes:Portrait-2.76 to 8.50" or 70 to 216 mmLandscape-5.83 to 14.02" or 148 to 356 mm | 5 | |
| Transparency (OHP film) Letter, A4 1 |
Basic Paper Specifications
This machine is designed to print on standard copy paper as used in regular ('dry') copiers and page printers such as laser printers. It also supports a variety of other types of paper that conform to the specifications given in this appendix.
Be careful when choosing paper. Paper unsuitable for the machine may cause jams or may be wrinkled.
Supported Paper
Use standard copy paper for regular copiers or laser printers. The printing quality will be affected by the quality of paper. Poor quality paper may result in unsatisfactory output.
Basic Paper Specifications
The following table lists the specifications of paper that is supported with this machine. Refer to the subsequent sections for further details.
| Criteria Specifications | |
| Weight Cassettes: 60 to 120 g/m | ^2 |
| Multi purpose tray: 60 to 220 g/m ^2 | |
| Thickness 0.086 to 0.110 mm | |
| Dimensional accuracy ± 0.7 mm | |
| Squareness of corners 90° ± 0.2° | |
| Moisture content 9% | |
| Grain direction Long grain (paper | supply direction) |
| Pulp content 80% or more | |
NOTE: Some recycled paper does not meet requirements for use with this machine as listed in the Basic Paper Specifications shown below, such as moisture or pulp content. For this reason, we recommend purchasing a small amount of recycled paper as a sample for testing prior to use. Choose recycled paper that gives the best printing results and contains low levels of paper dust.
We are not responsible for the problems occurred from the use of paper that does not conform to our specifications.

Choosing the Appropriate Paper
This section describes guidelines for choosing paper.
Condition
Avoid using paper with bent corners or that is curled, dirty, or torn. Do not use paper that has a rough surface or paper fiber lint, or that is especially delicate. Use of paper in any of these conditions will not only deliver poor copies but may also cause jams and shorten the useful life of the machine. Choose paper with a smooth and even surface; however, avoid coated paper or paper with a treated surface as it may damage the drum or fusing unit.
Ingredient
Do not use paper such as paper that has been coated or surface-treated or paper that contains plastic or carbon. These paper may produce harmful fumes from the heat of printing and may damage the drum.
Be sure to use the standard paper that contains at least 80% pulp, i.e., not more than 20% of the total paper content consists of cotton or other fibers.
Supported Paper Sizes
Paper of the following sizes is supported by the machine.
Measurements in the table take into account a ±0.7 mm dimensional accuracy for length and width. Corner angles must be 90^ ± 0.2^ .
| Multi Purpose Tray | Cassette or Multi Purpose Tray |
| B6 (128 × 182 mm) Letter | |
| ISO B5 (176 × 250 mm) Legal | |
| Envelope #10 (Commercial #10) (4 1/8 × 9 1/2") Statement * | |
| Envelope #9 (Commercial #9) (3 7/8 × 8 7/8") Executive | |
| Envelope #6 (Commercial #6 3/4) (3 5/8 × 6 1/2") Oficio II | |
| Envelope Monarch (3 7/8 × 7 1/2") A4 (297 × 210 mm) | |
| Envelope DL (110 × 220 mm) A5 (210 × 148 mm) | |
| Envelope C5 (162 × 229mm) A6 (105 × 148 mm) * | |
| Hagaki (100 × 148mm) B5 (257 × 182 mm) | |
| Oufuku Hagaki (148 × 200 mm) Folio (210 × 330 mm) | |
| Youkei 4 (105 × 235 mm) 16K (273 × 197 mm) | |
| Youkei 2 (114 × 162 mm) | |
| Size Entry (70 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm) |
* Except for the optional cassettes.
Smoothness
The paper surface should be smooth, but it must be uncoated. With paper that is too smooth and slippery, several sheets may accidentally be supplied at once, causing jams.
Basis Weight
In countries that use the metric system, basis weight is the weight in grams of one sheet of paper one square meter in area. In the United States, basis weight is the weight in pounds of one ream (500 sheets) of paper cut to the standard size (or trade size) for a specific grade of paper. Paper that is too heavy or too light may be supplied incorrectly or cause paper jams, which may cause excessive wear of the machine. Mixed paper weight (i.e., thickness) may cause several sheets to be supplied at once accidentally and may also cause blurring or other printing problems if the toner fails to adhere correctly.
The recommended basis weight is between 60 and 120 g/m ^2 for the cassettes and between 60 and 220 g/m ^2 for the multi purpose tray.
Thickness
Avoid using paper that is too thick or thin. Signs that paper may be thin include frequent problems with paper jams or with several sheets being supplied at once. Paper jams may also indicate that the paper is too thick. The proper thickness is between 0.086 and 0.110 mm.
Moisture Content
Paper moisture content is the ratio of moisture to dryness expressed as a percentage. Moisture affects how the paper is supplied, the electrostatic changeability of the paper, and how the toner adheres.
Paper moisture content varies depending on the relative humidity in the room. High relative humidity causes paper to become damp, making the edges expand so it appears wavy. Low relative humidity causes paper to lose moisture, making the edges tighten and weakening print contrast.
Wavy or tight edges may cause the paper to slip when it is supplied. Try to keep the moisture content between 4 to 6%.
To maintain the right level of moisture content, bear in mind the following considerations.
- Store paper in a cool, well-ventilated place.
- Store paper flat and unopened in the package. Once the package is opened, reseal it if the paper is not to be used for a while.
- Store paper sealed in the original package and box. Put a pallet under the carton to keep it raised above the floor. Especially during rainy seasons keep the paper a sufficient distance away from wooden or concrete floors.
- Before using paper that has been stored, keep it at the proper moisture level for at least 48 hours.
- Do not store paper where it is exposed to heat, sunlight, or dampness.
Other Paper Specifications
Porosity: The density of the paper fibers
Stiffness: Paper must be stiff enough or it may buckle in the machine, causing jams.
Curl: Most paper naturally tends to curl after the package is opened. When paper passes through the fixing unit, it curls upward slightly. To deliver flat printouts, load the paper so that the curl faces towards the bottom of the paper tray.
Static electricity: During printing, paper is electrostatically charged so that the toner adheres. Choose paper that can be discharged quickly so that copies do not cling together.
Whiteness: Paper whiteness affects print contrast. Use whiter paper for sharper, brighter copies.
Quality: Machine problems may occur if sheet sizes are not uniform or if corners are not square, edges are rough, sheets are uncut, or edges or corners are crushed. In order to prevent these problems, be especially careful when you cut the paper yourself.
Packaging: Choose paper that is properly packaged and stacked in boxes. Ideally, the packaging itself should have been treated with a coating to inhibit moisture.
Specially treated paper: We do not recommend printing onto the following types of paper, even if it conforms to the basic specifications. When you use these kinds of paper, purchase a small amount first as a sample to test.
- Glossy paper
- Watermarked paper
• Paper with an uneven surface - Perforated paper
Special Paper
This section describes printing onto special paper and print media.
The following paper and media can be used.
• Transparency (OHP film)
- Rough
• Vellum
- Labels
- Recycled
- Preprinted
- Bond
- Cardstock
• Color (Colour)
- Prepunched
- Letterhead
- Envelope
- Th i ck
- High Quality
- Custom 1 to 8
When using these paper and media, choose that are designed specifically for copiers or page printers (such as laser printers). Use the multi purpose tray for transparencies, thick paper, envelopes, cardstocks, and label paper.
Choosing Special Paper
Although special paper that meets the following requirements can be used with the machine, print quality will vary considerably due to differences in the construction and quality of special paper. Thus, special paper is more likely than regular paper to cause printing problems. Before purchasing special paper in volume, try testing a sample to ensure the print quality is satisfactory. General precautions when printing onto special paper are given below. Note that we are not responsible for any harm to the user or damage to the machine caused by moisture or specifications of special paper.
Select a cassette or multi purpose tray for special paper.
Transparency (OHP film)
Transparencies must be able to withstand the heat of printing. Transparencies must meet the following conditions.
| Criteria Specifications | |
| Heat resistance Must withstand at least 190°C | |
| Thickness 0.100 to 0.110 mm | |
| Material Polyester | |
| Dimensional accuracy ±0.7 mm | |
| Squareness of corners 90° ±0.2° | |
To avoid problems, use the multi purpose tray for transparencies and load transparencies with the long side facing the machine.
If transparencies jam frequently at output, try pulling the leading edge of sheets gently as they are ejected.
Cardstock

text_image
Burrs 1 4 BurrsBefore loading Hagaki into the multi purpose tray, fan them and align the edges. If the Hagaki paper is curled, straighten it before loading. Printing onto curled Hagaki may cause jams.
Use unfolded Oufuku Hagaki (available at post offices). Some Hagaki may still have rough edges developed by a paper cutter on the back side. Remove any such rough edges by placing the Hagaki on a flat surface and rubbing the edges gently a few times with a ruler.

Envelopes
Use the multi purpose tray for envelopes.
Due to the structure of envelopes, printing evenly over the entire surface may not be possible in some cases. Thin envelopes in particular may be wrinkled by the machine in some cases as they pass through. Before purchasing envelopes in volume, try testing a sample to ensure the print quality.
Storing envelopes for a long period may cause them to become wrinkled. Thus, keep the package sealed until you are ready to use them.
Keep the following points in mind.
Do not use envelopes with exposed adhesive. In addition, do not use the type of envelope in which the adhesive is exposed after the top layer is peeled off. Serious damage may be caused if the paper covering the adhesive comes off in the machine.
Do not use envelopes with certain special features. For example, do not use envelopes with a grommet for winding a string to close the flap or envelopes with an open or film-covered window.
If paper jams occur, load fewer envelopes at once.
To prevent paper jams when printing onto multiple envelopes, do not allow more than ten envelopes remain in the inner tray at once.
Thick Paper
Before loading thick paper in the multi purpose tray, fan it and align the edges. Some thick paper may still have rough edges developed by a paper cutter on the back side. Remove any such rough edges just as with Hagaki by placing the paper on a flat surface and rubbing the edges gently a few times with a ruler. Printing onto paper with rough edges may cause jams.
NOTE: If the paper is not supplied correctly even after it is smoothed, load the paper in the multi purpose tray with the leading edge raised a few millimeters.
Label
Be sure to feed labels from the multi purpose tray.
For selecting labels, use extreme care so that the adhesive may not come in direct contact with any part of the machine and that the labels are not easily peeled from the carrier sheet. Adhesives that stick to the drum or rollers and peeled labels remaining in the machine may cause a failure.
When printing onto labels, you must be liable for the print quality and possible trouble.

text_image
Top sheet Adhesive layer Carrier sheetLabels consist of three layers as shown in the illustration. The adhesive layer contains materials that are easily affected by the force applied in the machine. The carrier sheet bears the top sheet until the label is used. This composition of labels may cause more problems.
The label surface must be covered completely with the top sheet. Gaps between labels may cause peeling of labels, resulting in a serious failure.
Some label paper has large margins on the top sheet. When using such paper, do not peel these margins from the carrier sheet before completing output.

text_image
Top sheet Carrier sheet Not allowedAllowedUse label paper that conforms to the following specifications.
| Item Specifications | |
| Top sheet weight 44 to 74 g/m2 | |
| Basis weight(overall paper weight) | 104 to 151 g/m2 |
| Top sheet thickness 0.086 to 0.107 mm | |
| Overall paper thickness 0.115 to 0.145 mm | |
| Moisture content 4 to 6 % (composite) |
Colored Paper
Colored paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 11 of the Appendix. In addition, the pigments in the paper must be able to withstand the heat of printing (up to 200^ C or 392^ F).
Preprinted Paper
Preprinted paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 9 of the Appendix. The colored ink must be able to withstand the heat of printing. It must be resistant to silicone oil as well. Do not use paper with a treated surface such as glossy paper used for calendars.
Recycled Paper
Recycled paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 11 of the Appendix; however, its whiteness may be considered separately.
NOTE: Before purchasing recycled paper in volume, try testing a sample to ensure that the print quality.

Specifications
NOTE: Specifications are subject to change without notice.
Machine
| Item Description | ||
| Type Desktop | ||
| Printing Method | Electrophotography by semiconductor laser, single drum system | |
| Supported Original Types | Sheet, Book, 3-dimensional objects (maximum original size: Folio/Legal) | |
| Original Feed System Fixed | ||
| Paper Weight F | Front Cassette 60 to 120 g/m ^2 (Duplex: 60 to 120 g/m ^2 ) | |
| MP Tray 60 to 220 g/m ^2 | ||
| Paper Type | Front Cassette | Plain, Rough, Recycled, Preprinted, Bond, Color (Colour), Prepunched, Letterhead, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8 (Duplex: Same as Simplex) |
| MP Tray | Plain, Transparency (OHP film), Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled, Preprinted, Bond, Cardstock, Color (Colour), Prepunched, Letterhead, Thick, Envelope, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8 | |
| Paper Size Front | Cassette Maximum: 8 1/2 × 14"/A4 (Duplex: 8 1/2 × 14"/A4)Minimum: 5 1/2 × 8 1/2"/A6 (Duplex: 7 1/4 × 10 1/2"/A5) | |
| MP Tray Maximum: 8 1/2 × 14"/A4Minimum: 3 5/8 × 6 1/2"/A6 | ||
| Zoom Level Manual mode: 25 to 400%, 1% incrementsFixed magnifications:400%, 200%, 141%, 129%, 115%, 90%, 86%, 78%, 70%, 64%, 50%, 25% | ||
| Printing Speed | Simplex A4R/LetterR: 40/42 sheets/min Legal: 33 sheets/minB5R: 33 sheets/min A5R/A6R: 22 sheets/min | |
| Duplex | A4R/LetterR: 24.5/26 sheets/min Legal: 16.5 sheets/minB5R: 24 sheets/min A5R: 21 sheets/min | |
| First Print Time(A4, feed from Cassette) | 9.5 seconds or less | |
| Warm-up Time(22°C/71.6°F,60%) | Power on | 22 seconds or less |
| Low Power | 10 seconds or less | |
| Sleep | 15 seconds or less | |
| Paper Capacity | Front Cassette 500 sheets (80 g/m ^2 ) | |
| MP Tray 100 sheets (80 g/m ^2 , plain paper, A4/Letter or less) | ||
| Output Tray Capacity | 500 sheets (80 g/m ^2 ) | |
| Continuous Copying | 1 to 999 sheets (can be set in one sheet increments) | |
| Image Write System | Semiconductor laser (1 beam) | |
| Main Memory Standard: 256MB | Maximum: 768MB | |
| Interface USB Interface Connector | 1 (USB Hi-Speed)USB Host: 1Network interface: 1 (10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX) | |
| Resolution 600 × 600 dpi | ||
| Operating Environment | Temperature 10 to | 32.5°C/50 to 90.5°F |
| Humidity 15 to 80 % | ||
| Altitude 8,200 feet/2,500 m or less | ||
| Brightness 1,500 lux or less | ||
| Dimension (W × D × H) 11 1/2 × 19 9/16 × 21 1/2"494 × 497.1 × 545.5 mm | ||
| Weight (without toner container) | FS-3040MFP+ 56.1 lb/25.5 kg | |
| FS-3140MFP+ 56.76 lb/25.8 kg | ||
| Space Required (W × D) 11 1/2 × 25 7/8"494 × 656.1 mm (when using MP tray) | ||
| Power Requirement 120 V Speci cation Model:120 V (60 Hz, more than 9.5 A)230 V Specification Model: 220 to 240V (50/60 Hz, more than 5.1 A) | ||
| Power Consumption (Maximum) | Standard: 1032 W (U.S.A./Canada), 1046 W (European countries)With options: 1037 W (U.S.A./Canada), 1063 W (European countries) | |
| Power Consump-tion (During printing) | FS-3040MFP+ Standard: 679.9 W (U.S.A./Canada), 676.6 W (European countries)With options:713.3 W (U.S.A./Canada), 688.2 W (European countries) | |
| FS-3140MFP+ Standard: 680.9 W (U.S.A./Canada), 677.4 W (European countries)With options: 719.0 W (U.S.A./Canada), 703.5 W (European countries) | ||
| Power Consump-tion (During standby) | FS-3040MFP+ Standard: 94.5 W(U.S.A./Canada), 95.8 W (European countries)With options: 101.6 W(U.S.A./Canada), 103.7 W (European countries) | |
| FS-3140MFP+ Standard: 104.6 W(U.S.A./Canada), 97.9 W (European countries)With options: 113.0 W(U.S.A./Canada), 102.1 W (European countries) | ||
| Power Consump-tion (Low power mode) | FS-3040MFP+ | Standard: 34.0 W(U.S.A./Canada), 72.7 W (European countries)With options: 37.0 W(U.S.A./Canada), 73.1 W (European countries) |
| FS-3140MFP+ | Standard: 42.8 W(U.S.A./Canada), 74.8 W (European countries)With options: 43.3 W(U.S.A./Canada), 75.6 W (European countries) | |
| Power Consump-tion (Sleep mode) | FS-3040MFP+ Standard: 6.8 W (U.S.A./Canada), 6.9 W (European countries)With options: 8.8 W (U.S.A./Canada), 9.1 W (European countries) | |
| FS-3140MFP+ Standard: 10.4 W (U.S.A./Canada), 10.6 W (European countries)With options: 12.5 W (U.S.A./Canada), 12.6 W (European countries) | ||
| Power Consumption (Power off) | 0.1 W | |
| Options Paper feeder (up to 3 units) | ||

Printer
| Item Description | ||
| Printing Speed Same as Copying | Speed. | |
| First Print Time(A4, feed from Cassette) | 9.5 seconds or less | |
| Resolution Fine 1200, Fast 1200, | 600 dpi, 300 dpi | |
| Operating System Windows XP, | Windows XP Professional, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition, Windows Vista x86 Edition, Windows Vista x64 Edition, Windows Server 2008, Windows Server 2008 x64 Edition, Windows 7, Apple Macintosh OS 10.x | |
| Interface Standard USB Interface | Connector: 1 (USB Hi-Speed)USB Host: 1Network interface: 1 (10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX) | |
| Page Description Language PRE | SCRIBE | |
Scanner
| Item Description | |
| Operating System | Windows XP, Windows Vista, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2008, Windows 7 |
| System requirements IBM PC/AT | compatibleCPU: Celeron 600Mhz or higherRAM: 128MB or moreHDD free space: 20MB or moreInterface: Ethernet |
| Resolution 600 dpi, 400 dpi, 300 | dpi, 200 dpi |
| File Format | JPEG,TIFF,PDF, XPS |
| Scanning Speed *1 | 1-sided: B/W 35 Images/minColor 13 Images/min(A4 landscape, 600 dpi, Image quality: Text/Photo original) |
| Interface | Ethernet (10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX)USB2.0 (Hi-Speed USB) |
| Network Protocol | TCP/IP |
| Transmission System | PC transmission SMB Scan to SMBFTP Scan to FTP, FTP over SLE-mail transmission SNMP Scan to E-mailTWAIN scan*1WIA scan*2 |
*1 Available Operating System : Windows XP, Windows Server 2003, Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Server 2008
*2 Available Operating System : Windows Vista, Windows 7, Windows Server 2008
Document Processor
| Item Description | |
| Original Feed Method | Automatic feed |
| Supported Original Types | Sheet originals |
| Paper Size Maximum: | Legal/A4Minimum: Statement/A5 |
| Paper Weight Simplex: | 50 to 120 g/m ^2 Duplex: 50 to 110 g/m ^2 |
| Loading Capacity 50 sheets (50 to 80 g/m ^2 ) maximum | |
Environmental Specifications
| Item Description | |
| Time to Low Power mode (default setting) | 2 minutes |
| Time to Sleep mode (default setting) 15 minutes | |
| Recovery time from Low Power mode 10 seconds or less | |
| Recovery time from Sleep mode 15 seconds or less | |
| Duplexing Standard | |
| Paper supply capability 100% recycled paper may be used. |
NOTE: Consult your dealer or service representative for recommended paper types.
EN ISO 7779
AppleTalk, which comes with Apple Computer's Mac OS, is a network protocol. AppleTalk enables file/printer sharing and also enables you to utilize application software that is on another computer on the same AppleTalk network.
Auto Form Feed Timeout
During data transmission, the machine may sometimes have to wait until receiving the next data. This is the auto form feed timeout. When the preset timeout passes, the machine automatically put paper out. However, no output is performed if the last page has no data to be printed.
Auto Paper Selection
A function to automatically select paper in the same size as original at printing
Auto Sleep Mode
A mode designed for electrical power saving, activated when the machine is left unused or data transfer for a specific period. In Sleep mode, power consumption is kept to a minimum.
Bonjour
Bonjour, also known as zero-configuration networking, is a service that automatically detects computers, devices and services on an IP network. Bonjour, because an industry-standard IP protocol is used, allows devices to automatically recognize each other without an IP address being specified or DNS server being set. Bonjour also sends and receives network packets by UDP port 5353. If a firewall is enabled, the user must check that UDP port 5353 is left open so that Bonjour will run correctly. Some firewalls are set up so as to reject only certain Bonjour packets. If Bonjour does not run stably, check the firewall settings and ensure that Bonjour is registered on the exceptions list and that Bonjour packets are accepted. If you install Bonjour on Windows XP Service Pack 2 or later, the Windows firewall will be set up correctly for Bonjour.
Default Gateway
This indicates the device, such as a computer or router, that serves as the entrance/exit (gateway) for accessing computers outside the network that you are on, When no specific gateway is designated for a destination IP address, data is sent to the host designated as the Default Gateway.
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) that automatically resolves IP addresses, subnet masks, and gateway addresses on a TCP/IP network. DHCP minimizes the load of network management employing a large number of client computers because it relieves individual clients including printers from the IP address being assigned.
dpi (dots per inch)
A unit for resolution, representing the number of dots printed per inch (25.4 mm).
EcoPrint Mode
A printing mode that helps save toner. Copies made in this mode are thus lighter than normal.
Emulation
The function to interpret and execute other printers' page description languages. The machine emulates operation of PCL6, KC-GL, KPDL, and KPDL (automatic).
FTP (File Transfer Protocol)
A protocol to transfer files on the TCP/IP network, whether the Internet or an intranet. Along with HTTP and SMTP/POP, FTP is now frequently used on the Internet.
Grayscale
A computer color expression. Displayed images of this sort are typically composed of shades of gray, varying from black at the weakest intensity to white at the strongest, without any other colors. Gray levels are displayed in numerical levels: that is, white and black only for 1 bit; 256 gray levels (including white and black) for 8 bits; and 65,536 gray levels for 16 bits.
IP Address
An Internet protocol address is a unique number that represents a specific computer or related device on the network. The format of an IP address is four sets of numbers separated by dots, e.g. 192.168.110.171. Each number should be between 0 and 255.
IPP
IPP (Internet Printing Protocol) is a standard that uses TCP/IP networks such as the Internet to enable print jobs to be sent between remote computers and printers. IPP is an extension of the HTTP protocol used to view websites and enables printing to be carried out via routers on printers in remote locations. It also supports the HTTP authentication mechanisms along with SSL server and client authentication as well as encryption.
KPDL (Kyocera Page Description Language)
Kyocera's PostScript page description language compatible with Adobe PostScript Level 3.
Multi Purpose (MP) Tray
Use this tray instead of the cassettes when printing onto envelopes, Hagaki, transparencies, or labels.
NetBEUI (NetBIOS Extended User Interface)
An interface, developed by IBM in 1985, as an update from NetBIOS. It enables more advanced functions on smaller networks than other protocols such as TCP/IP, etc. It is not suitable for larger networks due to lack of routing capabilities to choose the most appropriate routes. NetBEUI has been adopted by IBM for its OS/2 and Microsoft for its Windows as a standard protocol for file sharing and printing services.
NetWare
Novell's network management software that is able to run on a variety of operating systems.
POP3 (Post Office Protocol 3)
A standard protocol to receive E-mail from the server in which the mail is stored on the Internet or an intranet.
PostScript
A page description language developed by Adobe Systems. It enables flexible font functions and highly-functional graphics, allowing higher quality printing. The first version called Level 1 was launched in 1985, followed by Level 2 that enabled color printing and two-byte languages (e.g. Japanese) in 1990. In 1996, Level 3 was released as an update for the Internet access and PDF format as well as gradual improvements in implementation technologies.
This indicates the number of A4 size printouts made in one minute.
Printer Driver
The software to enable you to print data created on any application software. The printer driver for the machine is contained in the DVD-ROM enclosed in the package. Install the printer driver on the computer connected to the machine.
Send as E-mail
A function to send the image data stored in the machine as an E-mail attachment. E-mail addresses can be selected from the list or entered at each time.
SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)
A protocol for E-mail transmission over the Internet or an intranet. It is used for transferring mail between mail servers as well as for sending mail from clients to their servers.
Status Page
The page lists machine conditions, such as the memory capacity, total number of prints and scans, and paper source settings.
Subnet Mask
The subnet mask is a way of augmenting the network address section of an IP address. A subnet mask represents all network address sections as 1 and all host address sections as 0. The number of bits in the prefix indicates the length of the network address. The term "prefix" refers to something added to the beginning and, in this context, indicates the first section of the IP address. When an IP address is written, the length of the network address can indicated by the prefix length after a forward slash (/). For example, "24" in the address "133.210.2.0/24". In this way, "133.210.2.0/24" denotes the IP address "133.210.2.0" with a 24-bit prefix (network section). This new network address section (originally part of the host address) made possible by the subnet mask is referred to as the subnet address.When you enter the subnet mask, be sure to set the DHCP setting to Off.
TCP/IP (Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol)
TCP/IP is a suite of protocols designed to define the way computers and other devices communicate with each other over a network.
TCP/IP (IPv6)
TCP/IP (IPv6) is based on the current Internet protocol, TCP/IP (IPv4). IPv6 is the next-generation Internet protocol and expands the available address space, which resolves the problem of the lack of addresses under IPv4, while also introducing other improvements such as additional security functionality and the capacity to prioritize data transmission.
TWAIN (Technology Without Any Interested Name)
A technical specification for connecting scanners, digital cameras, and other image equipment to the computers. The TWAIN compatible devices enable to process image data on any relevant application software. TWAIN is adopted on a large number of graphic software (e.g. Adobe Photoshop) and OCR software.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) 2.0
A USB interface standard for Hi-Speed USB 2.0. The maximum transfer rate is 480 Mbps. This machine is equipped with USB 2.0 for high-speed data transfer.
WIA (Windows Imaging Acquisition)
A function to import images supported after Windows Me/XP from digital cameras and other peripheral devices. This function replaces what TWAIN used to do; the feature is provided as a part of Windows functions and improves ease of operation, so that you import images directly to My Computer without using any application.

Index
Numerics
1-sided/2-sided Selection 5-7
A
Accessibility Appendix-22
Adjusting Density 5-13
Auto 3-8
Manual 3-8
Adjustment/Maintenance 8-98
Copy Density Adjustment 8-98
Correcting Fine Black Lines 8-100
Developer Refresh 8-101, 8-102
Send/Box Density 8-99
AppleTalk Appendix-22
Auto Low Power Mode 2-8
Auto Paper Selection Appendix-22
Auto Sleep 2-8, Appendix-22
B
Bonjour Appendix-22
Bundled Items 2-2
Buzzer 8-6
C
Cassette
Loading Paper 2-42
Paper Size and Media Type 8-12
Cassette 1 1-5
Changing Language 2-9, 8-3
Cleaning
Separator 9-5
Slit Glass 9-3
Color
Color / Grayscale / Black and White
Selection 5-15
Color mode
Color Selection (Copy) 8-42
Combine Mode
2-in-1 Mode 4-9
4-in-1 Mode 4-10
Page Boundary Lines 4-11
COMMAND CENTER 2-28
Connecting
LAN Cable 2-5
Power Cable 2-9
USB Cable 2-9
Connection Method 2-3
Continuous Scan
Copy 4-13
Send 5-16
Conventions in This Guide xxviii
Copy
Adjusting Density 3-8
Collate Copying 3-15
Duplex Copying 3-12
Offset Copying 3-15
Originals 4-2
Selecting Image Quality 3-9
Setup 8-68
Zoom Copying 3-10
Copy Settings 8-68
Auto Paper Selection 8-70, 8-71
Paper Selection 8-69
Quick Setup Registration 8-72
Copying Functions 4-1
Counting the Number of Pages Printed
Each Job 11-33
Printing a Report 11-35
Total Job 11-31
Counting the Number of Pages
Printed 11-31
D
Date/Timer 8-27
Auto Panel Reset 8-37
Date Format 8-29
Date/Time 8-27
Low Power Timer 8-39
Time Zone 8-30
Default 8-42
2 in 1 8-57
4 in 1 8-58

Collate/Offset 8-47
Color Selection (Copy) 8-42
Continuous Scan 8-52
Density 8-45
EcoPrint 8-49
E-mail Subject/Body 8-51
File Format 8-53
File Name 8-50
File Separation 8-54
Image Quality 8-63
Original Image 8-44
Original Orientation 8-48
Scan Resolution 8-43
TIFF Print 8-55
XPS FitTo Page 8-56
Zoom 8-46
Default Gateway Appendix-22
Default Screen 8-5
Density Adjustment
Copy 3-8
Send 5-13
Destination 8-105
Adding 8-105
Adding a Group 8-110
Choosing by One-Touch Key 3-28
Choosing from the Address Book 3-26
Editing 8-114
One-touch Key 8-116
Search 3-26
Sending to Different Types of Destinations (Multi Sending) 3-28
Developer unit 1-4
Device 7-19
Checking Status 7-19
Configuring 7-20
DHCP Appendix-22
Document Box 6-1
Document Processor Appendix-21
How to Load Originals 2-55
Loading Originals 2-55
Not Supported Originals 2-55
Supported Originals 2-55
Document processor 1-5
Document processor open/close handle 1-6
dpi Appendix-22
Duplex 3-12, 8-79
Duplexer front cover 1-4
DVD-ROM 2-2
E
EcoPrint Mode Appendix-22
Copy 4-8
Print 8-77
Send as E-mail 3-19
Emulation Appendix-22
Selection 8-74
Energy Star Program xxvi
Enter E-mail Subject and Body 5-18
Entry
Body 5-18
File Name 4-16, 5-17
Subject 5-18
Error Handling 8-25
Error Messages 10-6
Expansion Memory Appendix-2
F
File
Format 5-10
File Name 4-16
File Separation 5-24
Front cover 1-4
FTP Appendix-23
FTP Encrypted TX 5-23, 5-25
G
GPL/LGPL -xxiii
Grayscale 5-15, Appendix-23
H
Handholds 1-5
Handholes 1-6
|
Image Quality
Copy 3-7
Send 5-12
Included Guides 2
Inner tray 1-5
Installation Precautions xv
Interface Block 8-146
IP Address Appendix-23
IPP Appendix-23
J
Job
Available Status 7-2
Canceling 3-29, 7-18
Checking History 7-8
Checking Status 7-2
Pause and Resumption 7-18
Sending the Job Log History 7-13
Job Accounting 11-15
Managing the Copier/Printer Counts 11-22
Restricting the Use of the Machine 11-23
Job Box 8-88
Job Retention Deletion 8-89
Quick Copy Jobs 8-88
Job Finish Notice 5-21
Copy 4-14
Send 5-21
K
KPDL Appendix-23
L
Label Appendix-16
LAN Cable
Connecting 2-5
Left cover 1-6
Legal Information xxii
LINE connector 1-6
Login 3-2, 11-5
Logout 3-2, 11-5
Low Power Mode 2-8
Low Power Timer 8-39
M
Main power switch 1-6
Management 11-1
Job Accounting 11-15
User Login Administration 11-2
Monotype Imaging License Agreement xxv
Multi Purpose (MP) Tray Appendix-23
Paper Size and Media 2-51, 8-14
Multi purpose tray (MP tray) 1-5
Multi Sending (Sending to Different Types of
Destinations ) 3-28
N
NetBEUI Appendix-23
NetWare 8-131, Appendix-23
Setup 8-131
Network
Setup 2-14
Network Cable 2-4
Connecting 2-5
Network Interface 2-4
Network interface connector/indicators 1-6
Network Security 8-139
Network Setup
FTP (Reception) 8-136
HTTP 8-136
HTTPS 8-136
IPP over SSL 8-137
LAN Interface 8-120
LDAP 8-136
LPD 8-136
NetBEUI 8-136
NetWare 8-131
POP3 (E-mail RX) 8-136
Raw Port 8-136
SMTP (E-mail TX) 8-136
SNMP 8-136
TCP/IP (IPv4) 8-121
TCP/IP (IPv6) 8-130, 8-133, 8-134
0
Open SSLeay xxiii
Operation Panel 1-2
Operation panel 1-4
Option
Expansion Memory Appendix-2
Overview Appendix-2
Paper Feeder Appendix-2
Optional Functions 8-150
Original
Loading in the Document
Processor 2-55
Placing on the Platen 2-54
Original eject table 1-6
Original Orientation
Copy 4-6
Document Processor 4-6

Send 5-8
Original Size Selection
Send 5-2
Original SSLeay License xxiv
Original stopper 1-6
Original table 1-6
Original width guides 1-6
Originals
Copy 4-2
Custom 8-7
Setup 8-7
Size Selection 4-2, 5-2
P
Paper
Appropriate Paper Appendix-12
Auto Selection 8-19
Before Loading 2-41
Cassette 8-12
Custom 8-10
Default Paper Source 8-20
Loading Envelopes 2-47
Loading in the Cassettes 2-42
Loading in the Multi Purpose Tray 2-45
Multi Purpose Tray 8-14
Setup 8-7
Size and Media 2-49, Appendix-9
Special Paper 8-21, Appendix-14
Specifications Appendix-11
Weight 8-16
Paper Feeder Appendix-2
Paper guage 1-4
Paper Jam 10-13
Cassette 1 10-14
Document Processor 10-17
Duplexer 10-15
Jam Location Indicators 10-13
MP Tray 10-14
Paper Feeder 10-14
Precaution 10-13
Rear Unit 10-17
Paper length guide 1-5
Paper Selection 4-3
Cassette 4-3
Multi Purpose Tray 4-4
Paper size dial 1-5
Paper width adjusting tab 1-5
Paper width guide 1-5
Paper width guides
MP tray 1-5
Part Names 1-1
Platen 1-4
Placing Originals 2-54
POP3 Appendix-23
PostScript Appendix-23
Power Cable
Connecting 2-9
Power cord connector 1-6
Power Off 2-7
Power On 2-6
PPM Appendix-23
Preparation 2-1
Preparing Cables 2-4
Printer
Setup 8-74
Printer Driver Appendix-24
Printer Settings 8-74
Copies 8-80
CR Action 8-83
Duplex 8-79
EcoPrint 8-77
Emulation 8-74
Form Feed Timeout 8-82
LF Action 8-82
Orientation 8-81
Override A4/Letter 8-78
Printing 3-16
Printing from a Job Box 6-9
Printing from Applications 3-16
Printing Reports/Sending Notice 8-93
Font List 8-94
Network Status Page 8-95
Service Status Page 8-95
Status Page 8-93
Transmission Result Reports 8-96
Private Print 6-9
Product Library 2-2
Q
Quick Copy mode 6-10
Quick Setup Screen
Changing Registration 8-72, 8-86, 8-90
R
RAM Disk Mode 8-67
Rear cover 1-6
Resolution Appendix-19, Appendix-20
Restarting the System 8-119
s
Safety Conventions i
SAFETY OF LASER BEAM (USA) xvii
Scan Resolution 5-14
Default settings 8-43
Send
File Format 5-10
Image Quality 5-12
Original Size Selection 5-2
Sending Size Selection 5-3
Setup 8-86
Sending
Send as E-mail 3-19
Send to Folder (FTP) 3-23
Send to Folder (SMB) 3-23
Sending E-mail 2-29
Sending Functions 5-1
Sending Settings 8-86
Quick Setup Registration 8-86
Sending Size Selection 5-3
Sending to Different Types of Destinations
(Multi Sending) 3-28
Separator
Cleaning 9-5
Setting Date and Time 2-11
Setup
Copy 8-68
Date/Timer 8-27
NetWare 8-131
Network 8-120
Printer 8-74
Send 8-86
Sleep 2-8
Slit Glass
Cleaning 9-3
Slit glass 1-4
SMTP Appendix-24
Solving Malfunctions 10-2
Specifications
Document Processor Appendix-21
Environmental Specifications Appendix-21
Machine Appendix-18
Printer Appendix-20
Scanner Appendix-20
Specifying Destination 3-26
Status / Job Cancel 7-1
Status Page 8-93, Appendix-24
Subnet Mask Appendix-24
Support tray section of the multi purpose tray 1-5
Switching the Language 2-9, 8-3
Switching Unit of Measurement 8-24
Symbols i
System Menu 8-1
T
TCP/IP Appendix-24
TEL connector 1-6
Toner container 1-4
Toner container lock lever 1-4
Top cover 1-4, 1-6
Trade Names xxii
TWAIN Appendix-24
U
Unusable Time 8-40
USB Appendix-24
USB Cable
Connecting 2-9
USB Interface 2-4
USB interface connector 1-6
USB Memory
Printing Documents 6-2
Removing 6-8
Saving Documents 6-6
TIFF Print 6-3
XPS FitTo Page 6-4
USB memory slot 1-4
User Login Administration 11-2
Adding 11-6
Changing Properties 11-9
Displaying Network User Propertiy 11-12
Enabling/Disabling 11-2
Enabling/Disabling Group Authentication 11-11
Login 11-5
Logout 11-5
Unknown login user name Job 11-13

W
Waste Toner Box 1-6
WIA Appendix-25
WSD Scan 5-19
X
XPS
File formats 5-10, 8-53
Saving documents to Removable USB
Memory 6-6
Z
Zoom Copying
Auto Zoom 3-10
Manual Zoom 3-10
Preset Zoom 3-10
Zoom Mode
Copy 3-10, 5-5
Send 5-5

text_image
QUALITY CERTIFICATEPASSIONATE PEOPLE. FROM ALL OVER THE WORLD.


KYOCERA MITA EUROPE B.V.
EUROPEAN HEADQUARTERS
Bloemlaan 4
2132 NP Hoofddorp
The Netherlands
Phone: +31 20 654 0000
Fax: +31 20 653 1256
www.kyoceramita-europe.com

KYOCERA MITA Europe B.V., Amsterdam (NL)
(Europe, Middle East & North Africa)
Bloemlaan 4
2132 NP Hoofddorp
The Netherlands
Phone: +31 20 654 0000
Fax: +31 20 653 1256
www.kyoceramita-europe.com

AUSTRIA
KYOCERA MITA AUSTRIA GmbH
Eduard Kittenberger Gasse 95
A-1230 Wien
Phone: +43 1 86 338 0
Fax: +43 1 86 338 400
www.kyoceramita.at

BELGIUM
S.A. KYOCERA MITA Belgium N.V.
Sint-Martinusweg 199-201
BE-1930 Zaventem
Phone: +32 2 720 9270
Fax: +32 2 720 8748
www.kyoceramita.be

DENMARK
KYOCERA MITA Denmark A/S
Ejby Industrivej 60
DK-2600 Glostrup
Phone: +45 70 22 3880
Fax: +45 45 76 3850
www.kyoceramita.dk

FINLAND
KYOCERA MITA Finland OY
Kirvesmiehenkatu 4
FI-00880 Helsinki
Phone: +358 9 4780 5200
Fax: +358 9 4780 5390
www.kyoceramita.fi

FRANCE
KYOCERA MITA France S.A.
KYOCERA MITA South Africa (Pty) Ltd.
527 Kyalami Boulevard, Kyalami
Business Park · ZA-1685 Midrand
Phone: +27 11 540 2600
Fax: +27 11 466 3050
www.kyoceramita.co.za

SPAIN
8 Beacontree Plaza, Gillette Way,
Reading, Berkshire RG2 OBS
Phone: +44 1189 311 500
Fax: +44 1189 311 108
www.kyoceramita.co.uk
2-28, 1-Chome, Tamatsukuri, Chuo-ku,
Osaka 540-8585, Japan
Phone: +81 6 6764 3555
Fax: +81 6 6764 3980
www.kyoceramita.com

USA
KYOCERA MITA America, INC.
(Head office)
225 Sand Road, P.O. Box 40008
Fairfield, New Jersey 07004-0008, USA
www.kyoceramita.com/us
KYOCERA CORPORATION

JAPAN
KYOCERA CORPORATION
(Corporate Headquarters)
6 Takeda Tobadono-cho, Fushimi-ku
Kyoto 612-8501, Japan
Phone: +81 75 604 3500
Fax: +81 75 604 3501
www.kyocera.co.jp

KYOCERA


[IMAGE][IMAGE]













